Explain the TLS cleanup bug in the ChangeLog
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.80"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552013
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.endtable
440
441The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448.cindex "web site"
449.cindex "FTP site"
450The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453&%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454&%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457.cindex "wiki"
458.cindex "FAQ"
459As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496.cindex "training courses"
497Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503.cindex "bug reports"
504.cindex "reporting bugs"
505Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513.cindex "FTP site"
514.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516.display
517&*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518.endd
519This is mirrored by
520.display
521&*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522.endd
523The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531.display
532&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534.endd
535where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540.cindex "distribution" "public key"
541.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548&_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554&url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556.new
557Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
558key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
559Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
560.wen
561
562The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
563.display
564&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
565&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
566.endd
567For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
568separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
569find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
570
571.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
572The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
573documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
574inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
575.display
576&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
580.endd
581These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
582distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
583
584
585.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
586.ilist
587.cindex "limitations of Exim"
588.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
589Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
590RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
591simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
592configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
593UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
594.next
595.cindex "domainless addresses"
596.cindex "address" "without domain"
597Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
598local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
599configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
600systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
601arrival.
602.next
603.cindex "transport" "external"
604.cindex "external transports"
605The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
606and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
607transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
608and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
609to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
610handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
611.next
612Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
613such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
614(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
615other means.
616.next
617Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
618are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
619are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
620compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
621a number of common scanners are provided.
622.endlist
623
624
625.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
626Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
627into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
628values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
629file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
630distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
631
632
633.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
634.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
635Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
636can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
637&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
638about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
639Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
640example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
641format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6423, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
643documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
644made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
645
646Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
647line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
648which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
649interface to Exim's command line administration options.
650
651
652
653.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
654.cindex "terminology definitions"
655.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
656The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
657It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
658below) by a blank line.
659
660.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
661When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
662delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
663&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
664called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
665failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
666message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
667rise to further bounce messages.
668
669The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
670value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
671also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
672otherwise.
673
674The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
675destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
676down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
677until a later time.
678
679The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
680host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
681the part of an email address following the @ sign.
682
683.cindex "envelope, definition of"
684.cindex "sender" "definition of"
685A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
686body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
687be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
688sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
689envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
690messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
691
692.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
693.cindex "header section" "definition of"
694The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
695of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
696&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
697indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
698line.
699
700.cindex "local part" "definition of"
701.cindex "domain" "definition of"
702The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
703part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
704@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
705
706.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
707.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
708The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
709delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
710TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
711host it is running on are &'remote'&.
712
713.cindex "return path" "definition of"
714&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
715message's envelope.
716
717.cindex "queue" "definition of"
718The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
719because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
720Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
721normally no ordering of waiting messages.
722
723.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
724The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
725and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
726is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
727the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
728
729.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
730The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
731messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
732delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
733mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
734the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
735
736
737
738
739
740
741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
743
744.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
745.cindex "incorporated code"
746.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
747.cindex "PCRE"
748.cindex "OpenDMARC"
749A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
750
751.ilist
752Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
753Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
754&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
755Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
756or obtain and install the full version of the library from
757&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
758.next
759.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
760Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
761contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
762Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
763It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
764following statements:
765
766.blockquote
767Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
768
769This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
770the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
771Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
772version.
773This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
774the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
775&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
776some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
777restrictions applied to it).
778.endblockquote
779.next
780.cindex "SPA authentication"
781.cindex "Samba project"
782.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
783Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
784by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
785Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
786under the Gnu GPL.
787.next
788.cindex "Cyrus"
789.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
790.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
791Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
792by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
793Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
794conditions expressed therein.
795
796.blockquote
797Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
798
799Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
800modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
801are met:
802
803.olist
804Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
805notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
806.next
807Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
808notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
809the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
810distribution.
811.next
812The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
813endorse or promote products derived from this software without
814prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
815details, please contact
816.display
817 Office of Technology Transfer
818 Carnegie Mellon University
819 5000 Forbes Avenue
820 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
821 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
822 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
823.endd
824.next
825Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
826acknowledgment:
827
828&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
829at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
830
831CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
832THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
833AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
834FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
835WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
836AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
837OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
838.endlist
839.endblockquote
840
841.next
842.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
843.cindex "X-windows"
844.cindex "Athena"
845The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
846modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
847This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
848below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
849
850.blockquote
851Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
852and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
853
854All Rights Reserved
855
856Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
857documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
858provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
859both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
860supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
861used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
862software without specific, written prior permission.
863
864DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
865ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
866DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
867ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
868WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
869ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
870SOFTWARE.
871.endblockquote
872
873.next
874.new
875.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
876The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
877The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
878derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
879license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
880source code.
881.wen
882
883.next
884Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
885not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
886contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
887.endlist
888
889
890
891
892
893. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
894. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
895
896.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
897 "Receiving and delivering mail"
898
899
900.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
901.cindex "design philosophy"
902Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
903to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
904most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
905maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
906it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
907has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
908
909
910.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
911.cindex "policy control" "overview"
912Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
913Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
914&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
915unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
916facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
917
918.ilist
919.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
920Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
921incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
922series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
923several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
924host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
925very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
926rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
927two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
928error code.
929.next
930An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
931case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
932.next
933When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
934provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
935spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
936which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
937.next
938When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
939host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
940function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
941whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
942is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
943.next
944Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
945software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
946Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
947.next
948After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
949the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
950runs at the start of every delivery process.
951.endlist
952
953
954
955.section "User filters" "SECID12"
956.cindex "filter" "introduction"
957.cindex "Sieve filter"
958In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
959setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
960chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
961configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
962&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
963of filtering are available:
964
965.ilist
966Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
967by RFC 3028.
968.next
969Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
970powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
971.endlist
972
973User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
974
975
976
977.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
978.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
979.cindex "format" "of message id"
980.cindex "id of message"
981.cindex "base62"
982.cindex "base36"
983.cindex "Darwin"
984.cindex "Cygwin"
985Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
986characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
987example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
988normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
989system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
990(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
991id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
992not always case-sensitive.
993
994.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
995The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
996Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
997within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
998be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
999the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
1000somewhat eccentric:
1001
1002.ilist
1003The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1004started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1005contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1006way of representing the date and time of day).
1007.next
1008After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1009received the message.
1010.next
1011There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1012.olist
1013.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1014If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1015time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1016that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1017systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1018.next
1019If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1020the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1021(1/100) of a second.
1022.endlist
1023.endlist
1024
1025After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1026appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1027received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1028pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1029will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1030
1031
1032.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1033.cindex "receiving mail"
1034.cindex "message" "reception"
1035The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1036TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1037SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1038there are several possibilities:
1039
1040.ilist
1041If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1042non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1043command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1044.next
1045If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1046non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1047the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1048command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1049but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1050envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1051.next
1052If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1053interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1054passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1055This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1056example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1057.next
1058A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1059(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1060does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1061in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1062.endlist
1063
1064
1065.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1066.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1067In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1068constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1069qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1070option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1071SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1072certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1073unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1074address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1075different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1076users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1077users to change sender addresses.
1078
1079Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1080checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1081(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1082number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1083individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1084requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1085&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1086
1087Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1088received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1089connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1090queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1091configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1092message is received.
1093
1094
1095
1096
1097
1098.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1099.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1100.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1101When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1102first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1103the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1104the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1105file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1106
1107.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1108By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1109&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1110not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1111improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1112used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1113whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1114processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1115overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1116affect file system performance.
1117
1118The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1119the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1120any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1121a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1122first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1123
1124.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1125Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1126(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1127both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1128If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1129example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1130generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1131rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1132different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1133addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1134delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1135&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1136
1137
1138
1139.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1140.cindex "message" "life of"
1141.cindex "message" "frozen"
1142A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1143its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1144administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1145cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1146recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1147spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1148
1149.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1150.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1151An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1152corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1153addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1154to be sent.
1155
1156.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1157.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1158There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1159&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1160The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1161
1162.cindex "message" "log file for"
1163.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1164While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1165attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1166delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1167lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1168These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1169deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1170The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1171&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1172systems.
1173
1174.cindex "journal file"
1175.cindex "file" "journal"
1176All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1177spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1178address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1179message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1180addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1181is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1182Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1183minimize the possibility of data loss.
1184
1185Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1186the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1187time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1188updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1189deliveries caused by crashes.
1190
1191
1192
1193.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1194.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1195.cindex "router" "definition of"
1196.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1197The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1198&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1199number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1200specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1201ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1202
1203.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1204Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1205of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1206you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1207option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1208instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1209instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1210configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1211the driver's features in general.
1212
1213A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1214its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1215converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1216alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1217to be bounced.
1218
1219A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1220spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1221transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1222&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1223to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1224several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1225
1226.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1227An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1228turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1229specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1230detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1231address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1232
1233To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1234routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1235routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1236configuration.
1237
1238The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1239addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1240are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1241is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1242its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1243match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1244find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1245assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1246configured to fail the address.
1247
1248The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1249&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1250aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1251original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1252router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1253address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1254
1255The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1256address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1257see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1258local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1259the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1260the address is bounced.
1261
1262
1263
1264.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1265.cindex "router" "for verification"
1266.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1267As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1268are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1269one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1270sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1271&%-bvs%& command line options.
1272
1273When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1274does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1275detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1276when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1277sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1278previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1279checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1280would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1281
1282
1283
1284
1285.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1286.cindex "router" "running details"
1287.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1288.cindex "router" "result of running"
1289As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1290running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1291passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1292the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1293the following:
1294
1295.ilist
1296&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1297transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1298original address ceases,
1299.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1300unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1301can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1302for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1303passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1304end of routing.
1305
1306Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1307starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1308setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1309child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1310&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1311.next
1312&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1313requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1314is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1315&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1316must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1317.next
1318&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1319recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1320this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1321set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1322&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1323.next
1324&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1325the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1326original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1327.next
1328&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1329database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1330processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1331next time the message is considered for delivery.
1332.next
1333&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1334its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1335.endlist
1336
1337If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1338any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1339situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1340making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1341router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1342
1343Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1344met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1345You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1346when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1347facility for this purpose.
1348
1349
1350.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1351.cindex "case of local parts"
1352.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1353.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1354Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1355and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1356check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1357actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1358routed addresses are shown.
1359
1360
1361
1362.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1363.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1364.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1365The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1366order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1367described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1368
1369.ilist
1370The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1371the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1372suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1373skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1374removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1375of any other conditions.
1376.next
1377Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1378only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1379&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1380address.
1381Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1382&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1383sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1384you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1385.new "Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose."
1386.next
1387If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1388run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1389when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1390makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1391having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1392.next
1393Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1394opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1395.new "Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification."
1396.next
1397Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1398check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1399.next
1400If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1401of domains that it defines.
1402.next
1403.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1404.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1405.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1406If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1407the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1408&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1409part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1410that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1411that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1412&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1413.next
1414.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1415.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1416.vindex "&$home$&"
1417If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1418an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1419local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1420user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1421remaining preconditions.
1422.next
1423If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1424because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1425later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1426subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1427could lead to confusion.
1428.next
1429If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1430set of addresses that it defines.
1431.next
1432If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1433specified files is tested.
1434.next
1435.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1436If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1437uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1438Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1439.endlist
1440
1441
1442Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1443it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1444part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1445&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1446&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1447going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1448example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1449
1450
1451
1452.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1453.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1454When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1455
1456.ilist
1457If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1458filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1459message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1460fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1461files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1462filtering'&.
1463.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1464(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1465
1466Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1467&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1468filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1469if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1470be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1471condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1472filter.
1473.next
1474Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1475its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1476address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1477can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1478processed entirely independently of each other.
1479.next
1480.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1481.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1482A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1483transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1484is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1485Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1486from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1487process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1488which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1489.next
1490When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1491handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1492doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1493local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1494collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1495addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1496address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1497addresses to the same domain.
1498.next
1499Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1500non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1501deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1502to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1503run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1504one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1505The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1506deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1507.next
1508.cindex "queue runner"
1509When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1510database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1511address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1512Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1513reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1514queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1515follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1516better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1517causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1518.next
1519.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1520Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1521deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1522retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1523reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1524not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1525.next
1526If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1527appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1528for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1529messages to other addresses.
1530.next
1531.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1532If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1533the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1534&'deferred'&.
1535.next
1536When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1537handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1538deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1539.endlist
1540
1541
1542
1543
1544.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1545.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1546.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1547.cindex "queue runner"
1548Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1549attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1550uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1551intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1552not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1553first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1554its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1555passed its retry time.
1556You can run several queue runners at once.
1557
1558Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1559address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1560should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1561bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1562error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1563as permanent.
1564
1565
1566
1567.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1568.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1569There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1570particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1571connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1572detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1573Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1574is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1575impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1576also apply.
1577
1578If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1579waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1580connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1581deferred,
1582.cindex "hints database"
1583Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1584SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1585for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1586connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1587one connection.
1588
1589
1590
1591.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1592.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1593.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1594When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1595bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1596errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1597delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1598many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1599attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1600message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1601See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1602
1603.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1604Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1605failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1606automatically.
1607
1608.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1609A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1610obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1611address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1612forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1613failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1614&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1615of the list.
1616
1617
1618
1619.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1620.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1621If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1622itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1623but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1624that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1625for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1626&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631
1632. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1633. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1634
1635.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1636.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1637
1638.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1639Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1640creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1641&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1642
1643.table2 140pt
1644.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1645.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1646 documented"
1647.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1648.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1649.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1650.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1651 instructions"
1652.endtable
1653
1654Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1655following subdirectories are created:
1656
1657.table2 140pt
1658.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1659.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1660.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1661.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1662.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1663.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1664.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1665.endtable
1666
1667The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1668with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1669that may be useful to some sites.
1670
1671
1672.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1673.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1674The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1675a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1676source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1677Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1678system.
1679.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1680Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1681the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1682architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1683overridden if necessary.
1684
1685
1686.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687.cindex "PCRE library"
1688Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1690to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1691system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696If your operating system has no
1697PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1700
1701.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1708
1709.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1717
1718.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725Berkeley DB library.
1726
1727Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1729possibilities:
1730
1731.olist
1732A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1734.next
1735.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739file name is used unmodified.
1740.next
1741.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1745.next
1746If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1749.next
1750To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17522.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1753numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1754versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1755&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1756.next
1757.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1758Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1759&url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1760operates on a single file.
1761.endlist
1762
1763.cindex "USE_DB"
1764.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1765Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1766to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1767USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1768&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1769.code
1770USE_DB=yes
1771.endd
1772Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1773error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1774
1775At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1776thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1777configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1778Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1779configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1780&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1781
1782As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1783necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1784in one of these lines:
1785.code
1786DBMLIB = -ldb
1787DBMLIB = -ltdb
1788.endd
1789Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1790place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1791the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1792file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1793this example:
1794.code
1795INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1796DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1797.endd
1798There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1799file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1800
1801
1802
1803.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1804.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1805.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1806.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1807.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1808Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1809independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1810&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1811&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1812therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1813building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1814&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1815
1816There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1817without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1818(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1819(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1820maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1821a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1822
1823There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1824at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1825machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1826directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1827you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1828detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1829be logged.
1830
1831.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1832Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1833access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1834facilities, you need to set
1835.code
1836WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1837.endd
1838in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1839chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1840
1841
1842.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1843.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1844If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1845required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1846your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1847happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1848&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1849
1850This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1851operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1852to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1853configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1854defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1855do this.
1856
1857
1858
1859.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1860.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1861.cindex "RFC 2047"
1862The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1863described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1864in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1865character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1866mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1867(default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1868supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1869
1870However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1871very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1872&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1873systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1874&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1875.code
1876HAVE_ICONV=yes
1877.endd
1878to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1879
1880
1881
1882.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1883.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1884.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1885.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1886.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1887.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1888Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1889command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1890start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1891&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1892line option).
1893
1894If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1895OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1896implementing SSL.
1897
1898If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1899.code
1900SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1901TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1902.endd
1903in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1904OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1905.code
1906SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1907TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1908TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1909.endd
1910.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1911If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1912.code
1913SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1914USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1915.endd
1916.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1917If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1918.code
1919SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1920USE_GNUTLS=yes
1921TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1922.endd
1923in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1924library and include files. For example:
1925.code
1926SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1927USE_GNUTLS=yes
1928TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1929TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1930.endd
1931.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1932If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1933.code
1934SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1935USE_GNUTLS=yes
1936USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1937.endd
1938
1939You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1940specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1941given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1942
1943
1944
1945
1946.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1947
1948.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1949.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1950.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1951.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1952Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1953SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1954alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1955already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1956should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1957&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1958&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1959EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1960you might have
1961.code
1962USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1963CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1964EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1965.endd
1966in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1967files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1968.code
1969exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1970.endd
1971in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1972the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1973All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1974can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1975&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1976configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1977further details.
1978
1979
1980.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1981.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1982Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1983&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1984it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1985where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1986library files.
1987
1988Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1989defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1990currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1991as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1992over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1993if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1994this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1995support has not been tested for some time.
1996
1997
1998
1999.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2000.cindex "lookup modules"
2001.cindex "dynamic modules"
2002.cindex ".so building"
2003On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2004the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2005on demand.
2006This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2007library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2008dependencies.
2009Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2010
2011Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2012installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2013measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2014for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2015Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2016see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2017
2018Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2019&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2020For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2021on demand:
2022.code
2023LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2024LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2025LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2026.endd
2027
2028
2029.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2030.cindex "build directory"
2031Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2032created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2033operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2034For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2035&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2036.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2037Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2038
2039&*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2040building process fails if it is set.
2041
2042If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2043a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2044&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2045&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2046then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2047number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2048makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2049directory, should this ever be necessary.
2050
2051If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2052&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2053FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2054
2055
2056
2057.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2058The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2059unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2060output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2061appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2062each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2063get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2064.code
2065FULLECHO='' make -e
2066.endd
2067The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2068command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2069given in addition to the short output.
2070
2071
2072
2073.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2074.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2075The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2076consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2077values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2078more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2079convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2080order:
2081.display
2082&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2083&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2084&_Local/Makefile_&
2085&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2086&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2087&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2088&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2089.endd
2090.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2091.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2092.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2093where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2094architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2095process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2096and are often not needed.
2097
2098The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2099called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2100the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2101values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2102Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2103fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2104of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2105that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2106to find out what values are being used on your system.
2107
2108
2109&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2110therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2111needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2112file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2113default values are.
2114
2115
2116.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2117If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2118or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2119need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2120putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2121.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2122when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2123formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2124compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2125called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2126Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2127default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2128containing the lines
2129.code
2130CC=cc
2131CFLAGS=-std1
2132.endd
2133If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2134these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2135
2136Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2137files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2138the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2139
2140
2141.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2142.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2143.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2144.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2145Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2146lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2147not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2148and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2149which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2150case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2151.code
2152LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2153LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2154LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2155.endd
2156and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2157&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2158libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2159.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2160However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2161the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2162files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2163binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2164errors.
2165
2166.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2167.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2168Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2169about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2170being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2171makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2172variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2173name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2174&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2175with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2176syntax. For instance:
2177.code
2178LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2179LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2180AUTH_GSASL=yes
2181AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2182AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2183AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2184.endd
2185
2186.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2187Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2188subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2189.code
2190EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2191.endd
2192must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2193chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2194
2195.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2196The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2197operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2198with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2199monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2200The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2201.code
2202X11=/usr/X11R6
2203XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2205.endd
2206These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2207example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2208.code
2209X11=/usr/openwin
2210XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2211XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2212.endd
2213If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2214definition of all three of these variables into your
2215&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2216
2217.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2218If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2219variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2220default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2221command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2222
2223.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2224There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2225use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2226EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2227binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2228libraries.
2229
2230.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2231The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2232files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2233necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2234&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2235
2236
2237.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2238.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2239.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2240The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2241&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2242normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2243recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2244are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2245
2246
2247
2248.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2249.cindex "building Eximon"
2250A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2251where the files that are involved are
2252.display
2253&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2254&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2255&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2256&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2257&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2258&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2259.endd
2260.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2261As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2262&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2263&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2264variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2265EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2266LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2267.ecindex IIDbuex
2268
2269
2270.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2271.cindex "installing Exim"
2272.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2273The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2274arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2275whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2276.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2277The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2278going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2279&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2280install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2281some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2282it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2283chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2284
2285.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2286Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2287in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2288exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2289by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2290is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2291alternative files, no default is installed.
2292
2293.cindex "system aliases file"
2294.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2295One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2296default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2297The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2298SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2299If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2300and outputs a comment to the user.
2301
2302The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2303aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2304kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2305&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2306Exim's configuration if necessary.
2307
2308The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2309and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2310running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2311directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2312other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2313over SMTP.
2314
2315It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2316distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2317command such as
2318.code
2319make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2320.endd
2321This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2322paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2323configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2324For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2325but this usage is deprecated.
2326
2327.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2328Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2329&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2330upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2331directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2332INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2333
2334For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2335to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2336installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2337for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2338called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2339of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2340from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2341
2342.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2343If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2344real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2345command:
2346.code
2347make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2348.endd
2349The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2350script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2351the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2352directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2353command:
2354.code
2355(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2356.endd
2357.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2358There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2359
2360.ilist
2361&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2362to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2363.next
2364&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2365installed binary.
2366.endlist
2367
2368INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2369.code
2370make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2371.endd
2372The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2373to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2374without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2375.code
2376make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2377.endd
2378
2379
2380
2381.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2382.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2383Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2384reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2385distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2386&<<SECTavail>>&).
2387
2388If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2389source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2390install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2391
2392
2393
2394.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2395.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2396When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2397exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2398directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2399necessary.
2400
2401
2402
2403
2404.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2405.cindex "testing" "installation"
2406Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2407syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2408Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2409.code
2410exim -bV
2411.endd
2412If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2413Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2414the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2415other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2416Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2417example,
2418.display
2419&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2420.endd
2421should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2422.display
2423&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2424.endd
2425a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2426This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2427user agent. For example:
2428.code
2429exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2430From: user@your.domain.example
2431To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2432Subject: Testing Exim
2433
2434This is a test message.
2435^D
2436.endd
2437The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2438In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2439arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2440
2441.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2442If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2443&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2444of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2445&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2446with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2447.display
2448&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2449.endd
2450You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2451produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2452For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2453relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2454&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2455
2456.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2457.cindex "lock files"
2458One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2459local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2460&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2461writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2462is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2463directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2464that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2465&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2466approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2467&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2468agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2469see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2470
2471One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2472the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2473&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2474port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2475&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2476incoming SMTP mail.
2477
2478Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2479be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2480within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2481that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2482production version.
2483
2484
2485.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2486.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2487Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2488general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2489is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2490operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2491binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2492normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2493or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2494.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2495a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2496privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2497and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2498
2499.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2500.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2501Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2502example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2503&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2504described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2505as follows:
2506.code
2507sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2508send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2510newaliases /usr/bin/true
2511.endd
2512Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2513your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2514favourite user agent.
2515
2516You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2517have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2518various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2519command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2520use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2521&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2522
2523
2524
2525.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2526.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2527If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2528version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2529call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2530to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2531new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2532version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2533configuration file.
2534
2535
2536
2537
2538.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2539.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2540The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2541.code
2542/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2543.endd
2544If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2545fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2546for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2547(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2548solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2549.code
2550pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2551.endd
2552to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2553
2554Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2555still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2556(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2557
2558
2559
2560
2561. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2562. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2563
2564.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2565.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2566.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2567Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2568each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2569options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2570some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2571combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2572The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2573
2574
2575.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2576.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2577If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2578were present before any other options.
2579The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2580standard output.
2581This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2582that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2583&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2584
2585.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2586If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2587were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2588&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2589format.
2590
2591.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2592If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2593&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2594Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2595
2596.cindex "&'runq'&"
2597.cindex "queue runner"
2598If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2599were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2600option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2601
2602.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2603.cindex "alias file" "building"
2604.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2605If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2606&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2607This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2608the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2609command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2610
2611
2612.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2613Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2614available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2615user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2616EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2617&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2618
2619.ilist
2620.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2621.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2622The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2623&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2624supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2625configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2626
2627.cindex '&"From"& line'
2628.cindex "envelope sender"
2629Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2630&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2631Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2632See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2633users to set envelope senders.
2634
2635.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2636.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2637For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2638header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2639&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2640
2641Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2642protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2643locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2644have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2645users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2646that are available to trusted users.
2647.next
2648.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2649.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2650The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2651Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2652The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2653
2654Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2655operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2656necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2657the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2658
2659By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2660Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2661However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2662option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2663
2664Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2665is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2666false.
2667.endlist
2668
2669
2670&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2671edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2672getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2673&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2674
2675
2676
2677
2678.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2679Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2680of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2681a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2682format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2683on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2684with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2685outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2686
2687. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2688. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2689. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2690. creates a man page for the options.
2691. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2692
2693.literal xml
2694<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2695.literal off
2696
2697
2698.vlist
2699.vitem &%--%&
2700.oindex "--"
2701.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2702This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2703therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2704rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2705
2706.vitem &%--help%&
2707.oindex "&%--help%&"
2708This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2709The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2710no arguments.
2711
2712.vitem &%--version%&
2713.oindex "&%--version%&"
2714This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2715displayed.
2716
2717.new
2718.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2719 &%-Am%&
2720.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2721.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2722These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2723ignored by Exim.
2724.wen
2725
2726.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2727.oindex "&%-B%&"
2728.cindex "8-bit characters"
2729.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2730This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2731clean; it ignores this option.
2732
2733.vitem &%-bd%&
2734.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2735.cindex "daemon"
2736.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2737.cindex "queue runner"
2738This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2739the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2740that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2741
2742The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2743(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2744disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2745stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2746
2747By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2748all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2749ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2750&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2751
2752When a listening daemon
2753.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2754.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2755is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2756configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2757in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2758PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2759running as root.
2760
2761When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2762process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2763used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2764
2765The SIGHUP signal
2766.cindex "SIGHUP"
2767.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2768can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2769whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2770means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2771of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2772referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2773because these are reread each time they are used.
2774
2775.vitem &%-bdf%&
2776.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2777This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2778from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2779
2780.vitem &%-be%&
2781.oindex "&%-be%&"
2782.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2783.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2784Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2785prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2786files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2787of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2788
2789If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2790to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2791used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2792function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2793test data. A line history is supported.
2794
2795Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2796continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2797continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2798string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2799configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2800message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2801is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2802
2803&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2804files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2805the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2806of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2807
2808.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2809.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2810.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2811.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2812This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2813of a file. For example:
2814.code
2815exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2816.endd
2817The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2818message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2819variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2820no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2821recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2822&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2823line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2824&%-be%&).
2825
2826.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2828.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2829.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2830This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2831tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2832system filters are recognized.
2833
2834.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2835.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2836.cindex "filter" "testing"
2837.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2838.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2839.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2840.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2841This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2842to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2843there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2844supplied.
2845
2846If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2847can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2848filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2849.code
2850exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2851.endd
2852This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2853variables that are used by the user filter.
2854
2855If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2856.code
2857# Exim filter
2858# Sieve filter
2859.endd
2860it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2861that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2862&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2863redirection lists.
2864
2865The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2866detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2867with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2868separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2869
2870When testing a filter file,
2871.cindex "&""From""& line"
2872.cindex "envelope sender"
2873.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2874the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2875or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2876that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2877can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2878options).
2879
2880.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2881.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2882.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2883This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2884tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2885&$qualify_domain$&.
2886
2887.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2888.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2889This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2890tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2891process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2892suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2893actually being delivered.
2894
2895.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2896.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2897This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2898file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2899prefix.
2900
2901.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2902.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2903This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2904file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2905suffix.
2906
2907.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2908.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2909.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2910.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2911.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2912.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2913.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2914.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2915This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2916standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2917after a full stop. For example:
2918.code
2919exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2920exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2921.endd
2922When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2923of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2924conversion to the canonical form is
2925&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2926
2927Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2928include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2929This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2930messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2931test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2932
2933&*Warning 1*&:
2934.cindex "RFC 1413"
2935You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2936information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2937an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2938connection.
2939
2940&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2941are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2942occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2943
2944Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2945written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2946lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2947can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2948and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2949session were authenticated.
2950
2951The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2952output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2953acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2954
2955Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2956plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2957specialized SMTP test program such as
2958&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2959
2960.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2961.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2962This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2963verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2964updating the callout cache database.
2965
2966.vitem &%-bi%&
2967.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2968.cindex "alias file" "building"
2969.cindex "building alias file"
2970.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2971Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2972Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2973this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2974tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2975recognized.
2976
2977If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2978configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2979the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2980The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2981use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2982if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2983&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2984
2985.new
2986. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2987.vitem &%-bI:help%&
2988.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2989.cindex "querying exim information"
2990We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2991information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2992consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2993synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2994options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2995
2996.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2997.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2998.cindex "DSCP" "values"
2999This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3000recognised DSCP names.
3001
3002.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3003.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3004.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3005This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3006Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3007useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3008&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3009compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3010way to guarantee a correct response.
3011.wen
3012
3013.vitem &%-bm%&
3014.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3015.cindex "local message reception"
3016This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3017locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3018command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3019argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3020default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3021if no other conflicting option is present.
3022
3023If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3024qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3025options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3026suppressing this for special cases.
3027
3028Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3029the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3030
3031.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3032The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3033action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3034
3035The format
3036.cindex "message" "format"
3037.cindex "format" "message"
3038.cindex "&""From""& line"
3039.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3040.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3041of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3042compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3043.code
3044From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3045From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3046.endd
3047(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3048is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3049authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3050matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3051option, which can be changed if necessary.
3052
3053.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3054The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3055&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3056preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3057trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3058
3059.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3060.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3061.cindex "testing", "malware"
3062.cindex "malware scan test"
3063This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3064using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3065this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3066the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3067not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3068will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3069
3070Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3071using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3072user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3073This option requires admin privileges.
3074
3075The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3076there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3077administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3078
3079.vitem &%-bnq%&
3080.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3081.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3082By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3083without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3084is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3085envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3086&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3087defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3088
3089Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3090being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3091content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3092header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3093syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3094
3095The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3096messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3097addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3098unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3099
3100
3101.vitem &%-bP%&
3102.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3103.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3104.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3105If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3106main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3107of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3108arguments, for example:
3109.code
3110exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3111.endd
3112.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3113.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3114.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3115However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3116configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3117users, the output is as in this example:
3118.code
3119mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3120.endd
3121If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3122configuration file is output.
3123If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3124is the name of the file that was actually used.
3125
3126.new
3127.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3128If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3129name will not be output.
3130.wen
3131
3132.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3133.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3134If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3135directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3136respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3137sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3138written directly into the spool directory.
3139
3140If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3141.code
3142exim -bP +local_domains
3143.endd
3144it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3145local part) and outputs what it finds.
3146
3147.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3148.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3149.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3150If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3151followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3152that driver are output. For example:
3153.code
3154exim -bP transport local_delivery
3155.endd
3156The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3157options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3158using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3159&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3160settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3161&%authenticators%&.
3162
3163.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3164If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3165are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3166for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3167The output format is one item per line.
3168
3169.vitem &%-bp%&
3170.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3171.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3172.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3173This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3174standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3175just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3176admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3177to allow any user to see the queue.
3178
3179Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3180.code
318125m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3182 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3183 <other addresses>
3184.endd
3185.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3186.cindex "size" "of message"
3187The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3188(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3189identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3190envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3191&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3192the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3193before the sender address.
3194
3195.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3196If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3197&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3198
3199The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3200displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3201been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3202expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3203displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3204complete.
3205
3206
3207.vitem &%-bpa%&
3208.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3209This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3210that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3211alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3212of just &"D"&.
3213
3214
3215.vitem &%-bpc%&
3216.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3217.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3218This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3219to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3220&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3221
3222
3223.vitem &%-bpr%&
3224.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3225This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3226chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3227lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3228going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3229
3230.vitem &%-bpra%&
3231.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3232This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3233
3234.vitem &%-bpru%&
3235.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3236This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3237
3238
3239.vitem &%-bpu%&
3240.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3241This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3242addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3243forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3244router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3245
3246
3247.vitem &%-brt%&
3248.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3249.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3250.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3251This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3252arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3253and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3254.code
3255exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3256Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3257.endd
3258See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3259argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3260&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3261contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3262retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3263with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3264rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3265sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3266used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3267.code
3268exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3269Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3270.endd
3271
3272.vitem &%-brw%&
3273.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3274.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3275.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3276This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3277a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3278complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3279would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3280&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3281
3282.vitem &%-bS%&
3283.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3284.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3285.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3286This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3287for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3288submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3289input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3290input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3291&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3292believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3293
3294The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3295dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3296provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3297
3298As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3299messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3300Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3301&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3302
3303Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3304as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3305QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3306
3307.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3308If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3309error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3310was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3311was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3312
3313More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3314&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3315
3316.vitem &%-bs%&
3317.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3318.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3319.cindex "local SMTP input"
3320This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3321on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3322policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3323Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3324messages to the MTA.
3325
3326In
3327.cindex "sender" "source of"
3328this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3329set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3330Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3331the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3332&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3333&%-bnq%& option is used.
3334
3335.cindex "inetd"
3336The
3337&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3338using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3339whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3340&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3341above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3342Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3343the listening daemon.
3344
3345.vitem &%-bt%&
3346.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3347.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3348.cindex "address" "testing"
3349This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3350as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3351written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3352user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3353sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3354
3355If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3356right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3357
3358Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3359&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3360security issues.
3361
3362Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3363(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3364written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3365&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3366genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3367program.
3368
3369.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3370The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3371failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3372code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3373
3374.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3375&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3376addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3377This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3378always shown.
3379
3380&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3381routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3382message,
3383.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3384you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3385&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3386default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3387whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3388those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3389doing such tests.
3390
3391.vitem &%-bV%&
3392.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3393.cindex "version number of Exim"
3394This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3395number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3396It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3397specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3398name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3399
3400As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3401configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3402values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3403detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3404alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3405realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3406dynamic testing facilities.
3407
3408.vitem &%-bv%&
3409.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3410.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3411.cindex "address" "verification"
3412This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3413taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3414not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3415happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3416(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3417including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3418
3419If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3420failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3421usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3422
3423If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3424right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3425
3426Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3427&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3428security issues.
3429
3430Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3431that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3432router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3433verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3434address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3435
3436If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3437address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3438latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3439causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3440addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3441and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3442to succeed.
3443
3444When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3445and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3446considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3447
3448The
3449.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3450return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3451failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3452code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3453
3454If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3455address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3456sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3457calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3458
3459.vitem &%-bvs%&
3460.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3461This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3462than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3463might happen.
3464
3465.vitem &%-bw%&
3466.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3467.cindex "daemon"
3468.cindex "inetd"
3469.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3470This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3471similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3472and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3473
3474In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3475listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3476inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3477each port only when the first connection is received.
3478
3479If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3480which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3481
3482.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3483.oindex "&%-C%&"
3484.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3485.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3486.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3487This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3488list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3489compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3490name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3491file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3492proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3493
3494When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3495from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3496runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3497However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3498file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3499which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3500listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3501CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3502not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3503
3504Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3505configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3506even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3507running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3508delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3509test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3510on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3511
3512If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3513prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3514must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3515However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3516CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3517usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3518unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3519
3520ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3521to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3522broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3523configuration file.
3524
3525The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3526syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3527caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3528require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3529specified by this option.
3530
3531
3532.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3533.oindex "&%-D%&"
3534.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3535This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3536(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3537unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3538If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3539completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3540
3541If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3542colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3543supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3544not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3545the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3546to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3547regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3548
3549The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3550command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3551string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3552synonymous:
3553.code
3554exim -DABC ...
3555exim -DABC= ...
3556.endd
3557To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3558quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3559example:
3560.code
3561exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3562.endd
3563&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3564
3565
3566.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3567.oindex "&%-d%&"
3568.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3569.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3570This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3571error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3572database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3573filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3574writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3575return code.
3576
3577When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3578standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3579some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3580made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3581of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3582debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3583no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3584are:
3585.display
3586&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3587&`auth `& authenticators
3588&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3589&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3590&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3591&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3592&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3593&`filter `& filter handling
3594&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3595&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3596&`ident `& ident lookup
3597&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3598&`lists `& matching things in lists
3599&`load `& system load checks
3600&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3601 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3602&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3603&`memory `& memory handling
3604&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3605&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3606&`queue_run `& queue runs
3607&`receive `& general message reception logic
3608&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3609&`retry `& retry handling
3610&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3611&`route `& address routing
3612&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3613&`tls `& TLS logic
3614&`transport `& transports
3615&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3616&`verify `& address verification logic
3617&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3618.endd
3619The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3620for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3621tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3622is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3623generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3624turn everything off.
3625
3626.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3627.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3628The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3629with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3630unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3631rather than stderr.
3632
3633The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3634&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3635However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3636daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3637automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3638run in parallel.
3639
3640The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3641of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3642in processing.
3643
3644If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3645any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3646
3647.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3648.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3649This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3650starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3651subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3652behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3653
3654.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3655.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3656This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3657handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3658described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3659
3660.vitem &%-E%&
3661.oindex "&%-E%&"
3662.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3663This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3664failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3665and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3666generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3667could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3668follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3669new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3670
3671.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3672.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3673There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3674called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3675example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3676form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3677
3678.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3679.oindex "&%-F%&"
3680.cindex "sender" "name"
3681.cindex "name" "of sender"
3682This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3683message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3684entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3685their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3686between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3687
3688.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3689.oindex "&%-f%&"
3690.cindex "sender" "address"
3691.cindex "address" "sender"
3692.cindex "trusted users"
3693.cindex "envelope sender"
3694.cindex "user" "trusted"
3695This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3696message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3697by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3698users to use it.
3699
3700Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3701trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3702options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3703of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3704domain.
3705
3706There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3707can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3708never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3709string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3710examples of shell commands:
3711.code
3712exim -f '<>' user@domain
3713exim -f "" user@domain
3714.endd
3715In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3716with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3717&%-bv%& options.
3718
3719Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3720it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3721refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3722though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3723
3724White
3725.cindex "&""From""& line"
3726space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3727given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3728locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3729&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3730if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3731
3732.vitem &%-G%&
3733.oindex "&%-G%&"
3734.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3735.new
3736This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3737.code
3738control = suppress_local_fixups
3739.endd
3740for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3741bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3742in future.
3743
3744As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3745this option.
3746.wen
3747
3748.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3749.oindex "&%-h%&"
3750.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3751This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3752Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3753headers.)
3754
3755.vitem &%-i%&
3756.oindex "&%-i%&"
3757.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3758.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3759This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3760line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3761no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3762command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3763
3764.new
3765.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3766.oindex "&%-L%&"
3767.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3768This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3769file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3770Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3771read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3772effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3773
3774The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3775.wen
3776
3777.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3778.oindex "&%-M%&"
3779.cindex "forcing delivery"
3780.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3781.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3782This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3783any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3784delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3785and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3786
3787Retry
3788.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3789hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3790the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3791to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3792which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3793for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3794
3795The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3796not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3797produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3798use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3799
3800.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3801.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3802.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3803.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3804This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3805message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3806id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3807active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3808can be used only by an admin user.
3809
3810.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3811 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3812.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3813.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3814.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3815.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3816This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3818an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3819given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3820must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3821
3822.vitem &%-MCA%&
3823.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3824This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3825by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3826connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3827
3828.vitem &%-MCP%&
3829.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3830This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3831by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3832which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3833
3834.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3835.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3836This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3837by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3838started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3839together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3840signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3841messages through the same SMTP connection.
3842
3843.vitem &%-MCS%&
3844.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3845This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3846by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3847SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3848connection.
3849
3850.vitem &%-MCT%&
3851.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3852This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3853by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3854host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3855
3856.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3857.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3858.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3859.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3860This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3861but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3862that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3863provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3864order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3865However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3866respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3867overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3868If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3869&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3870and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3871
3872.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3873.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3874.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3875.cindex "sender" "changing"
3876This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3877given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3878&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3879be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3880is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3881This option can be used only by an admin user.
3882
3883.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3884.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3885.cindex "freezing messages"
3886.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3887This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3888prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3889either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3890However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3891attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3892user.
3893
3894.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3895.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3896.cindex "giving up on messages"
3897.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3898.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3899This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3900including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3901their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3902is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3903Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3904user.
3905
3906.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3907.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3908.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3909This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3910as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3911message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3912altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3913
3914.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3915.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3916.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3917.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3918.cindex "removing recipients"
3919This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3920(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3921the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3922addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3923(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3924can be used only by an admin user.
3925
3926.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3927.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3928.cindex "removing messages"
3929.cindex "abandoning mail"
3930.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3931This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3932bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3933the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3934only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3935placed on the queue.
3936
3937.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3938.oindex "&%-Mset%&
3939.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3940.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3941This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3942string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3943the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3944&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3945available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3946make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3947user. See also &%-bem%&.
3948
3949.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3950.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3951.cindex "thawing messages"
3952.cindex "unfreezing messages"
3953.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3954.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3955This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3956&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3957messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3958by an admin user.
3959
3960.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3961.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3962.cindex "listing" "message body"
3963.cindex "message" "listing body of"
3964This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3965written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3966
3967.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3968.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3969.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3970.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3971This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3972be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3973only by an admin user.
3974
3975.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3976.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3977.cindex "listing" "message headers"
3978.cindex "header lines" "listing"
3979.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3980This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3981written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3982
3983.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3984.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3985.cindex "listing" "message log"
3986.cindex "message" "listing message log"
3987This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3988the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3989
3990.vitem &%-m%&
3991.oindex "&%-m%&"
3992This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3993treats it that way too.
3994
3995.vitem &%-N%&
3996.oindex "&%-N%&"
3997.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3998.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3999This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4000level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4001it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4002had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4003database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4004than &"=>"&.
4005
4006Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4007user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4008words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4009which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4010address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4011routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4012the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4013for that message.
4014
4015.new
4016.vitem &%-n%&
4017.oindex "&%-n%&"
4018This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4019For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4020When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4021.wen
4022
4023.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4024.oindex "&%-O%&"
4025This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4026Exim.
4027
4028.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4029.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4030.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4031This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4032alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4033description above.
4034
4035.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4036.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4037.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4038.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4039.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4040This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4041be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4042transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4043
4044.vitem &%-odb%&
4045.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4046.cindex "background delivery"
4047.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4048This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4049including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4050messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4051delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4052processes to finish.
4053
4054When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4055leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4056and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4057This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4058
4059If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4060(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4061overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4062setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4063
4064.vitem &%-odf%&
4065.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4066.cindex "foreground delivery"
4067.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4068This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4069accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4070&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4071and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4072
4073The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4074process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4075during deliveries.
4076
4077However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4078false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4079
4080If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4081message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4082process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4083restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4084
4085
4086.vitem &%-odi%&
4087.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4088This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4089Sendmail.
4090
4091.vitem &%-odq%&
4092.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4093.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4094.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4095.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4096This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4097including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4098not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4099are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4100process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4101&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4102conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4103forces queueing.
4104
4105.vitem &%-odqs%&
4106.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4107.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4108This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4109However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4110&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4111configuration file is in effect.
4112
4113When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4114message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4115also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4116in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4117done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4118runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4119messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4120host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4121configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4122&%-qq%& option.
4123
4124.vitem &%-oee%&
4125.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4126.cindex "error" "reporting"
4127If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4128example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4129message.
4130
4131.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4132Provided
4133this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4134exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4135is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4136This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4137
4138.vitem &%-oem%&
4139.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4140.cindex "error" "reporting"
4141.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4142This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4143return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4144This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4145
4146.vitem &%-oep%&
4147.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4148.cindex "error" "reporting"
4149If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4150error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4151.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4152The return code is 1 for all errors.
4153
4154.vitem &%-oeq%&
4155.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4156.cindex "error" "reporting"
4157This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4158effect as &%-oep%&.
4159
4160.vitem &%-oew%&
4161.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4162.cindex "error" "reporting"
4163This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4164effect as &%-oem%&.
4165
4166.vitem &%-oi%&
4167.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4168.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4169This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4170line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4171single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4172lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4173&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4174
4175.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4176.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4177This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4178
4179.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4180.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4181.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4182A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4183with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4184over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4185&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4186other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4187
4188The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4189number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4190.code
4191exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4192.endd
4193An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4194followed by a colon and the port number:
4195.code
4196exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4197.endd
4198The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4199port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4200are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4201whichever one is last.
4202
4203.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4204.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4205.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4206See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4207option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4208name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4209This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4210authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4211
4212.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4213.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4214.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4215See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4216option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4217This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4218where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4219&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4220
4221.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4222.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4223.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4224See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4225option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4226overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4227messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4228default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4229specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4230&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4231
4232.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4233.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4234.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4235See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4236option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4237using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4238&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4239
4240.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4241.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4242.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4243.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4244See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4245option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4246&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4247or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4248SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4249&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4250one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4251be set by &%-oMr%&.
4252
4253.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4254.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4255.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4256See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4257option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4258present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4259uses the name it is given.
4260
4261.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4262.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4263.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4264See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4265option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4266local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4267used, when there is no default.
4268
4269.vitem &%-om%&
4270.oindex "&%-om%&"
4271.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4272In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4273message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4274expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4275
4276.vitem &%-oo%&
4277.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4278.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4279This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4280whatever that means.
4281
4282.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4283.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4284.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4285.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4286This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4287value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4288written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4289without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4290because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4291
4292.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4293.oindex "&%-or%&"
4294.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4295This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4296set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4297by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4298described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4299
4300.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4301.oindex "&%-os%&"
4302.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4303.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4304This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4305applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4306the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4307for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4308
4309.vitem &%-ov%&
4310.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4311This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4312
4313.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4314.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4315.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4316.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4317.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4318This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4319is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4320of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4321in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4322file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4323
4324.vitem &%-pd%&
4325.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4326.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4327This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4328chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4329option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4330needed.
4331
4332.vitem &%-ps%&
4333.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4334.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4335This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4336chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4337option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4338started.
4339
4340.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4341.oindex "&%-p%&"
4342For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4343.display
4344&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4345.endd
4346It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4347host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4348Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4349to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4350or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4351
4352.vitem &%-q%&
4353.oindex "&%-q%&"
4354.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4355This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4356configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4357relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4358and &%-S%& options).
4359
4360.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4361The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4362waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4363for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4364process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4365have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4366
4367If
4368.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4369.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4370.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4371the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4372passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4373proceeding.
4374
4375When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4376process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4377mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4378this to be repeated periodically.
4379
4380Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4381random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4382If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4383MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4384
4385It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4386order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4387&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4388
4389.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4390The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4391behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4392appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4393
4394.vitem &%-qq...%&
4395.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4396.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4397.cindex "queue" "routing"
4398.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4399An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4400stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4401every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4402transports are run.
4403
4404.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4405The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4406is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4407complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4408place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4409delivered down a single SMTP
4410.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4411.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4412.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4413connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4414This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4415intermittently.
4416
4417.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4418.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4419.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4420If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4421those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4422delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4423&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4424
4425.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4426.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4427.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4428.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4429If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4430message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4431their retry times are tried.
4432
4433.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4434.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4435.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4436If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4437frozen or not.
4438
4439.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4440.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4441.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4442The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4443be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4444for later delivery.
4445
4446.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4447.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4448When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4449lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4450starting message id. For example:
4451.code
4452exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4453.endd
4454Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4455second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4456are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4457.code
4458exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4459.endd
4460just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4461&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4462that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4463mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4464are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4465queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4466
4467.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4468.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4469.cindex "periodic queue running"
4470When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4471starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4472(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4473&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4474single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4475combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4476.code
4477/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4478.endd
4479Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4480process every 30 minutes.
4481
4482When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4483pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4484
4485.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4486.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4487This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4488compatibility.
4489
4490.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4491.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4492This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4493
4494.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4495.oindex "&%-R%&"
4496.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4497.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4498.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4499The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4500is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4501which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4502<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4503
4504This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4505perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4506queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4507address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4508way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4509regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4510
4511If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4512you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4513.code
4514exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4515.endd
4516This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4517every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4518applied to each queue run.
4519
4520Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4521are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4522information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4523means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4524existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4525address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4526will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4527information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4528address will be skipped.
4529
4530.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4531If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4532all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4533&'ff'& is present.
4534
4535The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4536to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4537command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4538effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4539an arbitrary command instead.
4540
4541.vitem &%-r%&
4542.oindex "&%-r%&"
4543This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4544
4545.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4546.oindex "&%-S%&"
4547.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4548.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4549This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4550message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4551conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4552has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4553
4554.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4555.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4556This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4557recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4558&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4559
4560.vitem &%-t%&
4561.oindex "&%-t%&"
4562.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4563.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4564.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4565.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4566When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4567input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4568from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4569from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4570takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4571
4572.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4573If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4574is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4575the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4576and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4577Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4578Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4579argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4580Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4581instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4582&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4583
4584.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4585If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4586recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4587lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4588with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4589&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4590
4591RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4592message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4593added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4594not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4595nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4596In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4597are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4598once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4599&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4600
4601.vitem &%-ti%&
4602.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4603This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4604compatibility with Sendmail.
4605
4606.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4607.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4608.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4609.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4610This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4611incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4612&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4613&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4614
4615
4616.vitem &%-U%&
4617.oindex "&%-U%&"
4618.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4619Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4620documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4621syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4622set. Exim ignores this option.
4623
4624.vitem &%-v%&
4625.oindex "&%-v%&"
4626This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4627describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4628receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4629dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4630the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4631selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4632unconditional.
4633
4634.vitem &%-x%&
4635.oindex "&%-x%&"
4636AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4637National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4638It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4639this option.
4640
4641.new
4642.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4643.oindex "&%-X%&"
4644This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4645to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4646.wen
4647.endlist
4648
4649.ecindex IIDclo1
4650.ecindex IIDclo2
4651
4652
4653. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4654. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4655. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4656. creates a man page for the options.
4657. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4658
4659.literal xml
4660<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4661.literal off
4662
4663
4664
4665
4666
4667. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4668. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4669
4670
4671.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4672 "The runtime configuration file"
4673
4674.cindex "run time configuration"
4675.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4676.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4677.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4678.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4679.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4680Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4681binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4682because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4683control.
4684
4685If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4686writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4687The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4688errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4689not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4690actually alter the string.
4691
4692The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4693reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4694most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4695give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4696existing file in the list.
4697
4698.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4699.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4700.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4701.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4702.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4703.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4704The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4705specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4706configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4707group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4708CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4709
4710&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4711to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4712easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4713CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4714who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4715
4716Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4717be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4718since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4719compromise the Exim user account.
4720
4721A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4722is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4723defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4724configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4725CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4726&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4727configuration.
4728
4729
4730
4731.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4732.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4733A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4734option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4735&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4736unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4737CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4738is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4739is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4740installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4741specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4742
4743Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4744with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4745listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4746testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4747delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4748Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4749the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4750can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4751message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4752&%-M%&).
4753
4754If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4755prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4756start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4757There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4758name can be used with &%-C%&.
4759
4760One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4761option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4762configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4763non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4764If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4765completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4766
4767The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4768to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4769necessarily be discarded.
4770WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4771considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4772values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4773is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4774transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4775values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4776
4777Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4778share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4779If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4780looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4781and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4782file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4783each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4784
4785In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4786different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4787help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4788
4789
4790
4791.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4792.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4793.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4794Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4795option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4796are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4797is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4798optional parts are:
4799
4800.ilist
4801&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4802&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4803.next
4804.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4805&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4806are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4807.next
4808&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4809addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4810&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4811.next
4812&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4813define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4814&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4815.next
4816&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4817If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4818defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4819are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4820&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4821.next
4822&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4823when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4824chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4825.next
4826&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4827want to use this feature, you must set
4828.code
4829LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4830.endd
4831in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4832facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4833.endlist
4834
4835.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4836.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4837.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4838Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4839
4840Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4841leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4842# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4843and does not introduce a comment.
4844
4845Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4846the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4847backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4848lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4849appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4850
4851A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4852default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4853change settings as required.
4854
4855The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4856described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4857respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4858items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4859onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4860described.
4861
4862
4863
4864.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4865.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4866.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4867.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4868.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4869You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4870using this syntax:
4871.display
4872&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4873&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4874.endd
4875on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4876the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4877second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4878name is required.
4879
4880Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4881configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4882If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4883because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4884
4885The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4886comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4887for example:
4888.code
4889hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4890 .include /some/file
4891.endd
4892Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4893process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4894inclusion appears.
4895
4896
4897
4898.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4899.cindex "macro" "description of"
4900.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4901If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4902&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4903definition, and must be of the form
4904.display
4905<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4906.endd
4907The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4908in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4909continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4910space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4911a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4912
4913Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4914definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4915ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4916
4917.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4918Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4919files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4920scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4921replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4922for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4923the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4924define
4925.display
4926&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4927&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4928.endd
4929but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4930error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4931before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4932consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4933line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4934comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4935
4936
4937.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4938Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4939(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4940&'='&. For example:
4941.code
4942MAC = initial value
4943...
4944MAC == updated value
4945.endd
4946Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4947subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4948the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4949Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4950.code
4951MAC = initial value
4952...
4953MAC == MAC and something added
4954.endd
4955This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4956from a number of other files.
4957
4958.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4959The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4960&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4961used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4962using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4963file to be ignored.
4964
4965
4966
4967.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4968As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4969up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4970strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4971.code
4972ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4973 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4974.endd
4975This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4976.code
4977data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4978.endd
4979In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4980address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4981section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4982
4983
4984.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4985.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4986.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4987You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4988&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4989portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4990read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4991
4992The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4993be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4994that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4995line. Thus:
4996.code
4997.ifdef AAA
4998message_size_limit = 50M
4999.else
5000message_size_limit = 100M
5001.endif
5002.endd
5003sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
5004otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5005is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5006obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5007
5008Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5009it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5010in this line"& will always be true.
5011
5012Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5013to clarify complicated nestings.
5014
5015
5016
5017.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5018.cindex "common option syntax"
5019.cindex "syntax of common options"
5020.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5021For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5022each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5023lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5024these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5025space) and then the value. For example:
5026.code
5027qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5028.endd
5029.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5030.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5031.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5032Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5033accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5034line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5035word &"hide"&. For example:
5036.code
5037hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5038.endd
5039For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5040.code
5041mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5042.endd
5043If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5044all instances of the same driver.
5045
5046The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5047that are found in option settings.
5048
5049
5050.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5051.cindex "format" "boolean"
5052.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5053.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5054.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5055Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5056different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5057the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5058if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5059boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5060&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5061the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5062.code
5063queue_only
5064queue_only = true
5065.endd
5066The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5067.code
5068no_queue_only
5069queue_only = false
5070.endd
5071You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5072
5073
5074
5075
5076.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5077.cindex "integer configuration values"
5078.cindex "format" "integer"
5079If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5080hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5081number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5082with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5083hexadecimal number.
5084
5085If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5086it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5087of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
50881024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5089and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5090used.
5091
5092
5093.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5094.cindex "integer format"
5095.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5096If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5097interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5098Such options are always output in octal.
5099
5100
5101.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5102.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5103.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5104If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5105integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5106
5107
5108
5109.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5110.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5111.cindex "format" "time interval"
5112A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5113the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5114
5115.table2 30pt
5116.irow &%s%& seconds
5117.irow &%m%& minutes
5118.irow &%h%& hours
5119.irow &%d%& days
5120.irow &%w%& weeks
5121.endtable
5122
5123For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5124intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5125is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5126
5127
5128
5129.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5130.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5131.cindex "format" "string"
5132If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5133or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5134consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5135the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5136removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5137Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5138appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5139therefore equivalent:
5140.code
5141trusted_users = uucp:mail
5142trusted_users = uucp:\
5143 # This comment line is ignored
5144 mail
5145.endd
5146.cindex "string" "quoted"
5147.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5148If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5149double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5150continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5151
5152.table2 100pt
5153.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5154.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5155.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5156.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5157.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5158.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5159 character"
5160.endtable
5161
5162If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5163character, that character replaces the pair.
5164
5165Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5166insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5167trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5168current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5169in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5170and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5171
5172
5173.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5174.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5175Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5176by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5177circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5178is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5179strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5180However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5181backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5182within a quoted configuration string.
5183
5184
5185.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5186.cindex "user name" "format of"
5187.cindex "format" "user name"
5188.cindex "groups" "name format"
5189.cindex "format" "group name"
5190User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5191above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5192either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5193&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5194
5195
5196.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5197.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5198.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5199.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5200The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5201default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5202the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5203&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5204are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5205particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5206&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5207
5208In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5209input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5210&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5211in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5212on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5213start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5214example, the list
5215.code
5216local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5217.endd
5218contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5219
5220&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5221list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5222colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5223be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5224
5225.section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5226.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5227.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5228Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5229introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5230with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5231character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5232above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5233.code
5234local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5235.endd
5236This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5237&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5238confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5239
5240.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5241.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5242It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5243code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5244must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5245are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5246sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5247interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5248generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5249.code
5250domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5251.endd
5252This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5253to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5254expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5255the value in quotes. For example:
5256.code
5257local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5258.endd
5259Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5260doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5261set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5262enclosing an empty list item.
5263
5264
5265
5266.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5267.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5268An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5269separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5270.code
5271senders = user@domain :
5272.endd
5273contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5274in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5275items, the second of which is empty:
5276.code
5277senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5278.endd
5279&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5280are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5281would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5282just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5283.code
5284senders = :
5285.endd
5286In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5287is at the end of the list.
5288
5289
5290
5291
5292.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5293.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5294There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5295and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5296instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5297a sequence of lines like this:
5298.display
5299<&'instance name'&>:
5300 <&'option'&>
5301 ...
5302 <&'option'&>
5303.endd
5304In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5305followed by three options settings:
5306.code
5307localuser:
5308 driver = accept
5309 check_local_user
5310 transport = local_delivery
5311.endd
5312For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5313setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5314settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5315deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5316a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5317described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5318
5319You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5320the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5321
5322The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5323passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5324transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5325authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5326them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5327server.
5328
5329.cindex "generic options"
5330.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5331Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5332and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5333same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5334&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5335.cindex "private options"
5336The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5337they all have default values.
5338
5339The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5340precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5341this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5342
5343Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5344elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5345with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5346a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5347instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5348confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5349configuration lines:
5350.code
5351remote_smtp:
5352 driver = smtp
5353.endd
5354create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5355&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5356different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5357instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5358thus:
5359.code
5360special_smtp:
5361 driver = smtp
5362 port = 1234
5363 command_timeout = 10s
5364.endd
5365The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5366these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5367lines.
5368
5369Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5370list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5371defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5372option.
5373
5374
5375
5376
5377
5378
5379. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5380. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5381
5382.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5383.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5384.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5385The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5386is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5387the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5388configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5389of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5390itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5391initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5392mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5393
5394
5395
5396.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5397The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5398file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5399the line
5400.code
5401# primary_hostname =
5402.endd
5403This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5404to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5405can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5406it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5407
5408The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5409.code
5410domainlist local_domains = @
5411domainlist relay_to_domains =
5412hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5413.endd
5414These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5415domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5416domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5417configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5418
5419The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5420later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5421on the local host.
5422
5423.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5424There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5425of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5426called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5427be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5428the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5429
5430The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5431list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5432controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5433domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5434domain is permitted.
5435
5436The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5437used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5438that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5439loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5440submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5441hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5442
5443Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5444we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5445and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5446
5447The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5448.code
5449acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5450acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5451.endd
5452These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5453during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5454command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5455respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5456&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5457section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5458accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5459to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5460contents of a message to be checked.
5461
5462Two commented-out option settings are next:
5463.code
5464# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5465# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5466.endd
5467These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5468content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5469scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5470details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5471
5472Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5473.code
5474# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5475# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5476# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5477.endd
5478These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5479support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5480first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5481connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5482other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5483key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5484More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5485
5486Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5487.code
5488# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5489# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5490.endd
5491.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5492.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5493.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5494.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5495.cindex "smtps protocol"
5496.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5497.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5498These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5499server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5500TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5501more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5502on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5503port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5504configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5505non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5506&<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5507
5508Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5509.code
5510# qualify_domain =
5511# qualify_recipient =
5512.endd
5513The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5514complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5515receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5516the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5517you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5518addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5519
5520.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5521The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5522addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5523(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5524.code
5525# allow_domain_literals
5526.endd
5527The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5528Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5529quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5530try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5531people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5532&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5533
5534The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5535.code
5536never_users = root
5537.endd
5538It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5539convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5540setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5541The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5542list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5543FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5544contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5545FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5546
5547When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5548Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5549line,
5550.code
5551host_lookup = *
5552.endd
5553specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5554in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5555information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5556or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5557Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5558because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5559unreachable.
5560
5561The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
55621413 (hence their names):
5563.code
5564rfc1413_hosts = *
5565rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5566.endd
5567These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5568You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5569that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5570Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5571messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5572result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5573delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5574
5575When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5576be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5577if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5578find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5579.code
5580# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5581# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5582.endd
5583show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5584and recipient addresses, respectively.
5585
5586The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5587.code
5588# percent_hack_domains =
5589.endd
5590It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5591This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5592anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5593
5594The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5595concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5596message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5597occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5598address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5599bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5600are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5601always bounce messages.
5602.code
5603ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5604timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5605.endd
5606The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5607discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5608message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5609after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5610bounce message ever lasts a week.
5611
5612
5613
5614.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5615.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5616.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5617In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5618It starts with the line
5619.code
5620begin acl
5621.endd
5622and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5623&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5624and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5625
5626.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5627The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5628RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5629are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5630rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5631result of the ACL processing.
5632.code
5633acl_check_rcpt:
5634.endd
5635This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5636ACL, and names it.
5637.code
5638accept hosts = :
5639.endd
5640This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5641But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5642names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5643list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5644host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5645important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5646
5647What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5648messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5649input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5650manner.
5651.code
5652deny message = Restricted characters in address
5653 domains = +local_domains
5654 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5655
5656deny message = Restricted characters in address
5657 domains = !+local_domains
5658 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5659.endd
5660These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5661characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5662Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5663&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5664in Internet mail addresses.
5665
5666The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5667addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5668option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5669in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5670programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5671at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5672characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5673policy of being as safe as possible.
5674
5675The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5676to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5677first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5678&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5679reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5680&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5681
5682The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5683block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5684or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5685have to modify this rule.
5686
5687Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5688allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5689common convention of local parts constructed as
5690&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5691the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5692with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5693file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5694that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5695is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5696
5697The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5698allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5699and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5700with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5701local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5702and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5703(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5704.code
5705accept local_parts = postmaster
5706 domains = +local_domains
5707.endd
5708This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5709local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5710&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5711reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5712&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5713
5714The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5715by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5716in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5717.code
5718require verify = sender
5719.endd
5720This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5721ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5722address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5723see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5724addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5725used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5726discusses the details of address verification.
5727.code
5728accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5729 control = submission
5730.endd
5731This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5732hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5733verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5734that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5735second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5736is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5737messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5738&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5739probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5740.code
5741accept authenticated = *
5742 control = submission
5743.endd
5744This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5745Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5746likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5747authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5748examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5749fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5750.code
5751require message = relay not permitted
5752 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5753.endd
5754This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5755one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5756.code
5757require verify = recipient
5758.endd
5759This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5760fails, the address is rejected.
5761.code
5762# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5763# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5764# $dnslist_text
5765# dnslists = black.list.example
5766#
5767# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5768# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5769# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5770# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5771.endd
5772These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5773sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5774from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5775line.
5776.code
5777# require verify = csa
5778.endd
5779This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5780authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5781records.
5782.code
5783accept
5784.endd
5785The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5786address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5787.code
5788acl_check_data:
5789.endd
5790This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5791of this ACL are commented out:
5792.code
5793# deny malware = *
5794# message = This message contains a virus \
5795# ($malware_name).
5796.endd
5797These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5798viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5799suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5800virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5801.code
5802# warn spam = nobody
5803# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5804# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5805# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5806# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5807.endd
5808These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5809SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5810and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5811&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5812series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5813whatever the spam score.
5814.code
5815accept
5816.endd
5817This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5818
5819
5820.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5821.cindex "default" "routers"
5822.cindex "routers" "default"
5823The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5824by the line
5825.code
5826begin routers
5827.endd
5828Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5829messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5830accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5831matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5832manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5833.code
5834# domain_literal:
5835# driver = ipliteral
5836# domains = !+local_domains
5837# transport = remote_smtp
5838.endd
5839.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5840This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5841support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5842you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5843&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5844.code
5845dnslookup:
5846 driver = dnslookup
5847 domains = ! +local_domains
5848 transport = remote_smtp
5849 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5850 no_more
5851.endd
5852The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5853domains. This is specified by the line
5854.code
5855domains = ! +local_domains
5856.endd
5857The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5858exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5859that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5860the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5861indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5862passed on to the following routers.
5863
5864The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5865and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5866the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5867instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5868one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5869
5870The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5871DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5872router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5873specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5874in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5875the address fails and is bounced.
5876
5877The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5878be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5879encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5880whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5881Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5882email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5883continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5884out.
5885.code
5886system_aliases:
5887 driver = redirect
5888 allow_fail
5889 allow_defer
5890 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5891# user = exim
5892 file_transport = address_file
5893 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5894.endd
5895Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5896domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5897alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5898data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5899the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5900the next router.
5901
5902&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5903often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5904file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5905&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5906.code
5907userforward:
5908 driver = redirect
5909 check_local_user
5910# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5911# local_part_suffix_optional
5912 file = $home/.forward
5913# allow_filter
5914 no_verify
5915 no_expn
5916 check_ancestor
5917 file_transport = address_file
5918 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5919 reply_transport = address_reply
5920.endd
5921This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5922redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5923individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5924local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5925router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5926namely:
5927.code
5928# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5929# local_part_suffix_optional
5930.endd
5931.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5932show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5933is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5934by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5935variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5936presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5937the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5938
5939When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5940home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5941declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5942redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5943
5944.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5945Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5946files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5947is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5948of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5949filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5950separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5951
5952The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5953verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5954There are two reasons for doing this:
5955
5956.olist
5957Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5958checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5959unnecessary work.
5960.next
5961More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5962command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5963The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5964It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5965this time.
5966.endlist
5967
5968The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5969address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5970works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5971forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5972
5973The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5974forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5975auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5976.code
5977a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5978.endd
5979the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5980transport.
5981.code
5982localuser:
5983 driver = accept
5984 check_local_user
5985# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5986# local_part_suffix_optional
5987 transport = local_delivery
5988.endd
5989The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5990part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5991the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5992routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5993same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5994
5995
5996.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5997.cindex "default" "transports"
5998.cindex "transports" "default"
5999Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6000only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6001not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6002.code
6003begin transports
6004.endd
6005One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6006.code
6007remote_smtp:
6008 driver = smtp
6009.endd
6010This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
6011options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6012.code
6013local_delivery:
6014 driver = appendfile
6015 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6016 delivery_date_add
6017 envelope_to_add
6018 return_path_add
6019# group = mail
6020# mode = 0660
6021.endd
6022This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6023traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6024local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6025directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6026under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6027show how this can be done.
6028
6029Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6030&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6031similarly-named options above.
6032.code
6033address_pipe:
6034 driver = pipe
6035 return_output
6036.endd
6037This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6038redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6039option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6040sender.
6041.code
6042address_file:
6043 driver = appendfile
6044 delivery_date_add
6045 envelope_to_add
6046 return_path_add
6047.endd
6048This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6049redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6050&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6051.code
6052address_reply:
6053 driver = autoreply
6054.endd
6055This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6056filter files.
6057
6058
6059
6060.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6061.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6062.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6063The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6064Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6065introduced by the line
6066.code
6067begin retry
6068.endd
6069In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6070errors:
6071.code
6072* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6073.endd
6074This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
60752 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
60761.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6077is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6078
6079If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6080if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6081temporary errors into permanent errors.
6082
6083
6084.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6085The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6086.code
6087begin rewrite
6088.endd
6089contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6090rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6091
6092
6093
6094.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6095.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6096The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6097.code
6098begin authenticators
6099.endd
6100defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6101configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6102which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6103standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6104mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6105to support most MUA software.
6106
6107The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6108.code
6109#PLAIN:
6110# driver = plaintext
6111# server_set_id = $auth2
6112# server_prompts = :
6113# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6114# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6115.endd
6116And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6117.code
6118#LOGIN:
6119# driver = plaintext
6120# server_set_id = $auth1
6121# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6122# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6123# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6124.endd
6125
6126The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6127in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6128&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6129that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6130i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6131when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6132when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6133need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6134
6135The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6136password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6137To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6138expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6139
6140Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6141usercode and password are in different positions.
6142Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6143
6144.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6145
6146
6147
6148. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6149. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6150
6151.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6152
6153.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6154.cindex "PCRE"
6155Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6156uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6157matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6158regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6159Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6160O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6161
6162The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6163are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6164description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6165the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6166the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6167case-insensitive.
6168
6169In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6170it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6171or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6172second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6173.code
6174domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6175.endd
6176The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6177precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6178of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6179regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6180backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6181normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6182matched.
6183
6184There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6185recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6186string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6187these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6188it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6189match anywhere in the subject string.
6190
6191In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6192you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6193.code
6194domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6195.endd
6196matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6197You need to use:
6198.code
6199domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6200.endd
6201if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6202$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6203
6204
6205
6206. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6207. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6208
6209.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6210.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6211.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6212.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6213Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6214messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6215
6216.olist
6217A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6218cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6219lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6220can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6221&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6222.next
6223Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6224way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6225returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6226succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6227chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6228.endlist
6229
6230String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6231that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6232involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6233if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6234time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6235chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6236
6237.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6238It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6239lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6240processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6241Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6242.code
6243domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6244domains = lsearch;/some/file
6245.endd
6246The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6247No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6248defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6249The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6250file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6251.code
6252192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6253192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6254.endd
6255When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6256possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6257
6258In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6259Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6260in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6261.code
6262domain1:
6263domain2:
6264.endd
6265Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6266matches the list item.
6267
6268It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6269Consider a file containing lines like this:
6270.code
6271192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6272.endd
6273If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6274first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6275causes a second lookup to occur.
6276
6277The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6278available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6279lookup is permitted.
6280
6281
6282.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6283.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6284.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6285Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6286
6287.ilist
6288The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6289and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6290lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6291.next
6292.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6293The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6294key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6295Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6296.endlist
6297
6298The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6299the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6300default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6301.code
6302LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6303LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6304.endd
6305which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6306For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6307libraries and header files before building Exim.
6308
6309
6310
6311
6312.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6313.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6314.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6315The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6316
6317.ilist
6318.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6319.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6320.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6321&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6322string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6323indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6324re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6325aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6326be found in several places:
6327.display
6328&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6329&url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6330&url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6331.endd
6332A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6333because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6334However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6335you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6336.next
6337.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6338.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6339.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6340&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6341DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6342zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6343&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6344
6345.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6346For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6347when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6348using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6349the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6350that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6351other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6352.next
6353.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6354.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6355.cindex "sasldb2"
6356.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6357&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6358interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6359ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6360authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6361&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6362&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6363.next
6364.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6365.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6366.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6367.cindex "Courier"
6368.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6369.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6370&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6371is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6372if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6373other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6374use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6375calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6376utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6377by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6378.next
6379.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6380.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6381&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6382whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6383contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6384the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6385symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6386lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6387&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6388.next
6389.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6390.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6391&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6392terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6393file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6394IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6395being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6396.code
63971.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6398192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6399"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6400"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6401.endd
6402The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6403file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6404key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6405&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6406&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6407
6408&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6409&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6410lookup types support only literal keys.
6411
6412&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6413the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6414&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6415.next
6416.cindex "linear search"
6417.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6418.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6419.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6420&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6421line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6422end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6423letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6424in the file is used.
6425
6426White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6427line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6428continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6429space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6430junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6431colon, for example:
6432.code
6433baduser: :fail:
6434.endd
6435Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6436middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6437that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6438wildcarding of any kind.
6439
6440.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6441.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6442In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6443characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6444If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6445matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6446contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6447quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6448quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6449
6450.next
6451.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6452.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6453.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6454&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6455the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6456&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6457reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6458aliases; the full map names must be used.
6459
6460.next
6461.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6462.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6463.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6464.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6465&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6466&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6467the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6468that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6469used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6470
6471.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6472Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6473file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6474&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6475
6476. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6477. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6478
6479.olist
6480The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6481.code
6482 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6483 *fish data for anythingfish
6484.endd
6485.next
6486The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6487example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6488.code
6489 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6490.endd
6491Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6492expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6493string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6494.code
6495 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6496.endd
6497The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6498expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6499For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6500.code
6501 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6502.endd
6503
6504If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6505either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6506ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6507colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6508escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6509
6510&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6511match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6512is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6513takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6514&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6515
6516.next
6517Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6518is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6519lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6520example:
6521.code
6522 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6523.endd
6524The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6525.endlist olist
6526
6527Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6528continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6529be followed by optional colons.
6530
6531&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6532&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6533lookup types support only literal keys.
6534.endlist ilist
6535
6536
6537.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6538.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6539.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6540The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6541many of them are given in later sections.
6542
6543.ilist
6544.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6545.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6546&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6547are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6548records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6549.next
6550.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6551.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6552&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6553.next
6554.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6555.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6556&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6557returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6558that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6559called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6560any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6561.next
6562.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6563.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6564&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6565MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6566.next
6567.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6568.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6569&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6570the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6571.next
6572.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6573.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6574&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6575Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6576.next
6577.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6578.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6579.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6580&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6581lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6582success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6583lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6584password value. For example:
6585.code
6586*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6587.endd
6588.next
6589.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6590.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6591&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6592PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6593
6594.next
6595.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6596.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6597&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6598that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6599
6600.next
6601&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6602not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6603.next
6604.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6605.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6606&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6607allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6608address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6609obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6610at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6611superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6612&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6613.code
6614require condition = \
6615 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6616.endd
6617The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6618the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6619this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6620one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6621.endlist
6622
6623
6624
6625.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6626.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6627Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6628completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6629reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6630options such as a list of local domains.
6631
6632When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6633of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6634temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6635or may give up altogether.
6636
6637
6638
6639.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6640.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6641.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6642.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6643.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6644.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6645In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6646that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6647
6648&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6649lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6650specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6651
6652If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6653and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6654provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6655
6656.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6657.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6658.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6659Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6660&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6661character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6662by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6663that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6664take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6665For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6666.code
6667data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6668.endd
6669Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6670looks up these keys, in this order:
6671.code
6672jane@eyre.example
6673*@eyre.example
6674*
6675.endd
6676The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6677&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6678complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6679Exim move on to try the next key.
6680
6681
6682
6683.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6684.cindex "partial matching"
6685.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6686.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6687.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6688.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6689The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6690match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6691being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6692information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6693domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6694a key in a DBM file is
6695.code
6696*.dates.fict.example
6697.endd
6698then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6699&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6700by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6701file.
6702
6703&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6704also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6705&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6706
6707Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6708keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6709be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6710partial matching keys
6711beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6712Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6713unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6714
6715Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6716the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6717is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6718is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6719fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6720start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6721remains.
6722
6723A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6724by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6725&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6726modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6727subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6728up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6729.code
67302250.dates.fict.example
6731*.2250.dates.fict.example
6732*.dates.fict.example
6733*.fict.example
6734.endd
6735As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6736finishes.
6737
6738.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6739.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6740The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6741changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6742formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6743parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6744.code
6745domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6746.endd
6747In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6748&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6749components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6750other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6751.code
6752domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6753.endd
6754For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6755&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6756
6757If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6758just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6759down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6760
6761.ilist
6762If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6763.next
6764If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6765example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6766.next
6767Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6768remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6769for &"*"& on its own.
6770.next
6771Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6772.endlist
6773
6774
6775If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6776&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6777this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6778specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6779prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6780lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6781&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6782
6783The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6784in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6785dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6786in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6787subject key is always followed by a dot.
6788
6789
6790
6791
6792.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6793.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6794.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6795Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6796lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6797of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6798single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6799
6800For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6801another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6802many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6803the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6804closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6805own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6806
6807The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6808strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6809complete.
6810
6811
6812
6813
6814.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6815.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6816.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6817When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6818is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6819the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6820.code
6821[name=$local_part]
6822.endd
6823will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6824For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6825.code
6826[name="$local_part"]
6827.endd
6828but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6829NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6830rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6831of the following form is provided:
6832.code
6833${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6834.endd
6835For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6836.code
6837[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6838.endd
6839See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6840operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6841lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6842
6843
6844
6845
6846.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6847.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6848.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6849.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6850The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6851of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6852an expansion string could contain:
6853.code
6854${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6855.endd
6856If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6857is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6858&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6859&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6860
6861The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, and TXT,
6862and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6863configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6864the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6865&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6866.code
6867${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6868.endd
6869If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6870altered and nothing is added.
6871
6872.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6873.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6874For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6875each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6876port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6877
6878For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6879single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6880concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6881depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6882between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6883by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6884.code
6885${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6886.endd
6887It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6888white space is ignored.
6889
6890.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6891.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6892For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6893unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6894character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6895items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6896default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6897.code
6898${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6899${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6900${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6901.endd
6902It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6903white space is ignored.
6904
6905.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6906.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6907By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6908each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6909the pseudo-type MXH:
6910.code
6911${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6912.endd
6913In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6914returned.
6915
6916.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6917Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6918records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6919component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6920records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6921error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6922but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6923top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6924.code
6925${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6926${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6927.endd
6928Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6929the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6930the name servers for &%edu%&.
6931
6932You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6933top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6934sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6935given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6936for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6937such a list.
6938
6939.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6940A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6941records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6942&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6943not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6944result of a successful lookup such as:
6945.code
6946${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6947.endd
6948has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6949The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6950authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6951
6952.new
6953.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6954The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
6955and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
6956(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
6957.code
6958${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
6959.endd
6960.wen
6961
6962
6963.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6964In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6965However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6966&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6967the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6968.code
6969${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6970${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6971${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6972.endd
6973In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6974the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6975to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6976case, it does not treat it as a list.
6977
6978The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6979in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6980different separator can be specified, as described above.
6981
6982The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6983temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6984an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6985type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6986&"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6987whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6988ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6989With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6990error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6991succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6992.code
6993${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6994${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6995.endd
6996Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6997yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6998
6999
7000
7001
7002.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7003.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7004.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7005.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7006The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7007become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7008implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7009contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7010the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7011it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7012indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7013your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7014.code
7015LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7016LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7017LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7018LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7019LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7020.endd
7021If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7022same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7023
7024There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7025the way they handle the results of a query:
7026
7027.ilist
7028&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7029gives an error.
7030.next
7031&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7032Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7033.next
7034&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7035from all of them are returned.
7036.endlist
7037
7038
7039For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7040Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7041the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7042First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7043
7044
7045.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7046.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7047An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7048the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7049.code
7050data = ${lookup ldap \
7051 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7052 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7053.endd
7054.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7055The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7056secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7057encrypted TLS connection is used.
7058
7059With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7060LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7061See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7062
7063
7064.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7065.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7066Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7067and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7068within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7069reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7070
7071The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7072filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7073the string:
7074.code
7075* => \2A
7076( => \28
7077) => \29
7078\ => \5C
7079.endd
7080in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7081to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7082.code
7083! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7084.endd
7085are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7086.code
7087${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7088.endd
7089yields
7090.code
7091%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7092.endd
7093Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7094.code
7095a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7096.endd
7097The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7098base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7099by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7100.code
7101, + " \ < > ;
7102.endd
7103It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7104before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7105is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7106.code
7107${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7108.endd
7109yields
7110.code
7111%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7112.endd
7113Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7114.code
7115\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7116.endd
7117There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7118authentication below.
7119
7120
7121.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7122.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7123The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7124is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7125an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7126by starting it with
7127.code
7128ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7129.endd
7130If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7131used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7132taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7133colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7134handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7135returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7136are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7137Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7138failures, and timeouts.
7139
7140For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7141of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7142&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7143doubled. For example
7144.code
7145ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7146.endd
7147If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7148to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7149the local host) is used.
7150
7151If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7152a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7153&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7154to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7155not available.
7156
7157For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7158for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7159can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7160the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7161.code
7162ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7163.endd
7164When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7165&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7166.code
7167${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7168.endd
7169When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7170a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7171specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7172socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7173&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7174or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7175the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7176backup host.
7177
7178If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7179specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7180&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7181
7182.ilist
7183Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7184interface.
7185.next
7186Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7187.endlist
7188
7189
7190Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7191&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7192
7193
7194
7195.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7196.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7197The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7198information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7199be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7200spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7201when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7202them. The following names are recognized:
7203.display
7204&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7205&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7206&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7207&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7208&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7209&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7210&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7211.endd
7212The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7213&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7214must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7215library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7216
7217The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7218backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7219enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7220network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7221&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7222LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7223if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7224SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7225Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7226
7227The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7228set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7229
7230
7231Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7232values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7233.code
7234${lookup ldap
7235 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7236 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7237 {$value}fail}
7238.endd
7239The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7240any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7241which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7242non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7243
7244The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7245connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7246on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7247
7248When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7249removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7250some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7251quoting has two advantages:
7252
7253.ilist
7254It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7255DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7256.next
7257It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7258.endlist
7259
7260For example, a setting such as
7261.code
7262USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7263.endd
7264should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7265
7266Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7267expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7268field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7269does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7270.code
7271PASS=${quote:$3}
7272.endd
7273The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7274SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7275&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7276
7277
7278
7279.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7280.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7281The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7282as a sequence of values, for example
7283.code
7284cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7285.endd
7286The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7287search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7288the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7289values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7290you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7291directory.
7292
7293In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7294result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7295has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7296
7297If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7298strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7299quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7300backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7301Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7302output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7303same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7304
7305Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7306LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7307&%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7308.code
7309ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7310value1.1, value1.2
7311
7312ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7313value two
7314
7315ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7316attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7317
7318ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7319objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7320.endd
7321The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7322individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7323make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7324results of LDAP lookups.
7325
7326
7327
7328
7329.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7330.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7331.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7332NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7333and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7334contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7335of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7336values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7337.code
7338[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7339.endd
7340might return the string
7341.code
7342name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7343home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7344.endd
7345(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7346.code
7347[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7348.endd
7349would just return
7350.code
7351Martin Guerre
7352.endd
7353with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7354for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7355operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7356
7357
7358
7359.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7360.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7361.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7362.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7363.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7364.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7365.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7366.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7367.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7368.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7369Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7370databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7371might be
7372.code
7373${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7374 {$value}fail}
7375.endd
7376If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7377field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7378.code
7379${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7380 {$value}}
7381.endd
7382might be
7383.code
7384home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7385.endd
7386Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7387quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7388field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7389.code
7390Mister X
7391.endd
7392If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7393with a newline between the data for each row.
7394
7395
7396.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7397.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7398.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7399.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7400.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7401.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7402.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7403.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7404.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7405If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7406&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7407option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7408information.
7409(For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7410queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7411&<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7412items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7413Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7414name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7415.code
7416hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7417.endd
7418Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7419&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7420option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7421.code
7422hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7423 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7424.endd
7425For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7426because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7427query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7428a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7429found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7430servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7431
7432The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7433convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7434respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7435itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7436addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7437for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7438characters are not special.
7439
7440.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7441For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7442it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7443done by starting the query with
7444.display
7445&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7446.endd
7447Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7448.olist
7449If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7450global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7451of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7452taken from there.
7453.next
7454If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7455.endlist
7456The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7457Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7458successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7459
7460This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7461are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7462master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7463like this:
7464.code
7465mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7466 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7467 master/db/name/pw
7468.endd
7469In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7470.code
7471${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7472.endd
7473That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7474the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7475option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7476.code
7477${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7478.endd
7479
7480
7481.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7482For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7483causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7484socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7485each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7486.display
7487<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7488 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7489.endd
7490Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7491the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7492
7493No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7494the queries.
7495
7496If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7497or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7498
7499&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7500anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7501is zero because no rows are affected.
7502
7503
7504.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7505PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7506This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7507However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7508database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7509looks like this:
7510.code
7511hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7512.endd
7513In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7514given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7515visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7516
7517If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7518update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7519affected.
7520
7521.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7522.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7523.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7524SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7525addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7526daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7527of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7528separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7529contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7530.code
7531${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7532 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7533.endd
7534In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7535.code
7536domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7537 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7538.endd
7539The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7540quote, which it doubles.
7541
7542The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7543internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7544update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7545are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7546waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7547to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7548option.
7549.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7550.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7551
7552
7553. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7554. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7555
7556.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7557 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7558 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7559.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7560A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7561email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7562contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7563are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7564arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7565
7566Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7567host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7568different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7569general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7570
7571
7572
7573.section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7574.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7575Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7576expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7577into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7578but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7579&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7580discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7581
7582
7583If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7584testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7585expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7586
7587If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7588other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7589misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7590the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7591expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7592.code
7593deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7594 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7595.endd
7596The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7597&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7598senders based on the receiving domain.
7599
7600
7601
7602
7603.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7604.cindex "list" "negation"
7605.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7606Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7607leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7608defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7609it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7610(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7611
7612The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7613subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7614subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7615subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7616was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7617.code
7618domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7619.endd
7620matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7621neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7622list is positive. However, if the setting were
7623.code
7624domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7625.endd
7626then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7627list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7628as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7629
7630Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7631the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7632item.
7633
7634
7635
7636.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7637.cindex "list" "file name in"
7638If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7639name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7640processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7641file names are not allowed,
7642and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7643Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7644lines:
7645
7646.ilist
7647For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7648file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7649.next
7650Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7651address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7652white space or the start of the line. For example:
7653.code
7654not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7655.endd
7656.endlist
7657
7658Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7659file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7660is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7661so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7662
7663If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7664within the file is inverted. For example, if
7665.code
7666hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7667.endd
7668and the file contains the lines
7669.code
7670!a.b.c
7671*.b.c
7672.endd
7673then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7674any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7675
7676
7677
7678.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7679As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7680to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7681confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7682an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7683sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7684non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7685always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7686
7687If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7688list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7689in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7690&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7691
7692
7693
7694
7695.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7696.cindex "named lists"
7697.cindex "list" "named"
7698A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7699which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7700particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7701places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7702the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7703a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7704locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7705.code
7706domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7707.endd
7708Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7709for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7710configured with the line
7711.code
7712domains = +local_domains
7713.endd
7714The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7715except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7716.code
7717dnslookup:
7718 driver = dnslookup
7719 domains = ! +local_domains
7720 transport = remote_smtp
7721 no_more
7722.endd
7723The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7724the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7725respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7726equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7727.code
7728hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7729addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7730.endd
7731A named list may refer to other named lists:
7732.code
7733domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7734domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7735domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7736.endd
7737&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7738effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7739out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7740.code
7741domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7742domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7743.endd
7744The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7745list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7746means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7747.code
7748domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7749.endd
7750where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7751referenced lists if you can.
7752
7753Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7754address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7755lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7756.code
7757domains = +local_domains
7758.endd
7759on several of your routers
7760or in several ACL statements,
7761the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7762if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7763references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7764the same each time they are referenced.
7765
7766By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7767extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7768is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7769hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7770
7771
7772
7773.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7774.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7775.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7776At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7777configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7778write
7779.code
7780ALIST = host1 : host2
7781auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7782.endd
7783it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7784.code
7785auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7786.endd
7787Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7788list, and write
7789.code
7790hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7791auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7792.endd
7793the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7794.code
7795auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7796.endd
7797
7798
7799.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7800.cindex "list" "caching of named"
7801.cindex "caching" "named lists"
7802While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7803it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7804the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7805that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7806an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7807message. For example:
7808.code
7809domainlist special_domains = \
7810 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7811.endd
7812This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7813address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7814in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7815cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7816same list each time.
7817
7818By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7819cache the result anyway. For example:
7820.code
7821domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7822.endd
7823If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7824the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7825
7826
7827
7828.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7829.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7830.cindex "list" "domain list"
7831Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7832The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7833
7834.ilist
7835.cindex "primary host name"
7836.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7837.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7838.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7839.cindex "@ in a domain list"
7840If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7841as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7842possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7843differ only in their names.
7844.next
7845.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7846.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7847.cindex "domain literal"
7848If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7849in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7850only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7851&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7852control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7853In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7854.next
7855.cindex "@mx_any"
7856.cindex "@mx_primary"
7857.cindex "@mx_secondary"
7858.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7859If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7860has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7861.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7862&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7863are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7864local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7865but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7866preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7867
7868The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7869performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7870example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7871resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7872options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7873
7874Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7875patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7876list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7877ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7878on a router). For example:
7879.code
7880domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7881.endd
7882This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7883the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7884
7885The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7886host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7887contain negative items.
7888
7889Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7890be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7891list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7892.code
7893domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7894 an.other.domain : ...
7895.endd
7896so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7897involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7898.code
7899domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7900 an.other.domain ? ...
7901.endd
7902.next
7903.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7904.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7905.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7906If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7907are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7908domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7909list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7910matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7911list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7912&'cipher.key.ex'&.
7913
7914.next
7915.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7916.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7917If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7918expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7919function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7920Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7921default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7922with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7923are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7924
7925&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7926must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7927use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7928it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7929expression by expansion, of course).
7930.next
7931.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7932.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7933If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7934semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7935must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7936&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7937.code
7938domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7939.endd
7940The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7941key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7942only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7943is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7944or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7945&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7946other statements in the same ACL.
7947
7948.next
7949Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7950&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7951.code
7952domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7953.endd
7954This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7955works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7956
7957.next
7958.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7959Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7960a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7961original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7962select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7963value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7964expansion variable.
7965.next
7966If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7967semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7968pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7969chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7970.code
7971hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7972 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7973.endd
7974In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7975example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7976whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7977&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7978variable and can be referred to in other options.
7979.next
7980.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7981If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7982between the pattern and the domain.
7983.endlist
7984
7985Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7986.code
7987domainlist funny_domains = \
7988 @ : \
7989 lib.unseen.edu : \
7990 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7991 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7992 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7993 nis;domains.byname : \
7994 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7995.endd
7996There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7997an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7998explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7999but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8000patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8001patterns earlier.
8002
8003
8004
8005.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8006.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8007.cindex "list" "host list"
8008Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8009example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8010may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8011two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8012pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8013You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8014involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8015
8016
8017.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8018.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8019.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8020If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8021involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8022process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8023not used.
8024
8025.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8026The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8027the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8028
8029
8030
8031.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8032.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8033If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8034the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8035&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8036list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8037systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8038concerns.)
8039
8040The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8041inspecting its IP address:
8042
8043.ilist
8044If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8045with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8046to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8047&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8048This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8049with the IP address of the subject host.
8050
8051If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8052lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8053ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8054temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8055what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8056
8057.next
8058.cindex "@ in a host list"
8059If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8060domain name, as just described.
8061
8062.next
8063If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8064subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8065IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8066be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8067separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8068without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8069IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8070that can never match a client host.
8071
8072.next
8073.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8074If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8075the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8076interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8077.code
8078accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8079accept hosts = @[]
8080.endd
8081.next
8082.cindex "CIDR notation"
8083If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8084example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8085host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8086included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8087specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8088significant end of the address.
8089
8090&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8091of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8092address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8093addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8094.code
8095192.168.23.236/31
8096.endd
8097matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
809832 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8099matches.
8100
8101Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8102.code
8103recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8104 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8105.endd
8106The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8107appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8108For example:
8109.code
8110recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8111.endd
8112could make use of a file containing
8113.code
8114172.16.0.0/12
81153ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8116.endd
8117to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8118addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8119changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8120.code
8121recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8122 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8123.endd
8124The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8125list.
8126.endlist
8127
8128
8129
8130.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8131 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8132.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8133When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8134address, the pattern takes this form:
8135.display
8136&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8137.endd
8138For example:
8139.code
8140hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8141.endd
8142The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8143IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8144letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8145&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8146quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8147returned by the lookup is not used.
8148
8149.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8150.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8151Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8152patterns of this form:
8153.display
8154&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8155.endd
8156For example:
8157.code
8158net24-dbm;/networks.db
8159.endd
8160The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8161length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8162mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8163is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8164&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8165
8166When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8167of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8168terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8169to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8170recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8171(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8172For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8173converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8174addresses are always used.
8175
8176Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8177colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8178However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8179configurations.
8180
8181&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8182IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8183the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8184case the IP address is used on its own.
8185
8186
8187
8188.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8189.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8190.cindex "unknown host name"
8191.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8192There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8193remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8194complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8195address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8196above.)
8197
8198If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8199patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8200Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8201DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8202Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8203effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8204Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8205
8206Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8207against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8208
8209By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8210if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8211&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8212are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8213security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8214for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8215Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8216discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8217found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8218
8219There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8220found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8221
8222.cindex "host" "alias for"
8223.cindex "alias for host"
8224As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8225of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8226
8227.ilist
8228.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8229If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8230the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8231&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8232requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8233expression.
8234.next
8235.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8236.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8237If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8238matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8239expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8240case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8241syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8242example,
8243.code
8244^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8245.endd
8246is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8247&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8248that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8249string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8250part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8251.code
8252sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8253.endd
8254&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8255&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8256example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8257required.
8258.endlist
8259
8260
8261
8262
8263.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8264.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8265While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8266name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8267from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8268behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8269
8270&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8271apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8272
8273.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8274.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8275Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8276lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8277Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8278does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8279To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8280&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8281not recognized in an indirected file).
8282
8283.ilist
8284If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8285cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8286.code
8287host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8288.endd
8289rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8290any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8291
8292.next
8293If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8294be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8295example:
8296.code
8297accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8298 192.168.4.5
8299.endd
8300accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8301whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8302name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8303.endlist
8304
8305Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8306list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8307list.
8308
8309.new
8310To explain the host/ip processing logic a different way for the same ACL:
8311
8312.ilist
8313If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8314IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8315addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8316.code
8317accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8318.endd
8319The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8320left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8321without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8322a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8323pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8324&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8325if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8326
8327.next
8328If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8329address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8330.code
8331accept hosts = *.friend.example
8332accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8333.endd
8334If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8335&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8336&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8337this section.
8338.endlist
8339.wen
8340
8341
8342
8343.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8344 "SECTtemdnserr"
8345.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8346.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8347.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8348A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8349&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8350host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8351&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8352section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8353host lists such as whitelists.
8354
8355
8356
8357.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8358 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8359.cindex "unknown host name"
8360.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8361If a pattern is of the form
8362.display
8363<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8364.endd
8365for example
8366.code
8367dbm;/host/accept/list
8368.endd
8369a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8370lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8371is not used.
8372
8373&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8374keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8375addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8376&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8377two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8378lookup, both using the same file.
8379
8380
8381
8382.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8383If a pattern is of the form
8384.display
8385<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8386.endd
8387the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8388data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8389&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8390.code
8391hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8392 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8393.endd
8394The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8395can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8396use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8397operator.
8398
8399If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8400looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8401&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8402
8403Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8404host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8405&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8406still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8407effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8408See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8409
8410
8411
8412.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8413 "SECTmixwilhos"
8414.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8415If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8416host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8417ACL you could have:
8418.code
8419accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8420.endd
8421The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8422It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8423item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8424compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8425&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8426IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8427
8428If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8429address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8430.code
8431accept hosts = *.friend.example
8432accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8433.endd
8434If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8435&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8436
8437
8438
8439
8440
8441.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8442.cindex "list" "address list"
8443.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8444.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8445Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8446is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8447always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8448list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8449using this option setting:
8450.code
8451senders = :
8452.endd
8453The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8454data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8455detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8456and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8457
8458Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8459example:
8460.code
8461senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8462.endd
8463A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8464character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8465semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8466subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8467with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8468the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8469wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8470.code
8471deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8472 *@+hostile_domains:\
8473 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8474 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8475.endd
8476.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8477.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8478If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8479specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8480treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8481
8482If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8483contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8484address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8485domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8486is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8487.code
8488deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8489.endd
8490
8491The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8492address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8493senders:
8494
8495.ilist
8496.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8497.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8498If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8499done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8500You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8501as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8502to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8503.code
8504deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8505 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8506.endd
8507The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8508start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8509
8510.next
8511.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8512Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8513lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8514example:
8515.code
8516deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8517 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8518 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8519.endd
8520Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8521lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8522not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8523always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8524
8525Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8526cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8527panic log.
8528.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8529However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8530&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8531default. For example, with this lookup:
8532.code
8533accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8534.endd
8535the file could contains lines like this:
8536.code
8537user1@domain1.example
8538*@domain2.example
8539.endd
8540and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8541that are tried is:
8542.code
8543nimrod@jaeger.example
8544*@jaeger.example
8545*
8546.endd
8547&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8548would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8549
8550&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8551.code
8552deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8553deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8554.endd
8555The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8556because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8557domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8558.endlist
8559
8560
8561The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8562If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8563always fails.
8564
8565
8566.ilist
8567.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8568.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8569.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8570If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8571(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8572split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8573it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8574from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8575of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8576
8577.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8578The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8579keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8580patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8581even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8582with
8583.code
8584deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8585.endd
8586the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8587.code
8588baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8589.endd
8590to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8591
8592.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8593If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8594has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8595may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8596but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8597surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8598.code
8599aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8600 spammer3 : spammer4
8601.endd
8602As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8603doubling.
8604
8605If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8606of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8607list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8608might have entries like
8609.code
8610aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8611xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8612*: ^\d{8}$
8613.endd
8614in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8615local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8616each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8617chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8618
8619.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8620It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8621them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8622
8623.next
8624The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8625lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8626can only return a single list of local parts.
8627.endlist
8628
8629&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8630in these two examples:
8631.code
8632senders = +my_list
8633senders = *@+my_list
8634.endd
8635In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8636example it is a named domain list.
8637
8638
8639
8640
8641.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8642.cindex "case of local parts"
8643.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8644.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8645Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8646case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8647Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8648Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8649blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8650lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8651default.
8652
8653The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8654address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8655comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8656the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8657that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8658keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8659works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8660case-independent.
8661
8662.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8663To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8664an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8665part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8666longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8667lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8668performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8669become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8670
8671
8672
8673.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8674.cindex "list" "local part list"
8675.cindex "local part" "list"
8676Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8677lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8678setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8679set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8680case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8681matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8682&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8683option is case-sensitive from the start.
8684
8685If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8686comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8687only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8688Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8689that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8690&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8691Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8692types.
8693.ecindex IIDdohoadli
8694
8695
8696
8697
8698. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8699. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8700
8701.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8702.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8703Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8704them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8705
8706When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8707when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8708start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8709below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8710escape character, as described in the following section.
8711
8712Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8713dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8714options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8715the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8716conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8717reasons.
8718
8719
8720
8721.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8722.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8723An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8724backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8725character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8726If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8727required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8728the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8729
8730.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8731A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8732two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8733expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8734.code
8735deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8736.endd
8737On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8738without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8739string.
8740
8741
8742
8743.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8744.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8745A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8746expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8747carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8748octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8749backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8750encoding.
8751
8752These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8753in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8754and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8755
8756
8757.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8758.cindex "expansion" "testing"
8759.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8760.oindex "&%-be%&"
8761Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8762takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8763arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8764to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8765since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8766value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8767database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8768and &%nhash%&.
8769
8770Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8771instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8772using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8773
8774.oindex "&%-bem%&"
8775If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8776from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8777option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8778read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8779.code
8780exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8781.endd
8782The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8783Exim message identifier. For example:
8784.code
8785exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8786.endd
8787This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8788is therefore restricted to admin users.
8789
8790
8791.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8792.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8793A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8794alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8795(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8796used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8797instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8798the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8799that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8800its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8801from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8802taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8803being expanded.
8804
8805
8806
8807
8808.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8809The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8810between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8811outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8812white space is significant.
8813
8814.vlist
8815.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8816.cindex "expansion" "variables"
8817Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8818.code
8819$local_part
8820${domain}
8821.endd
8822The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8823characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8824&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8825section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8826given, the expansion fails.
8827
8828.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8829.cindex "expansion" "operators"
8830The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8831<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8832.code
8833${lc:$local_part}
8834.endd
8835The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8836leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8837below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8838one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8839string easier to understand.
8840
8841.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8842This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8843expansion item below.
8844
8845
8846.new
8847.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8848.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8849.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8850The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8851arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8852Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8853arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8854and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8855are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8856a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8857the result of the expansion.
8858If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8859the expansion result is an empty string.
8860If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8861.wen
8862
8863
8864.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8865 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8866.cindex &%dlfunc%&
8867This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8868This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8869.code
8870EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8871.endd
8872set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8873object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8874(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8875
8876There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8877a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8878included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8879are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8880must have the following type:
8881.code
8882int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8883.endd
8884Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8885function should return one of the following values:
8886
8887&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8888into the expanded string that is being built.
8889
8890&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8891from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8892
8893&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8894taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8895
8896&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8897
8898When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8899you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8900configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8901
8902.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8903 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8904.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8905.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8906The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8907white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8908must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8909form:
8910.display
8911<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8912.endd
8913.vindex "&$value$&"
8914where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8915values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8916values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8917described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8918for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8919the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8920otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8921variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8922is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8923
8924If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8925key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8926extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8927yield &"2001"&:
8928.code
8929${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8930${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8931.endd
8932Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8933appear, for example:
8934.code
8935${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8936.endd
8937This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8938{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8939
8940
8941.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8942 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8943.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8944.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8945The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8946apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8947This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8948behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8949extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8950argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8951<&'string3'&> as before.
8952
8953The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8954separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8955The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8956counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8957number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8958number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8959expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8960provided. For example:
8961.code
8962${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8963.endd
8964yields &"42"&, and
8965.code
8966${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8967.endd
8968yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8969empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8970
8971
8972.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8973.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8974.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8975.vindex "&$item$&"
8976After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8977default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8978in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8979evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8980item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8981separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8982input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8983.code
8984${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8985.endd
8986yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8987to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8988
8989
8990.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8991.cindex "hash function" "textual"
8992.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8993This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8994early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8995(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8996
8997The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8998<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8999<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9000use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9001.code
9002${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9003.endd
9004The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9005or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9006Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9007function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9008first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9009.code
9010abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9011.endd
9012If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9013letters appear. For example:
9014.display
9015&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9016&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9017&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9018.endd
9019
9020.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9021 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9022 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9023 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9024 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9025 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9026.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9027.vindex "&$header_$&"
9028.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9029.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9030.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9031.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9032.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9033Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9034.code
9035$header_reply-to:
9036.endd
9037The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9038internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9039lines) may be present.
9040
9041The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9042the data in the header line is interpreted.
9043
9044.ilist
9045.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9046&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9047processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9048
9049.next
9050.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9051&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9052or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9053character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9054&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9055.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9056produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9057what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9058
9059.next
9060&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9061standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9062be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9063returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9064&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9065a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9066.endlist ilist
9067
9068In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9069command of the following form:
9070.code
9071headers charset "UTF-8"
9072.endd
9073This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9074subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9075character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9076option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9077value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9078ISO-8859-1.
9079
9080Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9081any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9082&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9083if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9084
9085Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9086this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9087message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9088filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9089router or transport are not accessible.
9090
9091For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9092before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9093message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9094are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9095point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9096by earlier ACLs are visible.
9097
9098Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9099following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9100this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9101white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9102If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9103replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9104&<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9105
9106If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9107to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9108&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9109each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9110newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9111newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9112those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9113junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9114
9115
9116.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9117.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9118.cindex &%hmac%&
9119This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9120shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9121RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9122&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9123cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9124or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9125present. For example:
9126.code
9127${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9128.endd
9129For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9130produces:
9131.code
9132dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9133.endd
9134As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9135an Exim configuration:
9136.code
9137SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9138.endd
9139In a router or a transport you could then have:
9140.code
9141headers_add = \
9142 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9143 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9144 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9145.endd
9146Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9147&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9148this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9149host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9150using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9151&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9152
9153
9154.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9155.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9156.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9157If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9158item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9159in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9160.code
9161${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9162.endd
9163The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9164true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9165be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9166case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9167&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9168
9169If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9170is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9171cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9172.code
9173condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9174.endd
9175you can use
9176.code
9177condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9178.endd
9179
9180.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9181.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9182.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9183The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9184strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9185you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9186change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9187some of the braces:
9188.code
9189${length_<n>:<string>}
9190.endd
9191The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9192of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9193&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9194
9195
9196.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9197 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9198This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9199described in the next item.
9200
9201.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9202 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9203.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9204.cindex "file" "lookups"
9205.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9206The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9207discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9208lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9209<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9210
9211If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9212a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9213other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9214in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9215out by the system administrator.
9216
9217.vindex "&$value$&"
9218If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9219During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9220lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9221level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9222the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9223string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9224lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9225original lookup fails.
9226
9227If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9228data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9229expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9230the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9231appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9232to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9233{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9234successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9235
9236For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9237search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9238type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9239&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9240
9241.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9242If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9243and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9244They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9245
9246This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9247.code
9248${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9249.endd
9250This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9251the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9252.code
9253${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9254 {$value}fail}
9255.endd
9256
9257
9258.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9259.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9260.vindex "&$item$&"
9261After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9262default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9263in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9264expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9265for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9266setting is not included in the output. For example:
9267.code
9268${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9269.endd
9270expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9271value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9272and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9273
9274.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9275.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9276.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9277The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9278<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9279if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9280can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9281.code
9282${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9283.endd
9284The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9285the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9286processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9287slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9288example,
9289.code
9290${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9291.endd
9292returns the string &"6/33"&.
9293
9294
9295
9296.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9297.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9298.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9299This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9300interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9301expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9302additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9303name of the subroutine, is nine.
9304
9305The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9306the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9307way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9308Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9309return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9310not its contents.
9311
9312If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9313with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9314Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9315
9316The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9317out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9318
9319
9320.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9321.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9322The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9323keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9324it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9325to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9326as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9327and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9328
9329.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9330 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9331.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9332This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9333checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9334yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9335empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9336prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9337version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9338variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9339
9340These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9341retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9342against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9343which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9344
9345The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9346string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9347result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9348whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9349is the expansion of the third argument.
9350
9351All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9352However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9353For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9354
9355.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9356.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9357.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9358.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9359The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9360then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9361the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9362newlines are left in the string.
9363String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9364you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9365the string expansion fails.
9366
9367The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9368locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9369
9370
9371
9372.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9373 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9374.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9375.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9376.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9377This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9378string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9379examples:
9380.code
9381${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9382${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9383.endd
9384For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9385For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9386a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9387number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9388optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9389example:
9390.code
9391${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9392.endd
9393Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9394one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9395both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9396(unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9397is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9398extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9399.code
9400${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9401.endd
9402A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9403that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9404turns them into spaces:
9405.code
9406${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9407.endd
9408As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9409happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9410addition, the following errors can occur:
9411
9412.ilist
9413Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9414.next
9415Failure to connect the socket;
9416.next
9417Failure to write the request string;
9418.next
9419Timeout on reading from the socket.
9420.endlist
9421
9422By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9423you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9424errors occurs. For example:
9425.code
9426${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9427 {socket failure}}
9428.endd
9429You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9430expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9431and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9432if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9433non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9434
9435The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9436locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9437
9438
9439.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9440.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9441.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9442.vindex "&$value$&"
9443.vindex "&$item$&"
9444This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9445<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9446separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9447assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9448list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9449them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9450iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9451added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9452number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9453.code
9454${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9455.endd
9456The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9457can be found:
9458.code
9459${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9460.endd
9461At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9462restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9463expansion items.
9464
9465.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9466This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9467expansion item above.
9468
9469.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9470 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9471.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9472.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9473The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9474command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9475other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9476a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9477
9478The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9479and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9480.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9481.vindex "&$value$&"
9482If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9483and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9484from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9485<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9486expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9487&$value$&.
9488
9489If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9490can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9491command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9492of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9493
9494.new
9495.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9496The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9497In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9498troubleshoot:
9499.code
9500warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9501 log_message = Output of id: $value
9502.endd
9503If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9504shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9505.code
9506${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9507.endd
9508.wen
9509
9510.vindex "&$runrc$&"
9511The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9512remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9513.code
9514if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9515 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9516 ...
9517endif
9518.endd
9519If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9520the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9521commands.
9522
9523&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9524option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9525testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9526by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9527
9528The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9529out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9530
9531
9532.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9533.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9534.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9535This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9536option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9537modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9538into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9539a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9540.code
9541${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9542.endd
9543yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9544if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9545substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9546.code
9547${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9548.endd
9549yields &"defabc"&, and
9550.code
9551${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9552.endd
9553yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9554the regular expression from string expansion.
9555
9556
9557
9558.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9559.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9560.cindex "substring extraction"
9561.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9562The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9563<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9564if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9565can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9566.code
9567${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9568.endd
9569The second number is optional (in both notations).
9570If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9571omitted.
9572
9573The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9574&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9575length required. For example
9576.code
9577${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9578.endd
9579If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9580null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9581length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9582given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9583
9584The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9585from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9586second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9587.code
9588${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9589.endd
9590yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9591length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9592the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9593.code
9594${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9595.endd
9596yields an empty string, but
9597.code
9598${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9599.endd
9600yields &"1"&.
9601
9602When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9603is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9604string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9605no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9606.code
9607${substr_-1:abcde}
9608${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9609.endd
9610yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9611
9612
9613
9614.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9615 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9616.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9617.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9618This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9619argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9620matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9621replacement list. For example
9622.code
9623${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9624.endd
9625yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9626last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9627last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9628place.
9629.endlist
9630
9631
9632
9633.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9634.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9635For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9636the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9637The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9638following operations can be performed:
9639
9640.vlist
9641.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9642.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9643.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9644The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9645header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9646not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9647
9648
9649.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9650.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9651.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9652The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
96532822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9654operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9655result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9656doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9657Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9658
9659It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9660separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9661character. For example:
9662.code
9663${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9664.endd
9665expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9666expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9667address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9668processing lists.
9669
9670.new
9671To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9672a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9673unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9674email address seperator. For the example header line:
9675.code
9676From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9677.endd
9678The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9679properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9680It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9681example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9682de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9683The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9684quoted.
9685.code
9686# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9687=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9688user@example.com
9689# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9690Last:user@example.com
9691# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9692user@example.com
9693.endd
9694.wen
9695
9696.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9697.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9698.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9699The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9700base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9701the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9702its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9703names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9704be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9705
9706.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9707.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9708.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9709The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9710environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9711identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9712string.
9713
9714
9715.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9716.cindex "domain" "extraction"
9717.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9718The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9719from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9720
9721
9722.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9723.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9724.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9725If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9726escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9727significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9728is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9729
9730
9731.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9732.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9733.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9734.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9735These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9736expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9737arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9738logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9739integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9740C programming language):
9741.table2 70pt 300pt
9742.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9743.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9744.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9745.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9746.irow "" "and (&&)"
9747.irow "" "xor (^)"
9748.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9749.endtable
9750Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9751space is permitted before or after operators.
9752
9753For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9754hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9755decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9756permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9757times, which often do have leading zeros.
9758
9759A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9760or 1024*1024*1024,
9761respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9762a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9763
9764.display
9765&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9766&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9767&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9768&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9769&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9770&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9771&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9772&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9773&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9774&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9775&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9776.endd
9777
9778As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9779.code
9780deny message = Too many bad recipients
9781 condition = \
9782 ${if and { \
9783 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9784 { \
9785 < \
9786 {$recipients_count} \
9787 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9788 } \
9789 }{yes}{no}}
9790.endd
9791The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9792fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9793
9794
9795.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9796.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9797The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9798example,
9799.code
9800${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9801.endd
9802first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9803and then re-expands what it has found.
9804
9805
9806.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9807.cindex "Unicode"
9808.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9809.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9810.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9811The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9812email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9813to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9814UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9815converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9816the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9817
9818Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9819ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9820For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9821way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9822characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9823single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9824translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9825
9826
9827.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9828.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9829.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9830The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9831be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9832change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9833.code
9834${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9835.endd
9836See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9837abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9838
9839
9840
9841.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9842.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9843.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9844.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9845This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9846be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9847
9848
9849
9850.new
9851.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9852.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
9853.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
9854This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
9855escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
9856as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
9857byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
9858.wen
9859
9860
9861.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9862.cindex "case forcing in strings"
9863.cindex "string" "case forcing"
9864.cindex "lower casing"
9865.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9866.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9867This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9868.code
9869${lc:$local_part}
9870.endd
9871
9872.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9873.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9874.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9875The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9876can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9877changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9878.code
9879${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9880.endd
9881See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9882&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9883when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9884
9885
9886.new
9887.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9888.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
9889.cindex "list" "item count"
9890.cindex "list" "count of items"
9891.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
9892The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
9893
9894
9895.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
9896.cindex "expansion" "named list"
9897.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
9898The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
9899expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
9900If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
9901and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
9902Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
9903matching list is returned.
9904.wen
9905
9906
9907.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9908.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9909.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9910The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9911extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9912empty.
9913
9914
9915.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9916.cindex "masked IP address"
9917.cindex "IP address" "masking"
9918.cindex "CIDR notation"
9919.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9920.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9921If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9922slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9923expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9924masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9925the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9926.code
9927${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9928.endd
9929returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9930be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9931address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9932terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9933.code
9934${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9935.endd
9936returns the string
9937.code
99383ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9939.endd
9940Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9941
9942
9943.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9944.cindex "MD5 hash"
9945.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9946.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9947The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9948as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9949
9950
9951.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9952.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9953.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9954The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9955that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9956strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9957.code
9958${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9959.endd
9960See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9961
9962
9963.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9964.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9965.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9966.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9967The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9968is an empty string or
9969contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9970Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9971Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9972respectively For example,
9973.code
9974${quote:ab"*"cd}
9975.endd
9976becomes
9977.code
9978"ab\"*\"cd"
9979.endd
9980The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9981variable or a message header.
9982
9983.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9984.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9985This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9986required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9987example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9988If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9989(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9990
9991
9992.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9993.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9994This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9995query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9996the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9997.code
9998${quote_ldap:two * two}
9999.endd
10000returns
10001.code
10002two%20%5C2A%20two
10003.endd
10004For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10005yields an unchanged string.
10006
10007
10008.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10009.cindex "random number"
10010This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10011supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10012on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10013If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10014If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10015for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10016Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10017srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10018random().
10019
10020
10021.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10022.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10023This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10024dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10025dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10026for DNS. For example,
10027.code
10028${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10029${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10030.endd
10031returns
10032.code
100334.2.0.192
10034f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10035.endd
10036
10037
10038.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10039.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10040.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10041.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10042This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10043encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10044assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10045&%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10046contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10047characters
10048.code
10049? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10050.endd
10051it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10052string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10053characters.
10054
10055
10056.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10057.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10058.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10059.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10060This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10061bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10062character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10063not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10064
10065&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10066access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10067to use this operator as well.
10068
10069
10070
10071.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10072.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10073.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10074.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10075The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10076characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10077variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10078
10079
10080.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10081.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10082.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10083.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10084The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10085it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10086
10087
10088.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10089.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10090.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10091.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10092The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10093function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10094expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10095series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10096except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10097a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1009810-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10099&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10100can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10101
10102The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10103the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10104systems for files larger than 2GB.
10105
10106.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10107.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10108.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10109.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10110This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10111
10112
10113
10114.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10115.cindex "expansion" "string length"
10116.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10117.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10118The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10119decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10120
10121
10122.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10123.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10124.cindex "substring extraction"
10125.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10126The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10127can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10128that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10129.code
10130${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10131.endd
10132See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10133abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10134
10135.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10136.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10137.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10138This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10139seconds.
10140
10141.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10142.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10143.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10144The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10145represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10146number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10147&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10148
10149.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10150.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10151.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10152.cindex "upper casing"
10153.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10154.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10155This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10156.endlist
10157
10158
10159
10160
10161
10162
10163.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10164.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10165The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10166while expanding strings:
10167
10168.vlist
10169.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10170.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10171.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10172Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10173condition.
10174
10175.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10176.cindex "numeric comparison"
10177.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10178There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10179are:
10180.display
10181&`= `& equal
10182&`== `& equal
10183&`> `& greater
10184&`>= `& greater or equal
10185&`< `& less
10186&`<= `& less or equal
10187.endd
10188For example:
10189.code
10190${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10191.endd
10192Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10193two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10194optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10195lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10196As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10197zero.
10198
10199In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10200<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1020110M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10202
10203
10204.new
10205.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10206 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10207.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10208.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10209The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10210arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10211Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10212arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10213and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10214are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10215a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10216the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10217If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10218If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10219.wen
10220
10221.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10222.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10223.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10224This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10225a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10226(case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10227false if zero.
10228An empty string is treated as false.
10229Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10230thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10231All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10232
10233When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10234make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10235For example:
10236.code
10237${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10238.endd
10239
10240
10241.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10242.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10243.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10244Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10245where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10246loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10247and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10248true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10249
10250Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10251
10252.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10253.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10254.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10255.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10256This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10257authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10258necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10259included in the binary.
10260
10261The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10262compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10263be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10264encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10265does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10266&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10267Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10268string in LDAP form is:
10269.code
10270{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10271.endd
10272If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10273be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10274.code
10275${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10276.endd
10277The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10278supported:
10279
10280.ilist
10281.cindex "MD5 hash"
10282.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10283&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10284printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10285length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10286(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10287hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10288comparison fails.
10289
10290.next
10291.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10292&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10293printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10294length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10295If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10296SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10297
10298.next
10299.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10300&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10301only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10302systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10303whatever its length.
10304
10305.next
10306.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10307&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10308use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10309modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10310.endlist
10311Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10312&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10313HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10314operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10315the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10316support &[crypt16()]&.
10317
10318Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10319it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10320turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10321&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10322algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10323
10324However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10325functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10326Exim is seen as very low priority.
10327
10328If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10329comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10330determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10331default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10332function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10333
10334.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10335.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10336.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10337The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10338variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10339variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10340.code
10341${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10342.endd
10343Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10344variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10345
10346.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10347 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10348.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10349This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10350exists in the message. For example,
10351.code
10352${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10353.endd
10354&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10355the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10356
10357.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10358 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10359.cindex "string" "comparison"
10360.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10361.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10362.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10363The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10364resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10365letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10366
10367.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10368.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10369.cindex "file" "existence test"
10370.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10371The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10372condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10373is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10374users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10375
10376.vitem &*first_delivery*&
10377.cindex "delivery" "first"
10378.cindex "first delivery"
10379.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10380.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10381This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10382attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10383
10384
10385.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10386 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10387.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10388.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10389.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10390.vindex "&$item$&"
10391These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10392the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10393the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10394be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10395condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10396.ilist
10397For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10398the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10399items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10400.next
10401For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10402and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10403all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10404.endlist
10405Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10406items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10407that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10408list separator is changed to a comma:
10409.code
10410${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10411.endd
10412The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10413being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10414
10415.new "To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator."
10416
10417
10418.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10419 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10420.cindex "string" "comparison"
10421.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10422.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10423.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10424The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10425string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10426comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10427case-independent.
10428
10429.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10430 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10431.cindex "string" "comparison"
10432.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10433.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10434.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10435The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10436string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10437includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10438case-independent.
10439
10440.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10441 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10442.cindex "string" "comparison"
10443.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10444Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10445strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10446is true.
10447
10448These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10449Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10450.code
10451${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10452 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10453${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10454 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10455.endd
10456
10457.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10458 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10459 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10460.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10461.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10462.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10463.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10464.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10465The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10466an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10467&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10468
10469For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10470which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10471colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10472hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10473component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10474
10475&*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10476values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10477check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10478host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10479.code
10480${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10481.endd
10482to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10483
10484.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10485.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10486.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10487.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10488This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10489&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10490queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10491query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10492password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10493server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10494with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10495will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10496of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10497this can be used.
10498
10499
10500.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10501 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10502.cindex "string" "comparison"
10503.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10504.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10505.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10506The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10507string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10508comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10509case-independent.
10510
10511.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10512 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10513.cindex "string" "comparison"
10514.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10515.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10516.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10517The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10518string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10519includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10520case-independent.
10521
10522
10523.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10524.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10525.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10526.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10527The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10528expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10529regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10530escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10531(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10532premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10533&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10534For example,
10535.code
10536${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10537.endd
10538If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10539backslashes is also required.
10540
10541The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10542The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10543metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10544and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10545the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10546metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10547
10548.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10549At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10550substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10551succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10552will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10553of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10554combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10555variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10556
10557.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10558.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10559See &*match_local_part*&.
10560
10561.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10562.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10563See &*match_local_part*&.
10564
10565.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10566.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10567This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10568be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10569address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10570list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10571.code
10572${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10573.endd
10574The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10575
10576.ilist
10577An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10578.next
10579A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10580.next
10581An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10582useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10583in a single test such as
10584. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10585. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10586. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10587. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10588.code
10589 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10590.endd
10591where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10592.next
10593The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10594.next
10595Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10596even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10597address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10598&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10599masks. For example:
10600.code
10601 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10602.endd
10603It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10604do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10605address mask, for example:
10606.code
10607 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10608.endd
10609However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10610just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10611.code
10612 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10613.endd
10614.endlist ilist
10615
10616Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10617Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10618
10619Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10620
10621.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10622.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10623.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10624.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10625.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10626This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10627possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10628condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10629example is:
10630.code
10631${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10632.endd
10633In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10634list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10635expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10636Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10637.code
10638${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10639.endd
10640.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10641For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10642item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10643have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10644caselessly.
10645
10646Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10647Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10648
10649&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10650hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10651how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10652matched using &%match_ip%&.
10653
10654.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10655.cindex "PAM authentication"
10656.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10657.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10658.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10659.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10660&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10661(&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10662available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10663distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10664the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10665.code
10666SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10667.endd
10668in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10669in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10670
10671The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10672colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10673The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10674taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10675The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10676from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10677request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10678
10679There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10680characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10681separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10682item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10683of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10684.code
10685server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10686.endd
10687For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10688.code
10689server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10690.endd
10691In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10692running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10693messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10694A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10695Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10696The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10697to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10698group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10699
10700
10701.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10702.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10703.cindex "Cyrus"
10704.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10705.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10706This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10707This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10708that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10709deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10710
10711The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10712the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10713building Exim. For example:
10714.code
10715CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10716.endd
10717You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10718the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10719from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10720access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10721
10722The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10723password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10724configuration, you might have this:
10725.code
10726server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10727.endd
10728Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10729.code
10730server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10731.endd
10732.vitem &*queue_running*&
10733.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10734.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10735.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10736This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10737initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10738
10739
10740.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10741.cindex "Radius"
10742.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10743.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10744Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10745set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10746the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10747support.
10748
10749With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10750library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10751this library, you need to set
10752.code
10753RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10754.endd
10755in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10756&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10757.code
10758RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10759.endd
10760in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10761You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10762Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10763
10764The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10765Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10766the authentication is successful. For example:
10767.code
10768server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10769.endd
10770
10771
10772.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10773 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10774.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10775.cindex "Cyrus"
10776.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10777.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10778This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10779daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10780Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10781by a process that is not running as root.
10782
10783The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10784the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10785building Exim. For example:
10786.code
10787CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10788.endd
10789You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10790the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10791from the Cyrus SASL library.
10792
10793Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10794two are mandatory. For example:
10795.code
10796server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10797.endd
10798The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10799in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10800realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10801.endlist vlist
10802
10803
10804
10805.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10806.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10807Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10808and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10809conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10810sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10811the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10812
10813
10814.vlist
10815.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10816.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10817.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10818The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10819any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10820For example,
10821.code
10822${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10823.endd
10824When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10825evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10826numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10827
10828.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10829.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10830.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10831The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10832all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10833sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10834the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10835parsed but not evaluated.
10836.endlist
10837.ecindex IIDexpcond
10838
10839
10840
10841
10842.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10843.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10844This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10845of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10846support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10847
10848.vlist
10849.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10850.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10851When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10852captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10853processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10854However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10855values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10856variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10857precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10858Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10859matching condition.
10860
10861.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10862Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10863can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10864long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10865example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10866variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10867used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10868same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10869with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10870during subsequent delivery.
10871
10872.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10873These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10874are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10875received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10876message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10877also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10878message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10879and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10880delivery.
10881
10882.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10883.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10884After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10885message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10886be preserved by coding like this:
10887.code
10888warn !verify = sender
10889 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10890.endd
10891You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10892&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10893failure.
10894
10895.vitem &$address_data$&
10896.vindex "&$address_data$&"
10897This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10898value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10899and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10900the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10901for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10902user filter files.
10903
10904If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10905a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10906conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10907to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10908of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10909from the child's routing.
10910
10911If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10912sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10913&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10914address.
10915
10916In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10917after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10918these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10919
10920.vitem &$address_file$&
10921.vindex "&$address_file$&"
10922When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10923to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10924is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10925default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10926.code
10927/home/r2d2/savemail
10928.endd
10929then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10930contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10931.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10932For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10933then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10934to the relevant file.
10935
10936.vitem &$address_pipe$&
10937.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10938When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10939this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10940
10941.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10942.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10943These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10944&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10945
10946.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10947.cindex "authentication" "id"
10948.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10949When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10950preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10951&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10952user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10953in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10954&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10955When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10956the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10957process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10958command line option.
10959
10960.new
10961.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10962.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
10963.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
10964When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10965will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
10966id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
10967available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
10968A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
10969authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
10970the ACL's as well.
10971.wen
10972
10973
10974.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10975.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10976.cindex "authentication" "sender"
10977.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10978.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10979When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10980SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10981described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10982&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10983available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10984sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10985
10986.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10987When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10988value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10989name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10990can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10991
10992
10993.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10994.cindex "authentication" "failure"
10995.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10996This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10997command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10998possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10999(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11000&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11001is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11002negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11003an undefined mechanism.
11004
11005.vitem &$av_failed$&
11006.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11007This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11008extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11009problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11010the ACL malware condition.
11011
11012.vitem &$body_linecount$&
11013.cindex "message body" "line count"
11014.cindex "body of message" "line count"
11015.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11016When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11017number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11018
11019.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11020.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11021.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11022.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11023.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11024When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11025number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11026
11027.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11028.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11029This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11030it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11031chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11032
11033.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11034.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11035This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11036up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11037file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11038
11039.vitem &$caller_gid$&
11040.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11041.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11042The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11043not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11044&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11045incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11046
11047.vitem &$caller_uid$&
11048.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11049.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11050The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11051not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11052&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11053incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11054
11055.vitem &$compile_date$&
11056.vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11057The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11058
11059.vitem &$compile_number$&
11060.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11061The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11062of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11063compilations of the same version of the program.
11064
11065.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11066.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11067This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11068the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11069details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11070
11071.vitem &$demime_reason$&
11072.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11073This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11074content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11075see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11076
11077.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11078 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11079 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11080 &$dnslist_value$&
11081.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11082.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11083.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11084.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11085.cindex "black list (DNS)"
11086When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11087the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11088looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11089main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11090
11091.vitem &$domain$&
11092.vindex "&$domain$&"
11093When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11094contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11095case for &$domain$&.
11096
11097Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11098&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11099is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11100message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11101
11102When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11103RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11104have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11105at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11106the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11107which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11108
11109.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11110At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11111set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11112
11113The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11114
11115.ilist
11116When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11117the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11118&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11119normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11120is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11121&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11122the &(smtp)& transport.
11123
11124.next
11125When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11126&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11127it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11128rewrite domains by file lookup.
11129
11130.next
11131With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11132&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11133a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11134is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11135that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11136recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11137
11138.next
11139.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11140.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11141When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11142the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11143.endlist
11144
11145
11146.vitem &$domain_data$&
11147.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11148When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11149means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11150of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11151address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11152transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11153used.
11154
11155&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11156domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11157the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11158to nothing.
11159
11160.vitem &$exim_gid$&
11161.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11162This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11163
11164.vitem &$exim_path$&
11165.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11166This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11167
11168.vitem &$exim_uid$&
11169.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11170This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11171
11172.vitem &$found_extension$&
11173.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11174This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11175content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11176see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11177
11178.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11179This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11180inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11181be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11182characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11183
11184.new
11185.vitem &$headers_added$&
11186.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11187Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11188the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11189The headers are a newline-separated list.
11190.wen
11191
11192.vitem &$home$&
11193.vindex "&$home$&"
11194When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11195directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11196means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11197explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11198by a setting on the transport itself.
11199
11200When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11201of the environment variable HOME.
11202
11203.vitem &$host$&
11204.vindex "&$host$&"
11205If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11206list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11207to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11208to local and remote transports.
11209
11210.cindex "transport" "filter"
11211.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11212For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11213&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11214particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11215using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11216&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11217is connected.
11218
11219When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11220&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11221client is connected.
11222
11223
11224.vitem &$host_address$&
11225.vindex "&$host_address$&"
11226This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11227for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11228when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11229
11230.vitem &$host_data$&
11231.vindex "&$host_data$&"
11232If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11233result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11234allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11235.code
11236deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11237message = $host_data
11238.endd
11239.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11240.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11241.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11242This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11243message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11244name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11245variables is set to &"1"&.
11246
11247.ilist
11248If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11249succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11250
11251.next
11252If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11253tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11254lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11255.endlist ilist
11256
11257Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11258single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11259names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11260is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11261&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11262IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11263sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11264lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11265the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11266&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11267
11268.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11269.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11270See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11271
11272
11273.vitem &$inode$&
11274.vindex "&$inode$&"
11275The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11276option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11277of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11278a unique name for the file.
11279
11280.vitem &$interface_address$&
11281.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11282This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11283
11284.vitem &$interface_port$&
11285.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11286This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11287
11288.vitem &$item$&
11289.vindex "&$item$&"
11290This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11291conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11292&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11293empty.
11294
11295.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11296.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11297This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11298contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11299lookup.
11300
11301.vitem &$load_average$&
11302.vindex "&$load_average$&"
11303This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11304is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11305variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11306
11307.vitem &$local_part$&
11308.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11309When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11310variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11311delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11312session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11313
11314Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11315&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11316&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11317because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11318once.
11319
11320.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11321.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11322If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11323value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11324any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11325&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11326
11327When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11328result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11329the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11330&$address_pipe$&).
11331
11332When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11333local part of the recipient address.
11334
11335When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11336&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11337it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11338
11339In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11340the addresses
11341.code
11342"abc:xyz"@test.example
11343abc\:xyz@test.example
11344.endd
11345the value of &$local_part$& is
11346.code
11347abc:xyz
11348.endd
11349If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11350inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11351have:
11352.code
11353data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11354.endd
11355&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11356to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11357&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11358
11359.vitem &$local_part_data$&
11360.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11361When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11362lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11363router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11364to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11365handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11366
11367&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11368matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11369available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11370variable expands to nothing.
11371
11372.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11373.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11374When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11375specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11376variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11377
11378.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11379.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11380When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11381specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11382variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11383
11384.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11385.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11386This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11387a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11388
11389.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11390.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11391See &$local_user_uid$&.
11392
11393.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11394.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11395This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11396&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11397are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11398and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11399router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11400are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11401
11402.vitem &$localhost_number$&
11403.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11404This contains the expanded value of the
11405&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11406been read.
11407
11408.vitem &$log_inodes$&
11409.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11410The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11411log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11412referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11413the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11414
11415.vitem &$log_space$&
11416.vindex "&$log_space$&"
11417The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11418partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11419whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11420ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11421the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11422
11423
11424.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11425.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11426This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11427&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11428&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11429contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11430without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11431variable is empty.
11432
11433.vitem &$malware_name$&
11434.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11435This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11436content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11437when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11438
11439.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11440.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11441.cindex "maximum" "line length"
11442.cindex "line length" "maximum"
11443This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11444received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11445character(s).
11446
11447.vitem &$message_age$&
11448.cindex "message" "age of"
11449.vindex "&$message_age$&"
11450This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11451of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11452delivery attempt.
11453
11454.vitem &$message_body$&
11455.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11456.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11457.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11458.vindex "&$message_body$&"
11459.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11460This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11461being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11462number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11463&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11464
11465.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11466By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11467easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11468this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11469zeros are always converted into spaces.
11470
11471.vitem &$message_body_end$&
11472.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11473.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11474.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11475This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11476body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11477&$message_body$&.
11478
11479.vitem &$message_body_size$&
11480.cindex "body of message" "size"
11481.cindex "message body" "size"
11482.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11483When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11484in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11485separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11486also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11487
11488.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11489.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11490When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11491unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11492An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11493received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11494line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11495&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11496
11497.vitem &$message_headers$&
11498.vindex &$message_headers$&
11499This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11500is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11501lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11502same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11503
11504.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11505.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11506This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11507contents of header lines is done.
11508
11509.vitem &$message_id$&
11510This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11511
11512.vitem &$message_linecount$&
11513.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11514This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11515message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11516During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11517number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11518routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11519&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11520lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11521from the body is not counted.
11522
11523As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11524appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11525&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11526file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11527header and the body).
11528
11529Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11530.code
11531deny message = Too many lines in message header
11532 condition = \
11533 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11534.endd
11535In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11536message has not yet been received.
11537
11538.vitem &$message_size$&
11539.cindex "size" "of message"
11540.cindex "message" "size"
11541.vindex "&$message_size$&"
11542When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11543most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11544message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11545deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11546expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11547doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11548precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11549&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11550
11551.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11552While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11553contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11554value may not, of course, be truthful.
11555
11556.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11557A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11558available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11559details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11560
11561.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11562These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11563of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11564
11565.vitem &$original_domain$&
11566.vindex "&$domain$&"
11567.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11568When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11569same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11570generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11571variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11572differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11573aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11574single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11575
11576If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11577filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11578part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11579
11580.vitem &$original_local_part$&
11581.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11582.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11583When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11584same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11585local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11586part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11587filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11588the original address.
11589
11590If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11591case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11592This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11593one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11594delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11595
11596If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11597filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11598part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11599
11600.vitem &$originator_gid$&
11601.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11602.cindex "sender" "gid"
11603.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11604.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11605This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11606message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11607gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11608normally the gid of the Exim user.
11609
11610.vitem &$originator_uid$&
11611.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11612.cindex "sender" "uid"
11613.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11614.vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11615The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11616messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11617For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11618user.
11619
11620.vitem &$parent_domain$&
11621.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11622This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11623above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11624
11625.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11626.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11627This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11628(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11629
11630.vitem &$pid$&
11631.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11632.vindex "&$pid$&"
11633This variable contains the current process id.
11634
11635.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11636.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11637.cindex "transport" "filter"
11638.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11639This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11640&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11641&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11642(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11643It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11644variable"& error if encountered.
11645
11646.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11647.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11648This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11649configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11650a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11651&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11652qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11653
11654
11655.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11656This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11657which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11658&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11659
11660.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11661This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11662which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11663&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11664
11665.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11666This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11667which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11668&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11669
11670.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11671.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11672The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11673
11674.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11675.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11676The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11677or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11678
11679.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11680.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11681When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11682RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11683RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11684
11685.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11686.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11687.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11688When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11689RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11690temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11691
11692.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11693.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11694When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11695RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11696permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11697
11698.vitem &$received_count$&
11699.vindex "&$received_count$&"
11700This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11701including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11702is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11703delivering.
11704
11705.vitem &$received_for$&
11706.vindex "&$received_for$&"
11707If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11708variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11709built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11710the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11711
11712.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11713.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11714As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11715variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11716is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11717&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11718the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11719option.
11720
11721As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11722could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11723on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11724values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11725messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11726time.
11727
11728&*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11729the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11730&(smtp)& transport).
11731
11732.vitem &$received_port$&
11733.vindex "&$received_port$&"
11734See &$received_ip_address$&.
11735
11736.vitem &$received_protocol$&
11737.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11738When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11739protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11740by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11741&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11742(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11743is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11744connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11745
11746Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11747automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11748&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11749encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11750where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11751STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11752
11753The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11754messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11755identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11756
11757.vitem &$received_time$&
11758.vindex "&$received_time$&"
11759This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11760as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11761
11762.vitem &$recipient_data$&
11763.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11764This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11765condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11766until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11767.display
11768&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11769&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11770.endd
11771&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11772method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11773The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11774expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11775
11776.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11777.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11778In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11779information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11780
11781.ilist
11782&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11783was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11784
11785.next
11786&"route"&: Routing failed.
11787
11788.next
11789&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11790or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11791MAIL).
11792
11793.next
11794&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11795.next
11796
11797&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11798.endlist
11799
11800The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11801rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11802
11803.vitem &$recipients$&
11804.vindex "&$recipients$&"
11805This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11806a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11807is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11808unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11809cases:
11810
11811.olist
11812In a system filter file.
11813.next
11814In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11815is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11816&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11817&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11818.next
11819From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11820.endlist
11821
11822
11823.vitem &$recipients_count$&
11824.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11825When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11826envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11827from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11828increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11829
11830
11831.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11832.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11833This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11834&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11835
11836
11837.vitem &$reply_address$&
11838.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11839When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11840&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11841contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11842white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11843decoding or character code translation takes place.
11844
11845.vitem &$return_path$&
11846.vindex "&$return_path$&"
11847When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11848the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11849in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11850same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11851mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11852for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11853address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11854that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11855the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11856envelope sender.
11857
11858.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11859.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11860This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11861
11862.new
11863.vitem &$router_name$&
11864.cindex "router" "name"
11865.cindex "name" "of router"
11866.vindex "&$router_name$&"
11867During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
11868.wen
11869
11870.vitem &$runrc$&
11871.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11872.vindex "&$runrc$&"
11873This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11874&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11875assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11876preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11877reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11878another.
11879
11880.vitem &$self_hostname$&
11881.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11882.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11883When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11884local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11885One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11886happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11887original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11888
11889.vitem &$sender_address$&
11890.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11891When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11892that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11893is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11894value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11895
11896.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11897.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11898.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11899If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11900sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11901distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11902after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11903longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11904
11905.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11906.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11907The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11908
11909.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11910.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11911The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11912
11913.vitem &$sender_data$&
11914.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11915This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11916in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11917value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11918this:
11919.display
11920&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11921&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11922.endd
11923&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11924method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11925The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11926expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11927
11928.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11929.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11930When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11931name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11932brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11933enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11934issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11935looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11936&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11937start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11938verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11939the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11940the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11941
11942.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11943.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11944When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11945command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11946set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11947the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11948
11949.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11950.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11951When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11952host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11953
11954.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11955.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11956This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11957driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11958received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11959&$authenticated_id$&.
11960
11961.new
11962.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
11963.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
11964If &$sender_host_name$& has been populated (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
11965otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
11966resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
11967other times, this variable is false.
11968
11969It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
11970library, by setting:
11971.code
11972dns_use_dnssec = 1
11973.endd
11974
11975Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
11976validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
11977
11978Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
11979with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
11980
11981If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
11982mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
11983.wen
11984
11985
11986.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11987.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11988When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11989host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11990other means, this variable is empty.
11991
11992.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11993If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11994&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11995A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11996via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11997any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11998&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11999
12000.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12001However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12002DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12003&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12004
12005Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12006host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12007in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12008is set to &"1"&.
12009
12010Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12011maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12012these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12013following are true:
12014
12015.ilist
12016A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12017.next
12018The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12019configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12020to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12021.next
12022Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12023that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12024&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12025.next
12026The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12027In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12028EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12029.next
12030The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12031domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12032. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12033. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12034.code
12035 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12036.endd
12037which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12038IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12039.endlist
12040
12041
12042.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12043.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12044When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12045number that was used on the remote host.
12046
12047.vitem &$sender_ident$&
12048.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12049When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12050identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12051been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12052called Exim.
12053
12054.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12055A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12056&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12057&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12058
12059.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12060.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12061.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12062.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12063This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12064either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12065there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12066there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12067the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12068followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12069first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12070the parentheses.
12071
12072There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12073was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12074address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12075all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12076into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12077
12078.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12079.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12080In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12081about the failure. The details are the same as for
12082&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12083
12084.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12085.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12086This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12087been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12088used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12089on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12090connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12091
12092.vitem &$sending_port$&
12093.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12094This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12095been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12096connections, see &$received_port$&.
12097
12098.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12099.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12100During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12101host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12102&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12103value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12104
12105.vitem &$smtp_command$&
12106.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12107During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12108entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12109the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12110.code
12111MAIL FROM:<>
12112MAIL FROM: <>
12113.endd
12114For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12115command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12116rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12117the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12118
12119.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12120.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12121.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12122While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12123argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12124space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12125somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12126
12127.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12128.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12129This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12130daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12131in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12132connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12133the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12134never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12135there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12136single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12137daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12138
12139.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12140These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12141that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12142filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12143example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12144message is junk mail.
12145
12146.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12147A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12148is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12149&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12150
12151
12152.vitem &$spool_directory$&
12153.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12154The name of Exim's spool directory.
12155
12156.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12157.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12158The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12159being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12160If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12161is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12162
12163.vitem &$spool_space$&
12164.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12165The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12166Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12167variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12168find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12169value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12170megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12171.code
12172condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12173.endd
12174See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12175
12176
12177.vitem &$thisaddress$&
12178.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12179This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12180command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12181command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12182interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12183
12184.new
12185.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12186.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12187Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12188on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12189this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12190If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12191The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12192when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12193
12194The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12195except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12196the outbound.
12197
12198.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12199.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12200Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12201on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12202this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12203If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12204
12205.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12206.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12207This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12208message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12209
12210The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12211except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12212the outbound.
12213
12214.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12215.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12216This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12217outbound SMTP connection was made,
12218and &"0"& otherwise.
12219
12220.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12221.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12222.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12223When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12224connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12225example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12226received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12227&$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12228non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12229
12230The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12231but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12232becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12233
12234.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12235.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12236This variable is
12237cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12238and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12239&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12240details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12241
12242.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12243.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12244.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12245When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12246connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12247the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12248&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12249
12250The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12251except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12252the outbound.
12253
12254.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12255.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12256When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12257connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12258the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12259&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12260
12261.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12262.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12263.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12264.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12265When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12266Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12267If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12268some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12269will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12270a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12271used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12272
12273The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12274except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12275the outbound.
12276
12277.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12278.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12279.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12280During outbound
12281SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12282the transport.
12283.wen
12284
12285.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12286.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12287The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12288files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12289
12290.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12291.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12292The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12293
12294.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12295.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12296The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12297
12298.vitem &$tod_full$&
12299.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12300A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12301+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12302positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12303values for those that are behind (west).
12304
12305.vitem &$tod_log$&
12306.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12307The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
123081995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12309
12310.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12311.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12312This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12313is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12314flag.
12315
12316.vitem &$tod_zone$&
12317.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12318This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12319-0500.
12320
12321.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12322.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12323This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12324by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12325
12326.new
12327.vitem &$transport_name$&
12328.cindex "transport" "name"
12329.cindex "name" "of transport"
12330.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12331During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12332.wen
12333
12334.vitem &$value$&
12335.vindex "&$value$&"
12336This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12337or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12338&*reduce*& expansion.
12339
12340.vitem &$version_number$&
12341.vindex "&$version_number$&"
12342The version number of Exim.
12343
12344.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12345.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12346This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12347delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12348
12349.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12350.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12351This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12352delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12353.endlist
12354.ecindex IIDstrexp
12355
12356
12357
12358. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12359. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12360
12361.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12362.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12363Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12364Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12365use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12366your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12367the line
12368.code
12369EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12370.endd
12371in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12372
12373
12374.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12375.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12376Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12377&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12378no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12379interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12380the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12381option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12382a newly created Perl interpreter.
12383
12384The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12385need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12386should usually be something like
12387.code
12388perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12389.endd
12390where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12391use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12392soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12393the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12394its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12395fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12396necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12397the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12398two ways:
12399
12400.ilist
12401.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12402Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12403a startup when Exim is entered.
12404.next
12405The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12406overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12407.endlist
12408
12409There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12410initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12411
12412
12413.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12414When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12415of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12416by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12417forms:
12418.code
12419${perl{foo}}
12420${perl{foo}{argument}}
12421${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12422.endd
12423which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12424arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12425with an error message of the form
12426.code
12427Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12428.endd
12429The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12430it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12431return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12432an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12433by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12434that was passed to &%die%&.
12435
12436
12437.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12438Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12439is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12440the Perl code
12441.code
12442my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12443.endd
12444makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12445Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12446&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12447
12448If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12449&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12450expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12451an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12452
12453.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12454.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12455Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12456&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12457debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12458&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12459timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12460
12461
12462.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12463.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12464You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12465Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12466before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12467SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12468is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12469error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12470avoided, but the output is lost.
12471
12472.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12473The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12474Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12475you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12476output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12477change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12478For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12479.code
12480$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12481.endd
12482Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12483example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12484include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12485as the first subroutine argument.
12486.ecindex IIDperl
12487
12488
12489. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12490. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12491
12492.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12493 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12494 "Starting the daemon"
12495.cindex "daemon" "starting"
12496.cindex "interface" "listening"
12497.cindex "network interface"
12498.cindex "interface" "network"
12499.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12500.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12501.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12502.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12503A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12504hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12505or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12506works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12507In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12508IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12509knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12510
12511.olist
12512When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12513and ports to listen on.
12514.next
12515When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12516are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12517processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12518same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12519when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12520local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12521option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12522as an error situation.
12523.next
12524When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12525for the outgoing connection.
12526.endlist
12527
12528
12529Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12530of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12531addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12532standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12533rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12534
12535In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12536interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12537options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12538chapter describes how they operate.
12539
12540When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12541actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12542
12543
12544
12545.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12546When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12547option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12548following options:
12549
12550.ilist
12551&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12552compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12553.next
12554&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12555listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12556.endlist
12557
12558The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12559described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12560it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12561colons. For example:
12562.code
12563local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12564 192.168.23.65 ; \
12565 ::1 ; \
12566 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12567.endd
12568There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12569in &%local_interfaces%&:
12570
12571.olist
12572The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12573on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12574.code
12575local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12576 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12577.endd
12578.next
12579The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12580with a colon separator, for example:
12581.code
12582local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12583 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12584.endd
12585.endlist
12586
12587When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12588default setting contains just one port:
12589.code
12590daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12591.endd
12592If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12593specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12594&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12595&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12596IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12597
12598
12599
12600.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12601The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12602as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12603case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12604instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12605default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12606.code
12607local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12608.endd
12609when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12610.code
12611local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12612.endd
12613Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12614
12615
12616
12617.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12618The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12619&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12620instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12621option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12622the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12623exim.
12624
12625The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12626changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12627contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12628&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12629items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12630replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12631.code
12632-oX 1225
12633.endd
12634overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12635whereas
12636.code
12637-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12638.endd
12639overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12640(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12641value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12642
12643
12644
12645.section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12646.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12647.cindex "smtps protocol"
12648.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12649.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12650Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12651before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12652still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12653list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12654common use of this option is expected to be
12655.code
12656tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12657.endd
12658because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12659a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12660this way when a daemon is started.
12661
12662&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12663daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12664&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12665because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12666connections via the daemon.)
12667
12668
12669
12670
12671.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12672.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12673IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12674can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12675interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12676address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12677percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12678adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12679.code
12680fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12681.endd
12682To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12683allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12684to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12685percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12686address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12687&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12688.code
12689IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12690.endd
12691is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12692Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12693instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12694function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12695&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12696
12697.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12698.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12699Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12700run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12701using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12702connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12703.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12704&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12705activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12706that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12707etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12708to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12709
12710On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12711disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12712option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12713and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12714IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12715
12716
12717
12718.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12719The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12720.code
12721daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12722local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12723.endd
12724This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12725Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12726the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12727read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12728
12729To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12730.code
12731daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12732.endd
12733(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12734.code
12735local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12736 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12737.endd
12738To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12739IPv4 loopback address only:
12740.code
12741local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12742.endd
12743To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12744.code
12745local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
12746.endd
12747&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12748
12749
12750
12751.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12752The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12753whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12754addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12755treated as local.
12756
12757For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12758the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12759available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12760(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12761
12762Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12763many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12764email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12765interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12766&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12767&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12768used for listening. Consider this example:
12769.code
12770local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12771 192.168.53.235 ; \
12772 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12773
12774extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12775.endd
12776The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12777address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12778Exim is routing.
12779
12780In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12781address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12782desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12783these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12784This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12785during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12786host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12787addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12788
12789
12790
12791.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12792Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12793allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12794there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12795&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12796description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12797details.
12798
12799
12800
12801
12802. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12803. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12804
12805.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12806.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12807.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12808The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12809
12810.ilist
12811Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12812&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12813.next
12814Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12815&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12816section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12817.next
12818Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12819(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12820&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12821only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12822settings.
12823.endlist
12824
12825This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12826types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12827in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12828are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12829an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12830listed in more than one group.
12831
12832.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12833.table2
12834.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12835.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12836.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12837.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12838.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12839.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12840.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12841.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12842.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12843.endtable
12844
12845
12846.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12847.table2
12848.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12849.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12850.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12851.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12852.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12853.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12854.endtable
12855
12856
12857
12858.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12859.table2
12860.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12861.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12862.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12863.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12864.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12865.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12866.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12867.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12868.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12869.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12870.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12871.endtable
12872
12873
12874
12875.section "Logging" "SECID99"
12876.table2
12877.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12878.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12879.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12880.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12881.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12882.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12883.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12884.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12885.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12886.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12887.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12888.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12889.endtable
12890
12891
12892
12893.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12894.table2
12895.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12896.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12897.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12898.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12899.endtable
12900
12901
12902
12903.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12904.table2
12905.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12906.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12907.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12908.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12909.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12910.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12911.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12912.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12913.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12914.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12915.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12916.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12917.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12918.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12919.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12920.endtable
12921
12922
12923
12924.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12925.table2
12926.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12927.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12928.endtable
12929
12930
12931
12932.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12933.table2
12934.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12935.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12936.endtable
12937
12938
12939
12940.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12941.table2
12942.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12943.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12944.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12945.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12946.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12947.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12948.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12949.endtable
12950
12951
12952
12953.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12954.table2
12955.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12956.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12957.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12958.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12959.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12960.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12961.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12962.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12963.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12964.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12965.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12966.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12967.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12968.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12969.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12970.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12971 connection"
12972.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12973.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12974.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12975.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12976.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12977.endtable
12978
12979
12980
12981.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12982.table2
12983.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12984.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12985.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12986.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12987.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12988.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12989.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12990.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12991.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12992.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12993.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12994.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12995.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12996.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12997.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12998.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12999.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13000.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13001.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13002.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13003 words""&"
13004.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13005.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13006.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13007.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13008.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13009.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13010.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13011.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13012.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13013.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13014.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13015.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13016.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13017.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13018.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13019.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13020.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13021.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13022.endtable
13023
13024
13025
13026.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13027.table2
13028.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13029 item"
13030.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13031 item"
13032.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13033.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13034.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13035.endtable
13036
13037
13038
13039.section "TLS" "SECID108"
13040.table2
13041.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13042.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13043.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13044.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13045.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13046.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13047.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13048.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13049.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13050.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13051.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13052.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13053.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13054.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13055.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13056.endtable
13057
13058
13059
13060.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13061.table2
13062.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13063.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13064.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13065.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13066.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13067.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13068.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13069.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13070.endtable
13071
13072
13073
13074.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13075.table2
13076.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13077.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13078.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13079.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13080.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13081.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13082.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13083.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13084.endtable
13085
13086
13087
13088
13089.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13090.table2
13091.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13092.endtable
13093
13094
13095
13096
13097
13098.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13099See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13100
13101.table2
13102.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13103.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13104.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13105.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13106.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13107.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13108.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13109.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13110.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13111.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13112.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13113.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13114.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13115.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13116 connection"
13117.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13118.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13119.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13120.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13121.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13122.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13123.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13124.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13125.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13126.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13127.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13128.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13129.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13130.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13131.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13132.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13133.endtable
13134
13135
13136
13137.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13138.table2
13139.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13140.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13141.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13142.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13143.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13144.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13145.endtable
13146
13147
13148
13149.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13150.table2
13151.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13152.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13153.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13154.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13155 words""&"
13156.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13157.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13158.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13159.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13160.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13161.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13162.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13163.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13164.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13165.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13166.endtable
13167
13168
13169
13170.section "System filter" "SECID115"
13171.table2
13172.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13173.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13174 directory"
13175.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13176.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13177.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13178.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13179.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13180.endtable
13181
13182
13183
13184.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13185.table2
13186.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13187.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13188.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13189.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13190.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13191.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13192.row &%dns_use_dnssec%& "parameter for resolver"
13193.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13194.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13195.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13196.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13197.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13198.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13199.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13200.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13201.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13202.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13203.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13204.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13205.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13206.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13207.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13208.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13209.endtable
13210
13211
13212
13213.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13214.table2
13215.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13216.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13217.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13218.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13219.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13220.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13221.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13222.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13223.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13224.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13225.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13226.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13227.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13228.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13229.endtable
13230
13231
13232
13233.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13234Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13235&dagger;.
13236
13237.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13238.cindex "8BITMIME"
13239.cindex "8-bit characters"
13240.cindex "log" "selectors"
13241.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13242This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13243EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13244However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13245takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13246
13247Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13248feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13249It now defaults to true.
13250A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13251.display
13252&url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13253.endd
13254
13255.new
13256To log received 8BITMIME status use
13257.code
13258log_selector = +8bitmime
13259.endd
13260.wen
13261
13262.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13263.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13264.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13265This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13266read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13267further details.
13268
13269.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13270This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13271messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13272SMTP messages.
13273
13274.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13275.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13276.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13277This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13278non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13279
13280.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13281.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13282.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13283This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13284received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13285
13286.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13287.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13288This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13289See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13290
13291.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13292.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13293This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13294processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13295acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13296
13297.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13298.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13299This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13300received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13301
13302.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13303.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13304This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13305received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13306
13307.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13308.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13309.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13310This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13311command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13312
13313
13314.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13315.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13316This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13317received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13318
13319.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13320.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13321This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13322a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13323&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13324
13325.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13326.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13327This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13328extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13329section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13330
13331.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13332This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13333received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13334further details.
13335
13336.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13337.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13338This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13339received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13340
13341.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13342.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13343This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13344received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13345
13346.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13347.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13348This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13349received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13350
13351.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13352.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13353This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13354received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13355
13356.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13357.cindex "admin user"
13358This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13359current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13360colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13361programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13362admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13363not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13364To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13365
13366.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13367.cindex "domain literal"
13368If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13369email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13370format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13371has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13372
13373Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13374format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13375addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13376&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13377domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13378configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13379the local host's IP addresses.
13380
13381
13382.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13383.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13384It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13385and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13386MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13387that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13388practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13389&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13390recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13391
13392.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13393.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13394.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13395Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13396camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13397that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13398experiment if they wish.
13399
13400If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13401UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13402letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13403enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13404adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13405suitable setting is:
13406.code
13407dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13408 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13409.endd
13410Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13411.code
13412dns_check_names_pattern =
13413.endd
13414That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13415
13416
13417.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13418.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13419.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13420If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13421response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13422Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13423Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13424advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13425authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13426&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13427authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13428
13429Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13430and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13431not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13432authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13433to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13434which Exim advertises AUTH.
13435
13436.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13437If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13438is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13439option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13440.code
13441auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13442.endd
13443.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13444If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13445the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13446expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13447
13448
13449.option auto_thaw main time 0s
13450.cindex "thawing messages"
13451.cindex "unfreezing messages"
13452If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13453new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13454this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13455being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13456saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13457
13458&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13459&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13460thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13461
13462
13463.option av_scanner main string "see below"
13464This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13465It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13466.code
13467sophie:/var/run/sophie
13468.endd
13469If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13470before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13471
13472
13473.option bi_command main string unset
13474.oindex "&%-bi%&"
13475This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13476the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13477just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13478required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13479
13480
13481.option bounce_message_file main string unset
13482.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13483.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13484This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13485for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13486chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13487
13488
13489.option bounce_message_text main string unset
13490When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13491message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13492delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13493
13494.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13495.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13496This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13497bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13498causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13499value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13500message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13501error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13502point at which the error was detected are returned.
13503.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13504
13505.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13506If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13507bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13508&%bounce_return_body%&.
13509
13510
13511.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13512.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13513.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13514.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13515This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13516senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13517limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13518any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13519that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13520
13521When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13522greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13523added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13524to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13525size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13526messages.
13527
13528.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13529.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13530.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13531.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13532This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13533bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13534connection. A typical setting might be:
13535.code
13536bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13537.endd
13538which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13539.code
13540MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13541.endd
13542The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13543address.
13544
13545.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13546.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13547.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13548This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13549domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13550section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13551
13552
13553.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13554This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13555domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13556section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13557
13558
13559.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13560This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13561address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13562section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13563
13564
13565.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13566This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13567address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13568section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13569
13570
13571.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13572This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13573callout verification. The default value is
13574.code
13575$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13576.endd
13577See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13578
13579
13580.option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13581See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13582
13583
13584.option check_log_space main integer 0
13585See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13586
13587.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13588.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13589.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13590RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13591system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13592word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13593multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13594exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13595of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13596set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13597
13598
13599.option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13600See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13601
13602
13603.option check_spool_space main integer 0
13604.cindex "checking disk space"
13605.cindex "disk space, checking"
13606.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13607The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13608message is accepted.
13609
13610.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13611.vindex "&$log_space$&"
13612.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13613.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13614When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13615want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13616testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13617&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13618
13619
13620&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13621either value is greater than zero, for example:
13622.code
13623check_spool_space = 10M
13624check_spool_inodes = 100
13625.endd
13626The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13627SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13628transit.
13629
13630&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13631files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13632&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13633
13634If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13635incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13636error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13637SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13638&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13639&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13640
13641The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13642number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13643
13644For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13645failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13646it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13647
13648.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13649.cindex "port" "for daemon"
13650.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13651This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13652listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13653backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13654
13655.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13656.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13657This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13658the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13659(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13660defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13661&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13662
13663.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13664See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13665
13666.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13667.cindex "warning of delay"
13668.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13669When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13670intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13671after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13672string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13673message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13674between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13675with
13676.code
13677delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13678.endd
13679the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13680the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13681because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13682just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13683.code
13684delay_warning = 6h
13685.endd
13686messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13687a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13688.code
13689delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13690.endd
13691
13692.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13693.vindex "&$domain$&"
13694The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13695deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13696expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13697forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13698&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13699not sent. The default is:
13700.code
13701delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13702 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13703 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13704 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13705 } {no}{yes}}
13706.endd
13707This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13708&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13709&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13710&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13711
13712.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13713.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13714.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13715If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13716delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13717the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13718of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13719chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13720
13721.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13722.cindex "load average"
13723.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13724When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13725becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13726ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13727See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13728
13729
13730.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13731.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13732Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13733message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13734handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13735should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13736removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13737occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13738
13739.option disable_fsync main boolean false
13740.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13741This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13742ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13743a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13744build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13745really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13746distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13747
13748When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13749updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13750such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13751Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13752
13753
13754.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13755.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13756If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13757activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13758that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13759etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13760to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13761
13762
13763.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13764.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13765DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13766&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13767keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13768incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13769may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13770anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13771This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13772by a setting such as this:
13773.code
13774dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13775.endd
13776This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13777&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13778since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13779&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13780when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13781options are applied after this global option.
13782
13783.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13784.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13785When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13786names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13787the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13788contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13789a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13790done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13791value of this option. The default pattern is
13792.code
13793dns_check_names_pattern = \
13794 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13795.endd
13796which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13797they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13798permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13799accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13800&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13801empty string.
13802
13803.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13804This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13805DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13806
13807.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13808This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13809reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13810section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13811
13812.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13813.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13814.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13815When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13816looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13817(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13818domain matches this list.
13819
13820This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13821not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13822servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13823
13824
13825.option dns_retrans main time 0s
13826.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13827The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13828retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13829defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13830time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13831totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13832take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13833parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13834but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13835to set in them.
13836
13837
13838.option dns_retry main integer 0
13839See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13840
13841
13842.new
13843.option dns_use_dnssec main integer -1
13844.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13845.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13846If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13847DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
13848default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
13849
13850If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
13851.wen
13852
13853
13854.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13855.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13856.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13857If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13858DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13859the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13860on.
13861
13862If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13863
13864
13865.option drop_cr main boolean false
13866This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13867handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13868described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13869
13870.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13871.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13872.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13873This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13874bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13875Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13876.code
13877dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13878.endd
13879The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13880panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13881
13882.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13883.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13884Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13885message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13886handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13887messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13888be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13889the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13890delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13891
13892
13893.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13894.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13895.cindex "copy of bounce message"
13896Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13897generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13898coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13899items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13900a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13901must be enclosed in double quotes.
13902
13903Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13904(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13905the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13906items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13907are examined. For example:
13908.code
13909errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13910 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13911 postmaster@mydomain.example
13912.endd
13913.vindex "&$domain$&"
13914.vindex "&$local_part$&"
13915The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13916and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13917there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13918.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13919variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13920
13921
13922.option errors_reply_to main string unset
13923.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13924By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13925.display
13926&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13927.endd
13928.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13929where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13930A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13931&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13932overrides the default.
13933
13934Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13935&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13936and warning messages. For example:
13937.code
13938errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13939.endd
13940The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13941address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13942&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13943own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13944not used.
13945
13946
13947.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13948.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13949.cindex "Exim group"
13950This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13951privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13952option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13953of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13954configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13955security issues.
13956
13957
13958.option exim_path main string "see below"
13959.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13960This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13961needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13962the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13963is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13964other place.
13965&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13966you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13967where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13968settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13969
13970
13971.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13972.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13973.cindex "Exim user"
13974This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13975privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13976time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13977options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13978
13979Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13980&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13981not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13982used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13983
13984
13985.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13986This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13987routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13988&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13989
13990
13991. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13992. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13993
13994.option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13995 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13996.oindex "&%-t%&"
13997.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13998.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13999According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14000are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14001envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14002line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14003behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14004command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14005&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14006argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14007addresses.
14008
14009
14010.option finduser_retries main integer 0
14011.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14012On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14013distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14014related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14015Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14016errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14017many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14018retries.
14019
14020.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14021You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14022a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14023search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14024
14025
14026
14027.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14028.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14029On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14030ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14031delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14032&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14033feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14034warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14035freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14036is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14037supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14038message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14039freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14040log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14041logging that you require.
14042
14043
14044.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14045.cindex "HP-UX"
14046.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14047Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14048password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14049looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14050headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14051of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14052it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14053upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14054
14055When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14056expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14057login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14058user's name.
14059
14060.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14061Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14062pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14063name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14064.code
14065gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14066gecos_name = $1
14067.endd
14068
14069.option gecos_pattern main string unset
14070See &%gecos_name%& above.
14071
14072
14073.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14074This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14075server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14076implementations of TLS.
14077
14078
14079.new
14080option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14081This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14082the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14083
14084See
14085&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14086for documentation.
14087.wen
14088
14089
14090
14091.option headers_charset main string "see below"
14092This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14093&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14094default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14095ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14096insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14097
14098
14099
14100.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14101.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14102.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14103This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14104section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14105&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14106sections are rejected.
14107
14108
14109.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14110.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14111.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14112This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14113all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14114header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14115zero means &"no limit"&.
14116
14117
14118
14119
14120.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14121.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14122.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14123Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14124mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14125some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14126this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14127if you want to do semantic checking.
14128See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14129set.
14130
14131
14132.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14133.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14134.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14135.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14136This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14137all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14138hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14139.code
14140helo_allow_chars = _
14141.endd
14142Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14143
14144
14145.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14146.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14147.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14148If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14149list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14150default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14151its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14152do.
14153
14154
14155.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14156.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14157.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14158By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14159&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14160to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14161condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14162Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14163to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14164necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14165encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14166Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14167
14168When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14169&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14170EHLO command either:
14171
14172.ilist
14173is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14174.next
14175.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14176.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14177matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14178calling host address, or
14179.next
14180when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14181available) yields the calling host address.
14182.endlist
14183
14184However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14185fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14186be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14187
14188.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14189.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14190.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14191Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14192backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14193name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14194&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14195rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14196If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14197error.
14198
14199.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14200.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14201.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14202This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14203manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14204&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14205verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14206item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14207it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14208
14209This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14210delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14211configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14212domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14213&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14214
14215A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14216messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14217time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14218retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14219
14220
14221.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14222.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14223Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14224is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14225&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14226option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14227default configuration file contains
14228.code
14229host_lookup = *
14230.endd
14231which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14232is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14233
14234After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14235has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14236this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14237
14238.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14239.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14240After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14241unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14242&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14243&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14244
14245
14246.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14247This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14248to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14249first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14250if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14251if you want.
14252
14253&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14254multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14255&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14256case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14257
14258
14259
14260.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14261.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14262If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14263as soon as the connection is made.
14264This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14265nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14266connections immediately.
14267
14268The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14269ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14270sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14271incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14272chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14273
14274
14275.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14276.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14277This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14278happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14279you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14280127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14281the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14282list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14283local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14284.code
14285hosts_connection_nolog = :
14286.endd
14287If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14288
14289
14290
14291.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14292.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14293.cindex "host" "treated as local"
14294If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14295if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14296records
14297or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14298host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14299
14300This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14301&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14302section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14303&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14304that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14305chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14306interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14307
14308
14309.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14310.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14311This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14312to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14313The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14314
14315
14316
14317.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14318.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14319.cindex "discarding bounce message"
14320This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14321that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14322suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14323
14324After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14325because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14326message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14327the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14328again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14329bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14330for frozen messages. For example,
14331.code
14332ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14333.endd
14334retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14335failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14336failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14337value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14338dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14339&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14340
14341
14342.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14343.cindex "&""From""& line"
14344.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14345Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14346the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14347message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14348such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14349match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14350process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14351&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14352
14353
14354.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14355See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14356
14357
14358.option keep_malformed main time 4d
14359This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14360have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14361next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14362logged.
14363
14364
14365.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14366.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14367This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14368a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14369While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14370Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14371and constrained to be a directory.
14372
14373
14374.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14375.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14376This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14377a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14378While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14379Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14380and constrained to be a file.
14381
14382
14383.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14384.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14385This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14386Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14387Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14388
14389
14390.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14391.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14392This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14393to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14394Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14395identity to be proven.
14396
14397
14398.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14399.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14400This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14401the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14402cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14403
14404
14405.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14406.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14407This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14408LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14409details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14410with LDAP support.
14411
14412
14413.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14414.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14415This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14416A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14417See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14418Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14419to hard/demand.
14420
14421
14422.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14423.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14424If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14425connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14426"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14427of SSL-on-connect.
14428In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14429by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14430
14431
14432.option ldap_version main integer unset
14433.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14434This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14435LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14436-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14437the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14438has been built with LDAP support.
14439
14440
14441
14442.option local_from_check main boolean true
14443.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14444.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14445When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14446an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14447checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14448the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14449
14450&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14451locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14452&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14453
14454You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14455on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14456&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14457and the default qualify domain.
14458
14459If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14460and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14461&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14462&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14463
14464.cindex "envelope sender"
14465These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14466is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14467&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14468
14469For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14470request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14471has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14472
14473
14474
14475
14476.option local_from_prefix main string unset
14477When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14478matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14479ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14480done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14481appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14482&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14483example, if
14484.code
14485local_from_prefix = *-
14486.endd
14487is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14488.code
14489From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14490.endd
14491will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14492matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14493qualify domain.
14494
14495
14496.option local_from_suffix main string unset
14497See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14498
14499
14500.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14501This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14502listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14503&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14504options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14505&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14506&%local_interfaces%& is
14507.code
14508local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14509.endd
14510when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14511.code
14512local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14513.endd
14514
14515.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14516.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14517.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14518This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14519&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14520the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14521message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14522non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14523
14524
14525
14526.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14527.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14528When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14529an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14530do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14531also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14532See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14533&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14534
14535
14536
14537
14538.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14539.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14540.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14541.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14542Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14543uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14544value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14545after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14546host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14547range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14548systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14549&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14550characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14551time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14552section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14553
14554
14555
14556.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14557.cindex "log" "file path for"
14558This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14559files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14560when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14561name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14562are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14563Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14564section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14565used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14566variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14567configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14568&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14569early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14570
14571
14572.option log_selector main string unset
14573.cindex "log" "selectors"
14574This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14575writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14576minus characters. For example:
14577.code
14578log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14579.endd
14580A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14581logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14582
14583
14584.option log_timezone main boolean false
14585.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14586.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14587.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14588By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14589timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14590in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14591avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14592&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14593timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14594of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14595&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14596another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14597
14598
14599.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14600.cindex "too many open files"
14601.cindex "open files, too many"
14602.cindex "file" "too many open"
14603.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14604.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14605This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14606lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14607Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14608file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14609recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14610actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14611as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14612open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14613&%lookup_open_max%&.
14614
14615
14616.option max_username_length main integer 0
14617.cindex "length of login name"
14618.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14619.cindex "limit" "user name length"
14620Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14621&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14622this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14623an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14624
14625
14626.option message_body_newlines main bool false
14627.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14628.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14629.vindex "&$message_body$&"
14630.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14631By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14632the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14633option is set true, this no longer happens.
14634
14635
14636.option message_body_visible main integer 500
14637.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14638.cindex "message body" "visible size"
14639.vindex "&$message_body$&"
14640.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14641This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14642&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14643
14644
14645.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14646.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14647If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14648(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14649locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14650means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14651Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14652Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14653replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14654empty string, the option is ignored.
14655
14656
14657.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14658If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14659the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14660message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14661take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14662the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14663it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14664yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14665before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14666that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14667means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14668colons will become hyphens.
14669
14670
14671.option message_logs main boolean true
14672.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14673.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14674If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14675&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14676Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14677minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14678per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14679which is not affected by this option.
14680
14681
14682.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14683.cindex "message" "size limit"
14684.cindex "limit" "message size"
14685.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14686This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14687value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14688to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14689TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14690optionally followed by K or M.
14691
14692&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14693other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14694the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14695error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14696&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14697
14698Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14699exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14700failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14701an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14702the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14703message that an individual transport can process.
14704
14705If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14706maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14707failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14708virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14709probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14710default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14711some problems may result.
14712
14713A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14714SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14715SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14716
14717
14718.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14719.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14720This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14721.code
14722SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14723.endd
14724in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14725moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14726and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14727standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14728lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14729
14730
14731.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14732Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14733it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14734contains a full description of this facility.
14735
14736
14737
14738.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14739.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14740This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14741be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14742option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14743
14744
14745.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14746This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14747message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14748recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14749It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14750safety precaution.
14751
14752When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14753list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14754the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14755contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14756can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14757
14758If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14759&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14760example is
14761.code
14762never_users = root:daemon:bin
14763.endd
14764Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14765harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14766transport driver.
14767
14768
14769.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14770.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14771This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14772by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14773each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14774
14775This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14776available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14777The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14778the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14779list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14780&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14781names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14782
14783Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14784SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14785yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14786adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14787invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14788
14789Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14790"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14791with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14792some now infamous attacks.
14793
14794An example:
14795.code
14796# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14797openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14798 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14799.endd
14800
14801Possible options may include:
14802.ilist
14803&`all`&
14804.next
14805&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14806.next
14807&`cipher_server_preference`&
14808.next
14809&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14810.next
14811&`ephemeral_rsa`&
14812.next
14813&`legacy_server_connect`&
14814.next
14815&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14816.next
14817&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14818.next
14819&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14820.next
14821&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14822.next
14823&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14824.next
14825&`no_compression`&
14826.next
14827&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14828.next
14829&`no_sslv2`&
14830.next
14831&`no_sslv3`&
14832.next
14833&`no_ticket`&
14834.next
14835&`no_tlsv1`&
14836.next
14837&`no_tlsv1_1`&
14838.next
14839&`no_tlsv1_2`&
14840.next
14841.new
14842&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
14843.wen
14844.next
14845&`single_dh_use`&
14846.next
14847&`single_ecdh_use`&
14848.next
14849&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14850.next
14851&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14852.next
14853&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14854.next
14855&`tls_d5_bug`&
14856.next
14857&`tls_rollback_bug`&
14858.endlist
14859
14860.new
14861As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
14862all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
14863to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
14864to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
14865release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
14866where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
14867.wen
14868
14869
14870.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14871.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14872This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14873to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14874The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14875
14876
14877.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14878.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14879.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14880.cindex "address" "source-routed"
14881The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14882percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14883replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14884also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14885option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14886but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14887an ACL.
14888
14889&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14890trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14891if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14892implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14893routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14894a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14895local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14896
14897
14898.option perl_at_start main boolean false
14899This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14900interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14901
14902
14903.option perl_startup main string unset
14904This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14905interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14906
14907
14908.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14909.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14910This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14911data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14912&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14913PostgreSQL support.
14914
14915
14916.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14917.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14918.cindex "pid file, path for"
14919This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14920process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14921to the host name:
14922.code
14923pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14924.endd
14925If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14926spool directory.
14927The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14928option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14929of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14930
14931
14932.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14933.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14934This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14935PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14936control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14937&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14938for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14939that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14940not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14941
14942
14943.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14944.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14945If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14946completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14947called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14948purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14949volume of mail. Use with care!
14950
14951
14952.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14953.cindex "name" "of local host"
14954.cindex "host" "name of local"
14955.cindex "local host" "name of"
14956.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14957This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14958HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14959option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14960The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14961server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14962
14963If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14964name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14965contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14966&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14967version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14968explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14969
14970
14971.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14972.cindex "printing characters"
14973.cindex "8-bit characters"
14974By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1497532&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14976when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14977sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14978is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14979characters.
14980
14981This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14982&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14983the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14984described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14985Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14986standards.
14987
14988
14989.option process_log_path main string unset
14990.cindex "process log path"
14991.cindex "log" "process log"
14992.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14993This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14994&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14995utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14996in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14997can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14998different spool directories.
14999
15000
15001.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15002.oindex "&%-M%&"
15003.oindex "&%-R%&"
15004.oindex "&%-q%&"
15005The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15006admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15007&%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15008
15009
15010.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15011.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15012.cindex "address" "qualification"
15013This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15014addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15015recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15016are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15017also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15018locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15019
15020Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15021unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15022&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15023addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15024necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15025addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15026&%primary_hostname%& value.
15027
15028
15029.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15030This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15031addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15032
15033
15034
15035.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15036.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15037.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15038.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15039This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15040A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15041domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15042next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15043
15044
15045.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15046.oindex "&%-bp%&"
15047The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15048queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15049&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15050
15051
15052.option queue_only main boolean false
15053.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15054.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15055If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15056whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15057next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15058delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15059
15060The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15061and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15062&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15063&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15064
15065
15066.option queue_only_file main string unset
15067.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15068.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15069This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15070one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15071it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15072each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15073For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15074&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15075.code
15076queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15077.endd
15078causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15079&_/some/file_& exists.
15080
15081
15082.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15083.cindex "load average"
15084.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15085.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15086If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15087all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15088happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15089the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15090the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15091false.
15092
15093Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15094option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15095determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15096&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15097
15098
15099.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15100.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15101When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15102because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15103all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15104This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15105threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15106connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15107circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15108where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15109should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15110re-evaluated for each message.
15111
15112
15113.option queue_only_override main boolean true
15114.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15115When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15116setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15117&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15118to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15119
15120
15121.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15122.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15123If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15124in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15125must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15126single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15127and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15128single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15129the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15130avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15131&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15132when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15133large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15134
15135
15136
15137.option queue_run_max main integer 5
15138.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15139This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15140can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15141but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15142start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15143very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15144however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15145started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15146
15147Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15148the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15149run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15150the daemon's command line.
15151
15152.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15153.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15154.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15155When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15156received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15157However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15158&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15159message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15160has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15161when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15162over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15163SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15164&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15165&%queue_domains%&.
15166
15167
15168.option receive_timeout main time 0s
15169.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15170This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15171maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15172the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15173&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15174controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15175
15176.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15177.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15178.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15179This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15180added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15181on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15182used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15183added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15184&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15185header lines. The default setting is:
15186
15187.code
15188received_header_text = Received: \
15189 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15190 {${if def:sender_ident \
15191 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15192 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15193 by $primary_hostname \
15194 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15195 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15196 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15197 ${if def:sender_address \
15198 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15199 id $message_exim_id\
15200 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15201.endd
15202
15203The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15204support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15205locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15206header lines such as the following:
15207.code
15208Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15209by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15210(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15211id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15212for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15213Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15214id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15215.endd
15216Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15217the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15218checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15219message was accepted.
15220
15221
15222.option received_headers_max main integer 30
15223.cindex "loop" "prevention"
15224.cindex "mail loop prevention"
15225.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15226When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15227counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15228have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15229This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15230
15231
15232.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15233.cindex "unqualified addresses"
15234.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15235This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15236recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15237qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15238affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15239addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15240host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15241or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15242option was not set.
15243
15244
15245.option recipients_max main integer 0
15246.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15247.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15248If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15249original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15250by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15251all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15252Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15253done.
15254
15255.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15256&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15257RCPT commands in a single message.
15258
15259
15260.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15261If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15262recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15263error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15264error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15265initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15266for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15267
15268
15269.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15270.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15271This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15272hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15273does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15274message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15275have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15276deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15277deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15278each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15279same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15280&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15281with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15282tagged with its process id.
15283
15284This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15285message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15286manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15287deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15288is received.
15289
15290.cindex "number of deliveries"
15291.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15292If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15293need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15294are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15295daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15296fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15297runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15298delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15299then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15300&%remote_max_parallel%&.
15301
15302If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15303&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15304doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15305host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15306
15307
15308.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15309.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15310.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15311When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15312domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15313.code
15314remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15315.endd
15316would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15317then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15318
15319
15320.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15321.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15322This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15323database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15324host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15325past failures.
15326
15327
15328.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15329.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15330.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15331Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15332intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15333straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15334retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15335the default value.
15336
15337
15338.option return_path_remove main boolean true
15339.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15340RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15341&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15342The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15343MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15344in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15345&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15346received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15347the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15348
15349
15350.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15351This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15352
15353
15354.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15355.cindex "RFC 1413"
15356.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15357RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15358in the list.
15359
15360.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15361.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15362.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15363This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15364no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15365
15366
15367.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15368.cindex "unqualified addresses"
15369.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15370This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15371sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15372&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15373not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15374it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15375&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15376using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15377
15378
15379.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15380.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15381This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15382TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15383connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15384other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15385still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15386this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15387connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15388tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15389hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15390
15391
15392
15393.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15394.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15395.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15396.cindex "inetd"
15397This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15398that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15399control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15400value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15401non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15402set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15403
15404A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15405has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15406that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15407and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15408
15409
15410.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15411.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15412.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15413Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15414the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15415check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15416client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15417client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15418
15419When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15420allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15421but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15422or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15423starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15424counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15425following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15426MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15427
15428
15429.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15430You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15431check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15432changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15433live with.
15434
15435
15436. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15437. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15438. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15439. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15440. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15441. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15442. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15443. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15444. the option name to split.
15445
15446.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15447 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15448.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15449.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15450The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15451prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15452results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15453response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15454precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15455seen).
15456
15457
15458.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15459.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15460.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15461This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15462host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15463expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15464reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15465connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15466is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15467of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15468required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15469
15470&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15471constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15472happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15473without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15474could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15475doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15476
15477
15478
15479.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15480.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15481.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15482.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15483If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15484listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15485on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15486fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15487subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15488to all messages received in the same connection.
15489
15490A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15491if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15492also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15493various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15494
15495
15496. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15497
15498.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15499 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15500.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15501.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15502This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15503automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15504the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15505and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15506number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15507are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15508restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15509systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15510dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15511
15512
15513.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15514.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15515.cindex "host" "reserved"
15516When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15517number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15518that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15519&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15520restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15521of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15522of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15523the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15524individual host.
15525
15526For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15527set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15528connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15529provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15530
15531
15532.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15533.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15534.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15535.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15536This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15537several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15538is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15539responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15540incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15541
15542.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15543The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15544is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15545in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15546
15547If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15548expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15549used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15550panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15551value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15552For example:
15553.code
15554smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15555 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15556.endd
15557
15558Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15559messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15560verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15561&%helo_data%& value.
15562
15563.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15564.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15565.cindex "banner for SMTP"
15566.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15567.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15568This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15569positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15570.code
15571smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15572 $version_number $tod_full
15573.endd
15574Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15575multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15576appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15577in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15578multiline response).
15579
15580
15581.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15582.cindex "checking disk space"
15583.cindex "disk space, checking"
15584.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15585When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15586option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15587spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15588leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15589is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15590
15591
15592.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15593.cindex "connection backlog"
15594.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15595.cindex "backlog of connections"
15596This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15597this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15598of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15599attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15600say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15601out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15602value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15603attacks by SYN flooding.
15604
15605
15606.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15607.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15608.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15609The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15610the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15611synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15612fewer, but they still exist.
15613
15614Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15615for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15616client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15617SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15618for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15619input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15620does detect many instances.
15621
15622The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15623If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15624hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15625(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15626
15627
15628
15629.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15630.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15631.vindex "&$domain$&"
15632If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15633command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15634chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15635are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15636argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15637example:
15638.code
15639smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15640 $sender_host_address
15641.endd
15642A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15643complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15644run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15645a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15646receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15647the command.
15648
15649
15650.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15651.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15652When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15653one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15654section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15655
15656
15657.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15658.cindex "load average"
15659If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15660accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15661If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15662the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15663systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15664&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15665
15666
15667
15668.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15669.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15670.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15671Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15672particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15673.code
15674RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15675.endd
15676causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15677(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15678example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15679too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15680dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15681
15682.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15683When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15684&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15685Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15686&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15687not count towards the limit.
15688
15689
15690
15691.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15692.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15693.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15694If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15695Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15696that subvert web
15697clients
15698into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15699non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15700
15701
15702
15703.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15704.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15705.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15706.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15707Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15708can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15709recipients.
15710
15711Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15712facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15713&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15714&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15715
15716When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15717&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15718rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15719respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15720values:
15721
15722.ilist
15723A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15724.next
15725An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15726fractional parts are allowed here.
15727.next
15728A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15729.next
15730A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15731because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15732.endlist
15733
15734For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15735first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15736.code
15737smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15738smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15739.endd
15740The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15741two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15742seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15743delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15744
15745
15746.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15747See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15748
15749
15750.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15751See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15752
15753
15754.option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15755.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15756.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15757This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15758input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15759data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15760the message is abandoned.
15761A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15762.code
15763SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15764SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15765.endd
15766The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15767means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15768
15769
15770.oindex "&%-os%&"
15771The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15772&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15773this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15774of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15775timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15776
15777
15778.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15779This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15780&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15781
15782
15783.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15784.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15785.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15786In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15787&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15788reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15789to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15790policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15791&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15792example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15793.code
15794550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15795550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15796.endd
15797
15798.option spamd_address main string "see below"
15799This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15800extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15801The default value is
15802.code
15803127.0.0.1 783
15804.endd
15805See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15806
15807
15808
15809.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15810.cindex "multiple spool directories"
15811.cindex "spool directory" "split"
15812.cindex "directories, multiple"
15813If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15814subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15815sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15816subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15817arrival of the message.
15818
15819Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15820where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15821directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15822directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15823are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15824
15825It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15826changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15827&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15828after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15829automatically deleted.
15830
15831When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15832changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15833trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15834sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15835sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15836spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15837particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15838if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15839entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15840
15841
15842.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15843.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15844This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15845it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15846configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15847string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15848&$primary_hostname$&.
15849
15850If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15851that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15852log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15853Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15854as failures in the configuration file.
15855
15856By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15857tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15858
15859.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15860.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15861This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15862access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15863
15864.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15865.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15866This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15867variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15868is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15869&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15870
15871.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15872.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15873If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15874items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15875treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15876passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15877option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15878
15879
15880.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15881.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15882.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15883If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15884ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15885MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15886domain causes a syntax error.
15887However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15888syntax checking.
15889
15890
15891.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15892.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15893When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15894separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15895be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15896separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15897nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15898particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15899both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15900containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15901Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15902the LOG_ALERT priority.
15903
15904
15905.option syslog_facility main string unset
15906.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15907This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15908syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15909&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15910If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15911details of Exim's logging.
15912
15913
15914
15915.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15916.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15917This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15918syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15919&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15920
15921
15922
15923.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15924.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15925If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15926omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15927details of Exim's logging.
15928
15929
15930.option system_filter main string&!! unset
15931.cindex "filter" "system filter"
15932.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15933.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15934This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15935the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15936must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15937generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15938appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15939which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15940&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15941
15942
15943.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15944.vindex "&$address_file$&"
15945This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15946&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15947implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15948During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15949
15950
15951.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15952.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15953This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15954command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15955the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15956
15957.option system_filter_group main string unset
15958.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15959This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15960gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15961with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15962
15963.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15964.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15965.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15966This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15967is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15968contains the pipe command.
15969
15970
15971.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15972.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15973This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15974is used in a system filter.
15975
15976
15977.option system_filter_user main string unset
15978.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15979If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15980delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15981process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15982Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15983is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15984configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15985specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15986&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15987
15988If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15989under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15990transport option overrides.
15991
15992
15993.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15994.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15995.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15996.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15997If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15998TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15999turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16000performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16001should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16002However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16003this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16004daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16005TCP_NODELAY.
16006
16007
16008.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16009.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16010.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16011If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16012message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16013is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16014bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16015sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16016If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16017frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16018
16019&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16020frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16021messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16022
16023
16024.option timezone main string unset
16025.cindex "timezone, setting"
16026The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16027running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16028created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16029to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16030.code
16031timezone = UTC
16032.endd
16033The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16034or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16035is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16036time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16037runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16038unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16039
16040
16041.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16042.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16043.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16044.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16045When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16046of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16047response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16048chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16049
16050
16051.option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16052.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16053.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16054The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16055file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16056assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16057&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16058
16059&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16060receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16061use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16062option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16063
16064If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16065if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16066Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16067&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16068
16069.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16070.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16071.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16072This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16073be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16074
16075See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16076
16077
16078.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16079.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16080The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16081the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16082interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16083suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16084
16085The value must be at least 1024.
16086
16087The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16088hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16089by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16090
16091If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16092number.
16093
16094Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16095little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16096larger prime than requested.
16097
16098
16099.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16100.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16101The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16102to be used by Exim.
16103
16104If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16105parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16106PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16107OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16108fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16109loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16110and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16111
16112If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16113loaded by Exim.
16114
16115If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16116Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16117does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16118See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16119
16120If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16121a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
161222.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16123in IKE is assigned number 23.
16124
16125Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16126of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16127"ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16128"ike23".
16129
16130The available primes are:
16131&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16132&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16133&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16134
16135Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16136Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16137
16138.new
16139The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16140to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16141whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16142tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16143need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16144userbase.
16145
16146Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16147is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16148applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16149used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16150mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16151prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16152acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16153.wen
16154
16155
16156.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16157This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16158operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16159set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16160further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16161
16162
16163
16164.option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16165.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16166The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16167file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16168the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16169key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16170&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16171
16172See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16173
16174
16175.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16176.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16177.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16178If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16179&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16180support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16181TLS session.
16182
16183
16184.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16185.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16186.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16187This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16188The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16189connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16190different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16191permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16192in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16193preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16194&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16195
16196
16197.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16198.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16199.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16200See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16201
16202
16203.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
16204.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16205.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16206The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
16207a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
16208match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
16209are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
16210directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
16211option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
16212
16213These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16214than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16215the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16216connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16217Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16218use OpenSSL with a directory.
16219
16220See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16221
16222.new
16223A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16224being unset.
16225.wen
16226
16227
16228.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16229.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16230.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16231This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16232certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16233&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16234either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16235&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16236
16237Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16238&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16239present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16240aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16241the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16242connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16243ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16244
16245A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16246matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16247certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16248abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16249state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16250such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16251but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16252certificate"&.
16253
16254Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16255certificates.
16256
16257
16258.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16259.cindex "trusted groups"
16260.cindex "groups" "trusted"
16261This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16262option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16263which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16264specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16265details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16266&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16267are trusted.
16268
16269.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16270.cindex "trusted users"
16271.cindex "user" "trusted"
16272This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16273option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16274trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16275&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16276If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16277Exim user are trusted.
16278
16279.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16280.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16281.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16282This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16283the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16284gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16285used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16286can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16287is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16288&%-F%& option.
16289
16290.option unknown_username main string unset
16291See &%unknown_login%&.
16292
16293.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16294.cindex "trusted users"
16295.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16296.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16297.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16298.cindex "envelope sender"
16299When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16300normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16301default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16302senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16303is used) is ignored.
16304
16305However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16306to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16307.code
16308exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16309.endd
16310.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16311The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16312other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16313users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16314patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16315identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16316users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16317followed by a hyphen
16318by a setting like this:
16319.code
16320untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16321.endd
16322If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16323restriction, you can use
16324.code
16325untrusted_set_sender = *
16326.endd
16327The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16328only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16329to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16330parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16331&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16332necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16333overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16334described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16335
16336The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16337&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16338&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16339envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16340sender address.
16341
16342
16343.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16344.cindex "&""From""& line"
16345.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16346Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16347an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16348particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16349of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16350matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16351&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16352default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16353.code
16354From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16355From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16356.endd
16357The pattern can be seen by running
16358.code
16359exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16360.endd
16361It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16362year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16363regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16364&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16365(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16366&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16367
16368
16369.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16370See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16371
16372
16373.option warn_message_file main string unset
16374.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16375.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16376This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16377for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16378been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16379&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16380&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16381
16382
16383.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16384.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16385If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16386See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16387.ecindex IIDconfima
16388.ecindex IIDmaiconf
16389
16390
16391
16392
16393. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16394. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16395
16396.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16397.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16398.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16399This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16400Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16401
16402For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16403&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16404which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16405provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16406&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16407
16408
16409
16410.option address_data routers string&!! unset
16411.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16412The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16413precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16414router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16415&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16416delivery of the address to be deferred.
16417
16418.vindex "&$address_data$&"
16419When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16420accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16421routers, and the eventual transport.
16422
16423&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16424that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16425in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16426either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16427put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16428
16429Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16430with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16431on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16432&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16433&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16434
16435The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16436for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16437you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16438.code
16439uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16440.endd
16441In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16442.code
16443file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16444.endd
16445This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16446lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16447
16448.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16449.vindex "&$address_data$&"
16450The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16451from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16452&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16453ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16454verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16455
16456
16457
16458.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16459.oindex "&%-bt%&"
16460.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16461If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16462by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16463your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16464having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16465routing.
16466
16467
16468
16469.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16470.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16471.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16472This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16473routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16474&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16475&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16476value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16477includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16478well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16479you could put:
16480.code
16481cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16482.endd
16483on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16484and
16485.code
16486cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16487.endd
16488on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16489this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16490explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16491logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16492
16493
16494.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16495.cindex "case of local parts"
16496.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16497By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16498manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16499If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16500this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16501part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16502turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16503more details.
16504
16505.vindex "&$local_part$&"
16506.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16507.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16508The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16509router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16510an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16511is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16512addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16513and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16514
16515This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16516recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16517modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16518(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16519
16520
16521
16522.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16523.cindex "local user, checking in router"
16524.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16525.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16526.vindex "&$home$&"
16527When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16528address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16529local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16530than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16531holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16532user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16533preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16534given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16535overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16536the router is skipped.
16537
16538If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16539or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16540setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16541two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16542setting to achieve this. For example:
16543.code
16544local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16545.endd
16546Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16547up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16548&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16549
16550
16551
16552.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16553.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16554This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16555router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16556evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16557result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16558&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16559router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16560
16561If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16562precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16563
16564This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16565All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16566
16567The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16568running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16569the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16570.code
16571condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16572.endd
16573Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16574.code
16575condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16576.endd
16577
16578A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16579.code
16580condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16581condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16582condition = foobar
16583.endd
16584
16585If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16586of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16587be specified using &%condition%&.
16588
16589
16590.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16591.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16592If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16593option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
16594the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16595If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16596output, and Exim carries on processing.
16597This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16598so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16599option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16600variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16601&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16602are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16603The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
16604
16605
16606
16607.option disable_logging routers boolean false
16608If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16609or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16610unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16611transport option of the same name.
16612
16613
16614.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16615.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16616.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16617If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16618the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16619lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16620expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16621a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16622
16623
16624
16625.option driver routers string unset
16626This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16627to be used.
16628
16629
16630
16631.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16632.cindex "envelope sender"
16633.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16634If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16635transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16636there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16637message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16638provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16639expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16640
16641The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16642subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16643settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16644setting.
16645
16646If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16647the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16648address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16649expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16650
16651If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16652SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16653any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16654sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16655settings:
16656.code
16657errors_to =
16658errors_to = ""
16659.endd
16660An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16661this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16662no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16663address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16664overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16665
16666.vindex "&$address_data$&"
16667If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16668MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16669path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16670setting &%return_path%&.
16671
16672The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16673manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16674implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16675
16676
16677
16678.option expn routers&!? boolean true
16679.cindex "address" "testing"
16680.cindex "testing" "addresses"
16681.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16682.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16683If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16684as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16685want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16686on for the system alias file.
16687See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16688are evaluated.
16689
16690The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16691&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16692an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16693
16694
16695
16696.option fail_verify routers boolean false
16697.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16698Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16699&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16700
16701
16702
16703.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16704If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16705verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16706
16707
16708
16709.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16710If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16711verifying a sender, verification fails.
16712
16713
16714
16715.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16716.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16717.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16718String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16719colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16720changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16721each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16722defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16723&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16724
16725If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16726associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16727list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16728randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16729transport for further details.
16730
16731
16732.option group routers string&!! "see below"
16733.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16734.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16735.cindex "transport" "local"
16736.cindex "router" "setting group"
16737When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16738specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16739process.
16740The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16741error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16742The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16743is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16744and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16745
16746
16747
16748.option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16749.cindex "header lines" "adding"
16750.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16751This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16752associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16753option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16754the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16755&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16756message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16757header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16758&"see"& the added header lines.
16759
16760The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16761&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16762the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16763failures are treated as configuration errors.
16764
16765.new
16766Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
16767for a router; all listed headers are added.
16768.wen
16769
16770&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16771router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16772
16773.cindex "duplicate addresses"
16774.oindex "&%unseen%&"
16775&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16776additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16777For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16778address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16779modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16780circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16781which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16782avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16783
16784
16785
16786.option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16787.cindex "header lines" "removing"
16788.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16789This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16790associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16791option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16792the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16793section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16794the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16795to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16796&"see"& the original header lines.
16797
16798The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16799&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16800the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16801errors.
16802
16803Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
16804for a router; all listed headers are removed.
16805
16806&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16807router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16808
16809&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16810removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16811routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16812warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16813
16814
16815.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16816.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16817.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16818Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16819entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16820IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16821address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16822like
16823.code
16824remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16825.endd
16826by setting
16827.code
16828ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16829.endd
16830on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16831discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16832attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16833domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16834Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16835router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16836
16837You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16838means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16839.code
16840ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16841ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16842.endd
16843The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16844in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16845
16846This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16847addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16848is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16849domain that is being routed.
16850
16851.vindex "&$host_address$&"
16852During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16853checked.
16854
16855.option initgroups routers boolean false
16856.cindex "additional groups"
16857.cindex "groups" "additional"
16858.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16859.cindex "transport" "local"
16860If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16861the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16862&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16863any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16864and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16865
16866
16867
16868.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16869.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16870.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16871If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16872one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16873section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16874evaluated.
16875
16876The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16877used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16878asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16879the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16880some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16881.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16882.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16883Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16884section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16885
16886.vindex "&$local_part$&"
16887.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16888During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16889running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16890expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16891the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16892a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16893command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16894This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16895the relevant transport.
16896
16897When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16898behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16899means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16900callout.
16901
16902The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16903&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16904&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16905to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16906immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16907.code
16908real_localuser:
16909 driver = accept
16910 local_part_prefix = real-
16911 check_local_user
16912 transport = local_delivery
16913.endd
16914For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16915router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16916.code
16917 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16918 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16919.endd
16920
16921If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16922both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16923are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16924separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16925
16926
16927.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16928See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16929
16930
16931
16932.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16933.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16934.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16935This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16936local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16937&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16938mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16939character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16940parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16941&%username-foo%&.
16942
16943
16944.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16945See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16946
16947
16948
16949.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16950.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16951.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16952The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16953See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16954are evaluated, and
16955section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16956string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16957example:
16958.code
16959local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16960.endd
16961.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16962If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16963for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16964expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16965example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16966send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16967each virtual domain:
16968.code
16969postmaster:
16970 driver = redirect
16971 local_parts = postmaster
16972 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16973.endd
16974
16975
16976.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16977.cindex "log" "delivery line"
16978.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16979Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16980deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16981recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16982this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16983router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16984router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16985redirect addresses.
16986
16987
16988
16989.option more routers boolean&!! true
16990The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16991that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16992result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16993fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16994delivery to be deferred.
16995
16996If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16997further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16998.oindex "&%self%&"
16999However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17000means of the setting
17001.code
17002self = pass
17003.endd
17004or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17005does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17006case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17007
17008Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17009expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17010controls what happens next.
17011
17012
17013.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17014.cindex "timeout" "of router"
17015.cindex "router" "timeout"
17016If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17017address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17018router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17019intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17020host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17021
17022There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17023lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17024applies to all of them.
17025
17026
17027
17028.option pass_router routers string unset
17029.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17030Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17031&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17032routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17033these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17034router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17035of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17036be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17037to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17038&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17039
17040
17041
17042.option redirect_router routers string unset
17043.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17044Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17045generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17046example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17047point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17048
17049The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17050It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17051instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17052which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17053
17054
17055
17056.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17057.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17058.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17059This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17060router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17061Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17062through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17063
17064Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17065be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17066If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17067failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17068
17069If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17070below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17071&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17072existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17073preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17074
17075.cindex "NFS"
17076If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17077the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17078unavailable.
17079
17080This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17081options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17082look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17083full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17084these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17085to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17086that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17087transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17088
17089During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17090facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17091This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17092operates as follows:
17093
17094If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17095characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17096comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17097but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17098used. For example:
17099.code
17100require_files = mail:/some/file
17101require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17102.endd
17103If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17104&%require_files%& condition fails.
17105
17106Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17107checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17108directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17109access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17110
17111&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17112incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17113may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17114may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17115user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17116
17117&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17118&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17119without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17120is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17121check again in that process.
17122
17123The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17124be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17125existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17126circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17127not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17128name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17129as if the file did not exist. For example:
17130.code
17131require_files = +/some/file
17132.endd
17133If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17134handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17135option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17136
17137
17138
17139.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17140.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17141.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17142When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17143in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17144domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17145other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17146Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17147latter kind.
17148
17149This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17150hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17151router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17152set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17153for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17154same name.
17155
17156The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17157appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17158independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17159
17160
17161
17162.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17163.cindex "router" "home directory for"
17164.cindex "home directory" "for router"
17165.vindex "&$home$&"
17166This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17167&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17168transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17169sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17170forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17171cause the router to defer.
17172
17173Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17174&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17175place.
17176(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17177are evaluated.)
17178While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17179&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17180
17181When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17182the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17183delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17184of these values that is set:
17185
17186.ilist
17187The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17188.next
17189The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17190.next
17191The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17192.next
17193The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17194.endlist
17195
17196In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17197router, but not for the transport.
17198
17199
17200
17201.option self routers string freeze
17202.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17203.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17204This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17205list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17206and &(manualroute)& routers.
17207Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17208of remote hosts.
17209Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17210&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17211host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17212The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17213&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17214
17215Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17216example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17217error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17218reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17219freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17220cases:
17221
17222.vlist
17223.vitem &%defer%&
17224Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17225
17226.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17227The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17228be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17229behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17230
17231.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17232The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17233reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17234rewritten.
17235
17236.vitem &%pass%&
17237.oindex "&%more%&"
17238.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17239The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17240&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17241subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17242name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17243distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17244combination
17245.code
17246self = pass
17247no_more
17248.endd
17249ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17250Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17251be passed to the next router.
17252
17253.vitem &%fail%&
17254Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17255
17256.vitem &%send%&
17257.cindex "local host" "sending to"
17258The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17259setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17260makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17261is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17262different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17263.endlist
17264
17265
17266
17267.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17268.cindex "router" "checking senders"
17269If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17270address matches something on the list.
17271See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17272are evaluated.
17273
17274There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17275dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17276setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17277to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17278set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17279verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17280SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17281matters.
17282
17283
17284.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17285.cindex "IP address" "translating"
17286.cindex "packet radio"
17287.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17288There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17289it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17290mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17291routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17292is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17293code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17294SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17295
17296.vindex "&$host_address$&"
17297The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17298by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17299expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17300For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17301If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17302address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17303up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17304produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17305addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17306.code
17307translate_ip_address = \
17308 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17309 {$value}fail}}
17310.endd
17311The file would contain lines like
17312.code
1731310.2.3.128/26 some.host
1731410.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17315.endd
17316You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17317are doing.
17318
17319
17320
17321.option transport routers string&!! unset
17322This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17323and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17324only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17325after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17326and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17327delivery is deferred.
17328
17329The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17330have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17331(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17332
17333
17334
17335.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17336.cindex "current directory for local transport"
17337This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17338to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17339explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17340file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17341option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17342overridden by a setting on the transport.
17343If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17344logged, and delivery is deferred.
17345See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17346environment.
17347
17348
17349
17350
17351.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17352.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17353This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17354local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17355configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17356pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17357string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17358setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17359If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17360logged, and delivery is deferred.
17361
17362If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17363&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17364the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17365the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17366is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17367
17368See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17369environment.
17370
17371
17372
17373
17374.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17375.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17376The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17377that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17378result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17379fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17380delivery to be deferred.
17381
17382When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17383address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17384overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17385&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17386the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17387sometimes true and sometimes false).
17388
17389.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17390Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17391qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17392delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17393In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17394&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17395to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17396&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17397
17398&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17399this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17400only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17401no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17402a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17403duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17404duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17405&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17406so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17407&%redirect%& router may be of help.
17408
17409Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17410&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17411subsequent routers.
17412
17413
17414.option user routers string&!! "see below"
17415.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17416.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17417.cindex "transport" "local"
17418.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17419.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17420When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17421specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17422The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17423error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17424This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17425The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17426the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17427a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17428See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17429&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17430
17431
17432
17433.option verify routers&!? boolean true
17434Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17435&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17436
17437
17438.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17439.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17440.oindex "&%-bv%&"
17441.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17442If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17443.new "delivering in cutthrough mode or"
17444testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17445with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17446restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17447&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17448
17449&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17450SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17451accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17452user or group.
17453
17454
17455.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17456If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17457addresses,
17458delivering in cutthrough mode
17459or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17460See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17461are evaluated.
17462
17463
17464.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17465If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17466or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17467See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17468are evaluated.
17469.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17470.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17471
17472
17473
17474
17475
17476
17477. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17478. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17479
17480.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17481.cindex "&(accept)& router"
17482.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17483The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17484used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17485be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17486specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17487it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17488up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17489.code
17490localusers:
17491 driver = accept
17492 domains = mydomain.example
17493 check_local_user
17494 transport = local_delivery
17495.endd
17496The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17497&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17498When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17499address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17500
17501
17502
17503
17504
17505
17506. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17507. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17508
17509.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17510.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17511.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17512The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17513recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17514unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17515
17516If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17517SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17518MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17519However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17520records.
17521
17522MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17523looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17524When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17525except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17526IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17527generic option, the router declines.
17528
17529Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17530to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17531are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17532
17533.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17534.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17535.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17536If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17537address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17538happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17539
17540
17541.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17542There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17543Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17544SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17545MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17546problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17547
17548For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17549&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17550&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17551an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17552domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17553such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17554proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17555look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17556case routing fails.
17557
17558
17559.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17560.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17561There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17562an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17563domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17564
17565Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17566.ilist
17567The domain does not exist in DNS
17568.next
17569The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17570convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17571for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17572.next
17573Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17574.next
17575MX record points to a non-existent host.
17576.next
17577MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17578&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17579.next
17580MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17581addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17582.next
17583The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17584&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17585.next
17586&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17587not be found in the MX records (see below)
17588.endlist
17589
17590
17591
17592
17593.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17594.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17595The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17596
17597.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17598.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17599If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17600(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17601process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17602differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17603the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17604
17605
17606.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17607.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17608The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17609addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17610enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17611required. For example,
17612.code
17613check_srv = smtp
17614.endd
17615looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17616expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17617to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17618submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17619option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17620normal way.
17621
17622When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17623the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17624host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17625this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17626SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17627according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17628
17629When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17630the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17631records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17632this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17633defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17634and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17635have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17636trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17637
17638See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17639when there is a DNS lookup error.
17640
17641
17642
17643.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17644.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17645.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17646A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17647record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17648For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17649records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17650setting:
17651.code
17652mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17653.endd
17654This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17655has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17656the address record.
17657
17658
17659.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17660If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17661DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17662&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17663
17664
17665
17666
17667.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17668.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17669.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17670When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17671lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17672single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17673called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17674&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17675resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17676&'resolv.conf'&.
17677
17678
17679
17680.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17681.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17682.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17683If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17684qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17685an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17686expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17687occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17688&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17689any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17690header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17691
17692This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17693ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17694sense.
17695
17696When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17697servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17698making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17699some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17700name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17701header rewriting.
17702
17703
17704.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17705.cindex "address" "copying routing"
17706Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17707to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17708options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17709default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17710servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17711any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17712
17713If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17714domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17715local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17716lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17717routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17718message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17719without processing them independently,
17720provided the following conditions are met:
17721
17722.ilist
17723No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17724&%headers_remove%&.
17725.next
17726The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17727the domain.
17728.endlist
17729
17730
17731
17732
17733.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17734.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17735When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17736lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17737applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17738the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17739domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17740up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17741&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17742actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17743
17744Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17745record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17746local wildcard.
17747
17748
17749
17750.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17751If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17752DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17753&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17754
17755
17756
17757
17758.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17759.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17760If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17761added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17762if
17763.code
17764widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17765.endd
17766is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17767&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17768&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17769and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17770the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17771when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17772
17773
17774.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17775When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17776of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17777corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17778is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17779
17780These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17781for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17782such as that implied by
17783.code
17784domains = @mx_any
17785.endd
17786that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17787entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17788.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17789.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17790
17791
17792
17793
17794
17795
17796
17797
17798
17799. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17800. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17801
17802.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17803.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17804.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17805.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17806This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17807verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17808generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17809takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17810router handles the address
17811.code
17812root@[192.168.1.1]
17813.endd
17814by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17815consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17816are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17817.code
17818postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17819.endd
17820Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17821grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17822
17823.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17824If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17825declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17826&%self%& option determines what happens.
17827
17828The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17829controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17830also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17831Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17832
17833
17834
17835. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17836. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17837
17838.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17839.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17840.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17841The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17842Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17843not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17844must set
17845.code
17846ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17847.endd
17848in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17849
17850The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17851connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17852a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17853message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17854this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17855can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17856must not be specified for it.
17857
17858.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17859.option hosts iplookup string unset
17860This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17861names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17862(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17863and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17864happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17865
17866
17867.option optional iplookup boolean false
17868If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17869is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17870delivery to the address is deferred.
17871
17872
17873.option port iplookup integer 0
17874.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17875This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17876call.
17877
17878
17879.option protocol iplookup string udp
17880This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17881protocols is to be used.
17882
17883
17884.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17885This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17886default value is:
17887.code
17888$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17889.endd
17890The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17891query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17892
17893
17894.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17895If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17896returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17897string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17898in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17899&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17900whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17901up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17902
17903
17904.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17905This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17906returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17907router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17908response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17909check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17910address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17911the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17912following could be used:
17913.code
17914response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17915reroute = $local_part@$1
17916.endd
17917
17918.option timeout iplookup time 5s
17919This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17920machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17921call. It does not apply to UDP.
17922
17923
17924
17925
17926. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17927. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17928
17929.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17930.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17931.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17932.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17933The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17934routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17935route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17936normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17937route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17938messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17939
17940The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17941it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17942has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17943include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17944&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17945generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17946being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17947
17948.vindex "&$host$&"
17949In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17950router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17951an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17952transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17953with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17954passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17955host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17956text string.
17957
17958The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17959&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17960or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17961any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17962below, following the list of private options.
17963
17964
17965.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17966
17967.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17968The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17969
17970.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17971See &%host_find_failed%&.
17972
17973.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17974This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17975address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17976of the following values:
17977.code
17978decline
17979defer
17980fail
17981freeze
17982ignore
17983pass
17984.endd
17985The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17986error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17987forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17988&%pass_router%&),
17989.oindex "&%more%&"
17990overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17991router only if &%more%& is true.
17992
17993The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17994cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17995controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17996as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17997
17998The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17999state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18000generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18001
18002
18003.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18004.cindex "randomized host list"
18005.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18006If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18007is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18008overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18009crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18010same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18011(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18012deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18013
18014When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18015into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18016set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18017item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18018.code
18019route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18020.endd
18021The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18022randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18023If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18024randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18025&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18026
18027
18028.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18029If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18030Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18031example:
18032.code
18033route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18034.endd
18035If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18036router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18037deferred.
18038
18039
18040.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18041This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18042unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18043that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18044
18045
18046.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18047.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18048Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18049router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18050router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18051default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18052servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18053any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18054
18055If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18056domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18057local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18058lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18059&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18060addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18061same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18062if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18063
18064
18065
18066
18067.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18068The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18069rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18070entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18071described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18072Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18073.display
18074<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18075.endd
18076The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18077no options:
18078.code
18079route_list = \
18080 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18081 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18082.endd
18083The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18084list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18085usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18086single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18087pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18088&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18089except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18090That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18091lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18092in a &%route_list%&).
18093
18094The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18095matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18096then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18097&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18098
18099
18100
18101.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18102The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18103routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18104hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18105The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18106Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18107expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18108like this:
18109.code
18110dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18111thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18112.endd
18113This data can be accessed by setting
18114.code
18115route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18116.endd
18117Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18118decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18119requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18120possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18121be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18122
18123
18124
18125
18126.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18127A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18128always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18129declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18130and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18131in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18132as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18133
18134If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18135variables are set during its expansion:
18136
18137.ilist
18138.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18139If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18140&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18141.code
18142route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18143.endd
18144.next
18145&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18146.next
18147&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18148
18149.next
18150.vindex "&$value$&"
18151If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18152looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18153.code
18154route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18155.endd
18156.endlist
18157
18158Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18159semicolon is the default route list separator.
18160
18161
18162
18163.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18164Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18165optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18166is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18167specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18168by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18169
18170.ilist
18171Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18172the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18173be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18174.code
18175route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18176route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18177.endd
18178.next
18179When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18180colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18181enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18182number follows. For example:
18183.code
18184route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18185.endd
18186.endlist
18187
18188.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18189When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18190the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18191delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18192option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18193transport.
18194
18195Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18196hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18197interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18198records in the DNS. For example:
18199.code
18200route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18201.endd
18202If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18203example:
18204.code
18205route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18206.endd
18207If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18208randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18209that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18210be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18211Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18212happens is controlled by the
18213.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18214&%self%& option of the router.
18215
18216A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18217hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18218lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18219below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18220preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18221randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18222defined by MX preferences.
18223
18224If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18225not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18226preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18227
18228If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18229depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18230is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18231Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18232
18233If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18234most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18235router.
18236
18237DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18238failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18239&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18240
18241The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18242whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18243
18244
18245
18246.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18247The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18248present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18249&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18250other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18251per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18252routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18253
18254.ilist
18255&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18256setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18257.next
18258&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18259overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18260.next
18261&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18262find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18263also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18264.next
18265&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18266no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18267timeout), delivery is deferred.
18268.endlist
18269
18270For example:
18271.code
18272route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18273 domain2 host4:host5
18274.endd
18275If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18276DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18277result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18278or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18279call.
18280
18281&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18282called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18283instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18284lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18285function called.
18286
18287
18288
18289If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18290&%host_find_failed%& option.
18291
18292.vindex "&$host$&"
18293When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18294The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18295
18296
18297
18298.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18299In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18300transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18301
18302.ilist
18303.cindex "smart host" "example router"
18304The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18305&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18306named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18307.code
18308domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18309.endd
18310You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18311your first router something like this:
18312.code
18313smart_route:
18314 driver = manualroute
18315 domains = !+local_domains
18316 transport = remote_smtp
18317 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18318.endd
18319This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18320&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18321they are tried in order
18322(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18323Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18324.code
18325smart_route:
18326 driver = manualroute
18327 transport = remote_smtp
18328 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18329.endd
18330There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18331However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18332example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18333precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18334always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18335would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18336always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18337&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18338
18339.next
18340.cindex "mail hub example"
18341A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18342records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18343the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18344machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18345&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18346to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18347using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18348lookup is easier to manage.
18349
18350If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18351to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18352example:
18353.code
18354hub_route:
18355 driver = manualroute
18356 transport = remote_smtp
18357 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18358.endd
18359This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18360whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18361if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18362that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18363domain can be used to find the host:
18364.code
18365through_firewall:
18366 driver = manualroute
18367 transport = remote_smtp
18368 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18369.endd
18370The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18371hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18372data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18373next router.
18374
18375.next
18376.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18377.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18378You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18379SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18380storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18381can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18382.code
18383save_in_file:
18384 driver = manualroute
18385 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18386 route_list = saved.domain.example
18387.endd
18388though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18389several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18390different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18391.code
18392save_in_file:
18393 driver = manualroute
18394 route_list = \
18395 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18396 *.saved.domain2.example \
18397 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18398 batch_pipe
18399.endd
18400.vindex "&$domain$&"
18401.vindex "&$host$&"
18402The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18403doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18404file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18405the address if the lookup fails.
18406
18407.next
18408.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18409Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18410&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18411one way it can be done:
18412.code
18413# Transport
18414uucp:
18415 driver = pipe
18416 user = nobody
18417 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18418 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18419 return_fail_output = true
18420
18421# Router
18422uucphost:
18423 transport = uucp
18424 driver = manualroute
18425 route_data = \
18426 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18427.endd
18428The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18429.code
18430darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18431.endd
18432It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18433makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18434&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18435.endlist
18436.ecindex IIDmanrou1
18437.ecindex IIDmanrou2
18438
18439
18440
18441
18442
18443
18444
18445
18446. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18447. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18448
18449.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18450.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18451.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18452.cindex "routing" "by external program"
18453The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18454and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18455mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18456However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18457&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18458be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18459options:
18460.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18461
18462.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18463This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18464command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18465expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18466&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18467
18468
18469.option command_group queryprogram string unset
18470.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18471This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18472address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18473uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18474gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18475
18476
18477.option command_user queryprogram string unset
18478.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18479This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18480command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18481it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18482using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18483not set, a value for the gid also.
18484
18485&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18486root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18487However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18488usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18489is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18490the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18491gid.
18492
18493
18494.option current_directory queryprogram string /
18495This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18496before running the command.
18497
18498
18499.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18500If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18501is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18502timeout.
18503
18504
18505The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18506the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18507containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18508the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18509field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18510
18511.ilist
18512&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18513below).
18514.next
18515&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18516&%no_more%& is set.
18517.next
18518&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18519subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18520of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18521included in the SMTP response.
18522.next
18523&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18524subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18525included in any SMTP response.
18526.next
18527&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18528.next
18529&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18530&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18531.next
18532&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18533new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18534or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18535.endlist
18536
18537When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18538number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18539the page):
18540.code
18541ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18542LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18543.endd
18544The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18545is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18546used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18547an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18548
18549The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18550As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18551in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18552&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18553(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18554
18555If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18556find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18557anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18558goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18559result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18560
18561.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18562If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18563variable. For example, this return line
18564.code
18565accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18566.endd
18567routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18568the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18569.ecindex IIDquerou1
18570.ecindex IIDquerou2
18571
18572
18573
18574
18575. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18576. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18577
18578.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18579.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18580.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18581.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18582.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18583The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18584common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18585(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18586files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18587redirected in several different ways:
18588
18589.ilist
18590It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18591independently.
18592.next
18593It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18594.next
18595It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18596.next
18597It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18598.next
18599It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18600.next
18601It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18602.next
18603It can be discarded.
18604.endlist
18605
18606The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18607However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18608files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18609&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18610
18611
18612
18613.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18614The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18615expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18616contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18617options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18618aliases, in a configuration like this:
18619.code
18620system_aliases:
18621 driver = redirect
18622 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18623.endd
18624If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18625expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18626expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18627cause delivery to be deferred.
18628
18629A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18630&_.forward_& files, like this:
18631.code
18632userforward:
18633 driver = redirect
18634 check_local_user
18635 file = $home/.forward
18636 no_verify
18637.endd
18638If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18639empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18640is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18641yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18642comments.
18643
18644
18645
18646.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18647.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18648It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18649&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18650
18651.ilist
18652When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18653running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18654the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18655practice the router may not be able to operate.
18656.next
18657However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18658is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18659local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18660saves some resources.
18661.endlist
18662
18663
18664
18665
18666
18667
18668.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18669.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18670.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18671The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18672can be interpreted in two different ways:
18673
18674.ilist
18675If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18676&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18677&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18678respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18679in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18680document is intended for use by end users.
18681.next
18682Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18683described in the next section.
18684.endlist
18685
18686When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18687in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18688generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18689configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18690for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18691
18692
18693
18694.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18695.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18696When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18697comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18698addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18699&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18700disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18701depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18702commas or newlines.
18703If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18704quotes.
18705
18706Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18707also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18708next newline character is ignored.
18709
18710If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18711double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18712(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18713&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18714removed.
18715
18716.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18717&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18718and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18719of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18720special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18721&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18722setting:
18723.code
18724data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18725.endd
18726
18727
18728.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18729.cindex "routing" "loops in"
18730.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18731.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18732A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18733consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18734automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18735is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18736Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18737as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18738complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18739
18740.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18741Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18742filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18743mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18744&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18745.code
18746cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18747.endd
18748.cindex "backslash in alias file"
18749.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18750For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18751preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18752it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18753synonymously.
18754
18755If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
187562822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18757domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18758addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18759force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18760
18761Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18762Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18763contains:
18764.code
18765Sam.Reman: spqr
18766.endd
18767Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18768messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18769this forward file:
18770.code
18771Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18772.endd
18773With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18774&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18775second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18776and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18777should really contain
18778.code
18779spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18780.endd
18781but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18782below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18783&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18784
18785
18786
18787.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18788In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18789lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18790
18791.ilist
18792.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18793.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18794An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18795as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18796command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18797Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18798which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18799
18800Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18801the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18802the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18803in double quotes, for example:
18804.code
18805"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18806.endd
18807since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18808quote just the command. An item such as
18809.code
18810|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18811.endd
18812is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18813
18814.new
18815Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
18816of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
18817redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
18818quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
18819string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
18820are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
18821data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
18822transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
18823an &%accept%& router.
18824.wen
18825
18826.next
18827.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18828.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18829An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18830parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18831.code
18832/home/world/minbari
18833.endd
18834is treated as a file name, but
18835.code
18836/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18837.endd
18838is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18839the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18840forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18841file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18842
18843Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18844which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18845
18846.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18847However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18848bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18849instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18850
18851.next
18852.cindex "included address list"
18853.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18854If an item is of the form
18855.code
18856:include:<path name>
18857.endd
18858a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18859point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18860out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18861by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18862item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18863the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18864.code
18865list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18866.endd
18867It must be given as
18868.code
18869list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18870.endd
18871.next
18872.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18873Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18874&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18875the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18876.cindex "black hole"
18877.cindex "abandoning mail"
18878&':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18879done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18880&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18881
18882&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18883delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18884are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18885database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18886&_/dev/null_&.
18887
18888.next
18889.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18890.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18891.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18892.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18893.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18894An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18895redirection items of the form
18896.code
18897:defer:
18898:fail:
18899.endd
18900respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18901to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18902text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18903associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18904.code
18905X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18906.endd
18907In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18908of a
18909.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18910VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18911default.
18912.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18913The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18914the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18915
18916.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18917By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18918&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18919space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18920followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18921code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18922incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18923suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18924&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18925ignored.
18926
18927.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18928In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18929default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18930therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18931
18932Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18933not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18934normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18935as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18936lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18937
18938During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18939containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18940whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18941subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18942deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18943rules still apply.
18944
18945.next
18946.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18947Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18948chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18949for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18950&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18951router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18952results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18953.endlist
18954
18955
18956.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18957.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18958.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18959.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18960Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18961to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18962routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18963aliasing scheme of the type
18964.code
18965pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18966localpart1: pipe
18967localpart2: pipe
18968.endd
18969does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18970when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18971discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18972such as
18973.code
18974localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18975localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18976.endd
18977does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18978the pipes are distinct.
18979
18980
18981
18982.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18983.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18984.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18985When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18986leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18987afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18988delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18989members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18990can be used to avoid this.
18991
18992
18993.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18994.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18995If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18996error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18997for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18998detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18999deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19000
19001
19002
19003.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19004
19005.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19006The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19007
19008
19009.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19010Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19011data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19012
19013
19014.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19015.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19016If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19017and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19018
19019
19020.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19021.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19022.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19023Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19024&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19025are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19026lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19027
19028It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19029the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19030
19031
19032The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19033&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19034&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19035files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19036true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19037
19038
19039
19040.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19041.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19042Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19043This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19044default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19045let ordinary users do.
19046
19047
19048
19049.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19050This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19051as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19052Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19053configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19054for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19055
19056When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19057is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19058the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19059and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19060domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19061&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19062.code
19063\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19064.endd
19065Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19066&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19067originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19068(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19069&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19070&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19071file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19072original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19073
19074
19075.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19076When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19077when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19078&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19079&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19080deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19081is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19082&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19083
19084
19085
19086.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19087When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19088this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19089permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19090option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19091&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19092
19093
19094.option data redirect string&!! unset
19095This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19096set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19097list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19098expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19099has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19100
19101When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19102filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19103terminated with newline characters. For example:
19104.code
19105data = #Exim filter\n\
19106 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19107.endd
19108If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19109you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19110choice into a newline.
19111
19112
19113.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19114A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19115ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19116specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19117configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19118
19119
19120.option file redirect string&!! unset
19121This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19122is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19123use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19124failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19125must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19126data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19127entirely of comments), the router declines.
19128
19129.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19130If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19131runs a check on the containing directory,
19132unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19133If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19134happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19135is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19136not, the router declines.
19137
19138
19139.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19140.vindex "&$address_file$&"
19141A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19142ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19143specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19144configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19145it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19146
19147
19148.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19149When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19150relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19151relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19152relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19153
19154
19155.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19156If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19157redirection list.
19158
19159
19160.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19161If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19162&%allow_filter%& is true.
19163
19164
19165
19166
19167.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19168.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19169.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19170.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19171If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19172specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19173conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19174set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19175locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19176
19177
19178.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19179.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19180If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19181make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19182functions.
19183
19184.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19185.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19186If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19187make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19188
19189.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19190If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19191permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19192under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19193&_.forward_& files).
19194
19195
19196.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19197If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19198to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19199
19200
19201.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19202This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19203it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19204of the embedded Perl support.
19205
19206
19207.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19208If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19209to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19210
19211
19212.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19213If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19214to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19215
19216
19217.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19218If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19219message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19220files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19221&%one_time%& is set.
19222
19223
19224.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19225If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19226to make use of &%run%& items.
19227
19228
19229.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19230If this option is true, items of the form
19231.code
19232:include:<path name>
19233.endd
19234are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19235
19236
19237.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19238.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19239If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19240specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19241forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19242
19243
19244.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19245If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19246&%allow_filter%& is true.
19247
19248
19249.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19250.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19251If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19252of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19253the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19254
19255
19256
19257
19258.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19259.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19260If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19261generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19262generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19263bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19264bounce may well quote the generated address.
19265
19266
19267.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19268.cindex "EACCES"
19269If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19270EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19271file did not exist.
19272
19273
19274.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19275.cindex "ENOTDIR"
19276If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19277ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19278router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19279
19280Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19281router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19282(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19283against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19284is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19285is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19286a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19287that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19288
19289
19290
19291.option include_directory redirect string unset
19292If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19293redirection list must start with this directory.
19294
19295
19296.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19297This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19298&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19299
19300
19301.option one_time redirect boolean false
19302.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19303.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19304.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19305.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19306.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19307Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19308files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19309of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19310is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19311but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19312message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19313lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19314before they subscribed.
19315
19316If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19317deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19318&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19319&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19320attempt.
19321
19322&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19323router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19324reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19325permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19326
19327&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19328to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19329and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19330
19331&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19332&%one_time%&.
19333
19334The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19335addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19336addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19337&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19338typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19339expansion.
19340
19341
19342.option owners redirect "string list" unset
19343.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19344.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19345.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19346.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19347This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19348This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19349See &%check_owner%& above.
19350
19351
19352.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19353This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19354The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19355&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19356
19357
19358.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19359.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19360A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19361starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19362transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19363name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19364When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19365
19366
19367.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19368.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19369If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19370generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19371in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19372expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19373to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19374&$qualify_recipient$&.
19375
19376This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19377but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19378not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19379addresses.
19380
19381.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19382.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19383.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19384.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19385If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19386set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19387without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19388address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19389&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19390this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19391
19392
19393.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19394If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19395any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19396the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19397only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19398&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19399
19400
19401.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19402A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19403&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19404by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19405transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19406are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19407
19408
19409.option rewrite redirect boolean true
19410.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19411If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19412subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19413and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19414
19415
19416.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19417The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19418:subaddress part of an address.
19419
19420.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19421The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19422of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19423(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19424
19425
19426.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19427.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19428To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19429&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19430(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19431&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19432needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19433
19434
19435
19436.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19437.cindex "forward file" "broken"
19438.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19439.cindex "alias file" "broken"
19440.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19441.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19442.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19443.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19444If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19445non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19446&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19447giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19448are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19449&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19450be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19451&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19452
19453If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19454errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19455the following routers.
19456
19457If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19458error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19459taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19460so it is passed to the following routers.
19461
19462.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19463Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19464action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19465&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19466
19467&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19468lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19469option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19470notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19471.code
19472userforward:
19473 driver = redirect
19474 allow_filter
19475 check_local_user
19476 file = $home/.forward
19477 file_transport = address_file
19478 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19479 reply_transport = address_reply
19480 no_verify
19481 skip_syntax_errors
19482 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19483 syntax_errors_text = \
19484 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19485 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19486 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19487 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19488 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19489 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19490 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19491 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19492 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19493 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19494.endd
19495You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19496&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19497put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19498.code
19499real_localuser:
19500 driver = accept
19501 check_local_user
19502 local_part_prefix = real-
19503 transport = local_delivery
19504.endd
19505For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19506router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19507.code
19508 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19509 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19510.endd
19511
19512
19513.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19514See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19515
19516
19517.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19518See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19519.ecindex IIDredrou1
19520.ecindex IIDredrou2
19521
19522
19523
19524
19525
19526
19527. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19528. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19529
19530.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19531 "Environment for local transports"
19532.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19533.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19534.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19535Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19536transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19537in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19538mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19539
19540Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19541some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19542transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19543&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19544
19545The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19546different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19547settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19548or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19549configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19550
19551
19552
19553.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19554.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19555.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19556If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19557simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19558the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19559rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19560time.
19561
19562However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19563locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19564.code
19565my_transport:
19566 driver = pipe
19567 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19568.endd
19569This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19570messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19571&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19572file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19573
19574
19575
19576
19577.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19578.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19579.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19580All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19581overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19582set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19583delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19584group (set by the transport). For example:
19585.code
19586# Routers ...
19587# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19588local_users:
19589 driver = accept
19590 check_local_user
19591 transport = group_delivery
19592
19593# Transports ...
19594# This transport overrides the group
19595group_delivery:
19596 driver = appendfile
19597 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19598 group = mail
19599.endd
19600If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19601address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19602gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19603set.
19604
19605.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19606When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19607function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19608&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19609by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19610for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19611
19612.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19613The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19614is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19615receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19616original gid is also used.
19617
19618This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19619following that is set is used:
19620
19621.ilist
19622A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19623.next
19624A &%group%& setting of the router;
19625.next
19626A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19627&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19628.next
19629The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19630.next
19631In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19632the uid is the creator's uid;
19633.next
19634The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19635.endlist
19636
19637If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19638no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19639This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19640The first of the following that is set is used:
19641
19642.ilist
19643A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19644.next
19645In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19646.next
19647A &%user%& setting of the router;
19648.next
19649A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19650.next
19651The Exim uid.
19652.endlist
19653
19654Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19655&%never_users%& list.
19656
19657
19658
19659
19660
19661.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19662.cindex "current directory for local transport"
19663.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19664.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19665.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19666Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19667the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19668However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19669are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19670for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19671
19672.ilist
19673The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19674.next
19675The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19676.next
19677The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19678.next
19679The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19680.endlist
19681
19682The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19683
19684.ilist
19685The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19686.next
19687The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19688.endlist
19689
19690
19691If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19692value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19693directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19694
19695
19696
19697.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19698.vindex "&$domain$&"
19699.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19700.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19701Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19702variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19703deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19704at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19705other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19706never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19707and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19708.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19709.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19710.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19711
19712
19713
19714
19715
19716
19717
19718. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19719. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19720
19721.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19722.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19723.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19724.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19725The following generic options apply to all transports:
19726
19727
19728.option body_only transports boolean false
19729.cindex "transport" "body only"
19730.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19731.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19732If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19733mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19734or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19735&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19736automatically suppress them.
19737
19738
19739.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19740.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19741This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19742transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19743If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19744logged, and delivery is deferred.
19745
19746
19747.option disable_logging transports boolean false
19748If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19749deliveries by the transport or for any
19750transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19751what you are doing.
19752
19753
19754.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19755.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19756If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19757option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19758transport is run.
19759If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19760output, and Exim carries on processing.
19761This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19762so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19763option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19764variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19765one.
19766.new
19767The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
19768transport and the router that called it.
19769.wen
19770
19771.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19772.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19773If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19774This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19775header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19776requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19777safely be resent to other recipients.
19778
19779
19780.option driver transports string unset
19781This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19782There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19783
19784
19785.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19786.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19787If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19788This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19789delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19790configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19791address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19792header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19793its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19794resent to other recipients.
19795
19796
19797.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19798.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19799This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19800value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19801&%user%& (see below).
19802
19803
19804.option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19805.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19806.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19807This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19808portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19809&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19810routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19811is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19812errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19813
19814.new
19815Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19816for a transport; all listed headers are added.
19817.wen
19818
19819
19820.option headers_only transports boolean false
19821.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19822.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19823.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19824If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19825exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19826transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19827checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19828
19829
19830.option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19831.cindex "header lines" "removing"
19832.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19833This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19834these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19835in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19836routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19837is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19838errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19839
19840Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19841for a router; all listed headers are added.
19842
19843
19844
19845.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19846.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19847.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19848This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19849that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19850option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19851the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19852message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19853example,
19854.code
19855headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19856 x@y w@z
19857.endd
19858changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19859&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19860header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19861only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19862the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19863filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19864affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19865envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19866change envelope recipients at this time.
19867
19868
19869.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19870.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19871.vindex "&$home$&"
19872This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19873overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19874placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19875used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19876&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19877&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19878for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19879deferred.
19880
19881
19882.option initgroups transports boolean false
19883.cindex "additional groups"
19884.cindex "groups" "additional"
19885.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19886If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19887transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19888to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19889
19890
19891.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19892.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19893.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19894.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19895This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19896expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19897digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19898including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19899delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19900message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19901the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19902ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19903&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19904delivered.
19905
19906
19907
19908.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19909.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19910.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19911.cindex "local part" "prefix"
19912.cindex "local part" "suffix"
19913When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19914affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19915form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19916that contains
19917.code
19918local_part_prefix = *-
19919.endd
19920routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19921is delivered with
19922.code
19923RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19924.endd
19925This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19926recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19927whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19928deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19929&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19930
19931
19932.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19933.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19934When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19935in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19936is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19937deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19938part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19939temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19940deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19941
19942However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19943as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19944(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19945this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19946
19947For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19948the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19949on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19950
19951
19952.option return_path transports string&!! unset
19953.cindex "envelope sender"
19954.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19955.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19956If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19957the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19958that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19959designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19960SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19961only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19962header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19963
19964&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19965&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19966
19967.vindex "&$return_path$&"
19968The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19969either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19970&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19971replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19972option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19973section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19974
19975&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19976remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19977the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19978This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19979&%errors_to%& in a router.
19980
19981
19982
19983.option return_path_add transports boolean false
19984.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19985If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19986Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19987mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19988have easy access to it.
19989
19990RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19991the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19992header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19993option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19994incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19995recipients.
19996
19997
19998.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19999See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20000
20001
20002.option shadow_transport transports string unset
20003.cindex "shadow transport"
20004.cindex "transport" "shadow"
20005A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20006another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20007
20008Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20009&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20010string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20011passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20012expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20013cause a log line to be written.
20014
20015The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20016subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20017provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20018is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20019ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20020of the form
20021.code
20022ST=<shadow transport name>
20023.endd
20024If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20025parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20026purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20027provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20028headers that some sites insist on.
20029
20030
20031.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20032.cindex "transport" "filter"
20033.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20034This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20035at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20036individual users or via a system filter.
20037
20038When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20039&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20040the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20041input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20042command must be specified as an absolute path.
20043
20044The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20045terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20046SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20047lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20048settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20049&(pipe)& transports.
20050
20051The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20052standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20053destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20054filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20055are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20056
20057The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20058care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20059test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20060SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20061
20062.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20063A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20064at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20065message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20066a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20067not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20068
20069.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20070A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20071being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20072support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20073at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20074more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20075the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20076additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20077
20078.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20079The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20080the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20081parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20082Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20083section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20084to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20085of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20086an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20087&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20088
20089.vindex "&$host$&"
20090.vindex "&$host_address$&"
20091The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20092transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20093which the message is being sent. For example:
20094.code
20095transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20096 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20097.endd
20098
20099Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20100generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20101command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20102.ilist
20103If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20104part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20105expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20106example:
20107.code
20108transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20109.endd
20110This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20111&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20112stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20113the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20114&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20115Exim tried to expand the first one.
20116.next
20117Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20118expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20119arguments. Consider this example:
20120.code
20121transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20122 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20123.endd
20124The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20125if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20126.code
20127transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20128 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20129.endd
20130.endlist
20131
20132The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20133For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20134normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20135A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20136serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20137the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20138bounced from a transport filter.
20139
20140If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20141passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20142message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20143
20144
20145.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20146.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20147When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20148that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20149temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20150&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20151way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20152error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20153becomes a temporary error.
20154
20155
20156.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20157.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20158.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20159This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20160run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20161given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20162associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20163option is not set.
20164
20165For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20166specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20167&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20168
20169.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20170For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20171sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20172to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20173retry data.
20174.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20175.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20176.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20177
20178
20179
20180
20181
20182
20183. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20184. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20185
20186.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20187 "Address batching"
20188.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20189The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20190one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20191remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20192normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20193transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20194copy of the message is delivered each time.
20195
20196.cindex "batched local delivery"
20197.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20198.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20199In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20200local transport, for example:
20201
20202.ilist
20203In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20204delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20205recipients saves space.
20206.next
20207In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20208a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20209.next
20210In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20211to a scanner program or
20212to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20213acceptable.
20214.endlist
20215
20216These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20217(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20218repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20219
20220The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20221delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20222(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20223&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20224(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20225to certain conditions:
20226
20227.ilist
20228.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20229If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20230batching is possible.
20231.next
20232.vindex "&$domain$&"
20233If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20234addresses with the same domain are batched.
20235.next
20236.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20237If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20238addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20239customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20240including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20241from taking place.
20242.next
20243Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20244delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20245group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20246be the same.
20247.endlist
20248
20249In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20250both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20251is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20252course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20253option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20254&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20255&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20256.code
20257check_string = "."
20258escape_string = ".."
20259.endd
20260when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20261given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20262&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20263
20264.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20265If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20266&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20267that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20268transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20269addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20270
20271.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20272.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20273If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20274transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20275the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20276of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20277argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20278delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20279are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20280
20281
20282
20283
20284. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20285. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20286
20287.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20288.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20289.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20290.cindex "directory creation"
20291.cindex "creating directories"
20292The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20293file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20294files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20295format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20296University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20297being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20298to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20299delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20300supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20301directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20302
20303The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20304default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20305SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20306included.
20307
20308.cindex "quota" "system"
20309Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20310also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20311system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20312
20313If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20314partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20315modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20316creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20317
20318Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20319file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20320private options.
20321
20322The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20323users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20324putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20325&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20326option).
20327
20328
20329
20330.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20331The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20332the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20333the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20334normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20335
20336.vindex "&$address_file$&"
20337.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20338However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20339directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20340forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20341user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20342the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20343name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20344operation. There are two cases:
20345
20346.ilist
20347If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20348must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20349common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20350different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20351default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20352name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20353&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20354.next
20355If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20356used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20357contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20358.endlist
20359
20360
20361.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20362.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20363As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20364have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20365form:
20366.code
20367save folder23
20368.endd
20369or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20370.code
20371require "fileinto";
20372fileinto "folder23";
20373.endd
20374In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20375must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20376case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20377is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20378way of handling this requirement:
20379.code
20380file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20381 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20382 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20383 {$address_file} \
20384 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20385 }} \
20386 }
20387.endd
20388With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20389location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20390&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20391
20392&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20393&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20394the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20395you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20396&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20397path to the transport.
20398
20399&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20400the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20401
20402
20403
20404
20405.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20406.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20407
20408
20409
20410.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20411.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20412.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20413.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20414Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20415regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20416delivery is deferred.
20417
20418
20419.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20420.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20421.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20422By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20423that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20424are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20425what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20426are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20427
20428
20429.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20430See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20431However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20432happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20433file.
20434
20435
20436.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20437See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20438
20439
20440.option check_group appendfile boolean false
20441When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20442option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20443delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20444file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20445
20446
20447.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20448When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20449is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20450process is running.
20451
20452
20453.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20454.cindex "&""From""& line"
20455As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20456matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20457replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20458a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20459contains is significant.
20460
20461If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20462are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20463configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20464&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20465&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20466
20467The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20468suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20469&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20470if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20471.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20472.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20473.code
20474check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20475escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20476message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20477message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20478.endd
20479.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20480.cindex "directory creation"
20481When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20482directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20483is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20484
20485The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20486operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20487example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20488is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20489in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20490
20491
20492
20493.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20494This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20495by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20496directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20497delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20498beneath.
20499
20500The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20501&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20502set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20503given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20504names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20505by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20506&%file_must_exist%&.
20507
20508
20509.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20510This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20511or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20512redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20513
20514When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20515into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20516appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20517(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20518&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20519
20520
20521.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20522.cindex "base62"
20523.vindex "&$inode$&"
20524When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20525&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20526whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20527.code
20528q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20529.endd
20530This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20531inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20532option.
20533
20534
20535.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20536If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20537&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20538
20539
20540.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20541See &%check_string%& above.
20542
20543
20544.option file appendfile string&!! unset
20545This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20546&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20547of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20548specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20549&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20550&%file%&.
20551
20552.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20553.cindex "locking files"
20554.cindex "lock files"
20555If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20556mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20557
20558The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20559path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20560examples:
20561.code
20562file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20563file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20564file = $home/inbox
20565.endd
20566.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20567In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20568is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20569create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20570deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20571run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20572
20573
20574
20575.option file_format appendfile string unset
20576.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20577This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20578before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20579start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20580colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20581second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20582string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20583transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20584this added to it:
20585.code
20586file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20587 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20588.endd
20589Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20590a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20591to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20592to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20593is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20594match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20595delivery is deferred.
20596
20597
20598.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20599If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20600A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20601If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20602
20603
20604.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20605.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20606.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20607.cindex "locking files"
20608By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20609when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20610sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20611Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20612for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20613deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20614mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20615misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20616
20617On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20618not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20619is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20620and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20621
20622If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20623timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20624retries is
20625.code
20626(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20627.endd
20628rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20629which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20630&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20631
20632You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20633local deliveries because of errors of the form
20634.code
20635failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20636.endd
20637
20638.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20639This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20640&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20641&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20642
20643
20644.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20645This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20646for details of locking.
20647
20648
20649.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20650This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20651is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20652
20653
20654.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20655This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20656used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20657
20658
20659.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20660.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20661When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20662exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20663accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20664
20665
20666.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20667.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20668.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20669If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20670number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20671followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20672external source that maintains the data.
20673
20674
20675.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20676.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20677.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20678If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20679size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20680This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20681maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20682it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20683
20684
20685
20686.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20687.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20688If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20689file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20690transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20691&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20692&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20693directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20694SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20695&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20696
20697
20698.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20699.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20700.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20701This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20702a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20703directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20704calculation. The default value is:
20705.code
20706maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20707.endd
20708This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20709(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20710&_Trash_&
20711folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20712.code
20713maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20714.endd
20715This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20716directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20717calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20718directly into that directory.
20719
20720
20721.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20722This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20723&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20724
20725
20726.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20727This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20728section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20729
20730
20731.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20732.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20733The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20734If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20735creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20736quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20737value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20738&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20739
20740.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20741.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20742.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20743The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20744effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20745matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20746containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20747delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20748&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20749See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20750
20751
20752.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20753.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20754If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20755new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20756SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20757below for further details.
20758
20759
20760.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20761This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20762section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20763
20764
20765.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20766This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20767section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20768
20769
20770.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20771.cindex "locking files"
20772.cindex "file" "locking"
20773.cindex "file" "MBX format"
20774.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20775This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20776set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20777the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20778traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20779IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20780
20781&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20782automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20783empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20784combination:
20785.code
20786mbx_format = true
20787message_prefix =
20788message_suffix =
20789.endd
20790If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20791&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20792is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20793&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20794interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20795should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20796going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20797mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20798
20799If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20800the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20801(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20802append messages to it.
20803
20804
20805.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20806.cindex "&""From""& line"
20807The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20808The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20809in which case it is:
20810.code
20811message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20812 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20813.endd
20814&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20815&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20816
20817.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20818The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20819The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20820in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20821setting
20822.code
20823message_suffix =
20824.endd
20825&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20826&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20827
20828.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20829If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20830has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20831permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20832if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20833a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20834value, and this option is ignored.
20835
20836
20837.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20838This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20839mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20840true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20841continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20842
20843
20844.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20845If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20846successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20847on users about incoming mail.
20848
20849
20850.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20851.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20852This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20853or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20854is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20855all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20856individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20857&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20858have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20859
20860As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20861multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20862For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20863
20864A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20865may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20866If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20867become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20868Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20869the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20870
20871The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20872(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20873for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20874large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20875be handled.
20876
20877&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20878
20879The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20880the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20881be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20882fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20883system quota failures.
20884
20885By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20886mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20887last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20888during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20889refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20890message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20891changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20892for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20893continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20894delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20895
20896
20897.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20898This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20899into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20900called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20901delivery directory.
20902
20903
20904.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20905This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20906number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20907can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20908failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20909&"no quota"&.
20910
20911
20912.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20913See &%quota%& above.
20914
20915
20916.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20917This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20918for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20919these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20920If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20921captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20922file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20923
20924This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20925&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20926facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20927the file length to the file name. For example:
20928.code
20929maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20930quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20931.endd
20932An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20933number of lines in the message.
20934
20935The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20936file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20937sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20938
20939Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20940
20941
20942.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20943See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20944&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20945.code
20946quota_warn_message = "\
20947 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20948 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20949 This message is automatically created \
20950 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20951 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20952 a warning threshold that is\n\
20953 set by the system administrator.\n"
20954.endd
20955
20956
20957.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20958.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20959.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20960.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20961This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20962resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20963size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20964threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20965may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20966sign. For example:
20967.code
20968quota = 10M
20969quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20970.endd
20971If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20972percent sign is ignored.
20973
20974The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20975and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20976warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20977the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20978can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20979&'From:'& line, the default is:
20980.code
20981From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20982.endd
20983.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20984If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20985option.
20986
20987The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20988are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20989percentage.
20990
20991
20992.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20993.cindex "envelope sender"
20994If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20995format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20996you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20997so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20998for details of batch SMTP.
20999
21000
21001.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21002.cindex "carriage return"
21003.cindex "linefeed"
21004This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21005(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21006of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21007of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21008
21009&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21010(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21011in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21012carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21013have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21014changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21015
21016
21017.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21018This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21019exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21020&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21021that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21022&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21023
21024
21025.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21026This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21027the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21028&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21029each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21030
21031This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21032&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21033where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21034both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21035
21036.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21037Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21038have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21039&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21040the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21041error.
21042
21043&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21044is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21045
21046
21047.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21048If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21049appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21050&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21051sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21052&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21053delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21054
21055.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21056In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21057necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21058achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21059file corruption.
21060
21061The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21062It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21063except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21064
21065
21066.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21067This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21068set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21069locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21070of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21071are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21072the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21073rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21074does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21075
21076You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21077&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21078MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21079without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21080
21081
21082
21083
21084.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21085.cindex "appending to a file"
21086.cindex "file" "appending"
21087Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21088
21089.ilist
21090If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21091return is given.
21092
21093.next
21094.cindex "directory creation"
21095If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21096&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21097&%directory_mode%& option.
21098
21099.next
21100If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21101indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21102transport.
21103
21104.next
21105.cindex "file" "locking"
21106.cindex "locking files"
21107.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21108If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21109reliably over NFS, as follows:
21110
21111.olist
21112Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21113current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21114as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21115.next
21116Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21117.next
21118If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21119Unlink the hitching post name.
21120.next
21121Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21122then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21123of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21124restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21125.next
21126If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21127up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21128mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21129lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21130existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21131it before trying again.
21132.endlist olist
21133
21134.next
21135A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21136so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21137than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21138
21139.next
21140.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21141.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21142If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21143&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21144checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21145is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21146ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21147directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21148idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21149checked.
21150
21151.next
21152If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21153and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21154different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21155delivery is deferred.
21156
21157.next
21158If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21159If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21160is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21161permissions.
21162
21163.next
21164The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21165If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21166hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21167
21168.next
21169If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21170changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21171have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21172
21173.next
21174If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21175option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21176directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21177open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21178except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21179set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21180the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21181that prevents link following.
21182
21183.next
21184.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21185If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21186existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21187being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21188after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21189
21190.next
21191If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21192
21193.next
21194.cindex "file" "locking"
21195.cindex "locking files"
21196Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21197are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21198&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21199However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21200file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21201.code
21202/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21203.endd
21204using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21205the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21206the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21207
21208If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21209depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21210&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21211
21212If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21213&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21214to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21215delivery is deferred.
21216
21217If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21218&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21219waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21220immediately. It retries up to
21221.code
21222(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21223.endd
21224times (rounded up).
21225.endlist
21226
21227At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21228and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21229
21230
21231.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21232.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21233.cindex "&""From""& line"
21234When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21235delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21236activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21237&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21238router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21239configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21240ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21241
21242No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21243locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21244separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21245of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21246newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21247&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21248any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21249
21250If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21251the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21252different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21253deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21254
21255
21256.cindex "maildir format"
21257.cindex "mailstore format"
21258There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21259done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21260&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21261formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21262SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21263
21264.cindex "directory creation"
21265In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21266sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21267option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21268constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21269the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21270&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21271deferred.
21272
21273
21274
21275.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21276.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21277If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21278it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21279directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21280directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21281&_new_& subdirectory.
21282
21283In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21284<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21285Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21286before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21287file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21288opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21289Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21290
21291Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21292called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21293do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21294path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21295&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21296contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21297&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21298&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21299
21300These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21301and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21302folders. Consider this example:
21303.code
21304maildir_format = true
21305directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21306 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21307 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21308maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21309.endd
21310If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21311delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21312the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21313not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21314&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21315&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21316
21317However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21318delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21319does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21320&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21321directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21322
21323&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21324not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21325&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21326
21327.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21328.cindex "maildir++"
21329If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21330&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21331the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21332Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21333down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21334the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21335amount of space used.
21336
21337One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21338computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21339checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21340needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21341use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21342of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21343
21344
21345
21346
21347.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21348If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21349When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21350tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21351name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21352the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21353
21354
21355.vindex "&$message_size$&"
21356Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21357&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21358happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21359variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21360forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21361be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21362Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21363empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21364colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21365maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21366backwards compatibility).
21367
21368For one common implementation, you might set:
21369.code
21370maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21371.endd
21372but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21373
21374It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21375as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21376&[stat()]& each message file.
21377
21378
21379.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21380.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21381.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21382If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21383storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21384within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21385creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21386the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21387to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21388
21389The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21390messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21391in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21392value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21393is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21394need to know the quota.
21395
21396If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21397file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21398
21399A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21400maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21401See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21402details.
21403
21404
21405.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21406.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21407If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21408files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21409message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21410this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21411contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21412itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21413
21414During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21415&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21416&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21417mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21418file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21419the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21420
21421The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21422option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21423the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21424There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21425greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21426appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21427
21428If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21429failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21430configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21431&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21432
21433
21434.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21435If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21436file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21437messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21438section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21439.code
21440directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21441.endd
21442might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21443then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21444expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21445.ecindex IIDapptra1
21446.ecindex IIDapptra2
21447
21448
21449
21450
21451
21452
21453. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21454. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21455
21456.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21457.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21458.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21459The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21460the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21461automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21462&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21463to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21464
21465If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21466&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21467delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21468that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21469another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21470
21471
21472The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21473&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21474directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21475message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21476empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21477
21478The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21479by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21480passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21481transport is run as a consequence of a
21482&%mail%&
21483or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21484supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21485that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21486case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21487is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21488&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21489
21490&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21491command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21492gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21493&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21494
21495There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21496that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21497&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21498address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21499separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21500the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21501message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21502
21503Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21504message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21505immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21506the transport defers.
21507Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21508controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21509
21510If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21511&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21512of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21513&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21514
21515.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21516If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21517the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21518as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21519is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21520problems. They are just discarded.
21521
21522
21523
21524.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21525.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21526
21527.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21528This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21529message when the message is specified by the transport.
21530
21531
21532.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21533This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21534when the message is specified by the transport.
21535
21536
21537.option file autoreply string&!! unset
21538The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21539is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21540string comes first.
21541
21542
21543.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21544If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21545subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21546
21547
21548.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21549If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21550option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21551
21552
21553.option from autoreply string&!! unset
21554This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21555specified by the transport.
21556
21557
21558.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21559This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21560when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21561&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21562
21563
21564.option log autoreply string&!! unset
21565This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21566the message is specified by the transport.
21567
21568
21569.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21570If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21571used.
21572
21573
21574.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21575If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21576item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21577discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21578generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21579
21580
21581
21582.option once autoreply string&!! unset
21583This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21584recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21585This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21586
21587If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21588By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21589is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21590However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21591message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21592this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21593prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21594infinity.
21595
21596If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21597and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21598greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21599Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21600regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21601
21602In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21603which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21604be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21605means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21606unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21607file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21608
21609
21610.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21611See &%once%& above.
21612
21613
21614.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21615See &%once%& above.
21616After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21617
21618
21619.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21620This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21621specified by the transport.
21622
21623
21624.option return_message autoreply boolean false
21625If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21626message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21627configuration option.
21628
21629
21630.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21631This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21632specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21633automatic responses. For example:
21634.code
21635subject = Re: $h_subject:
21636.endd
21637There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21638subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21639bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21640non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21641small.
21642
21643
21644
21645.option text autoreply string&!! unset
21646This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21647message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21648the text comes first.
21649
21650
21651.option to autoreply string&!! unset
21652This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21653when the message is specified by the transport.
21654.ecindex IIDauttra1
21655.ecindex IIDauttra2
21656
21657
21658
21659
21660. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21661. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21662
21663.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21664.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21665.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21666.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21667.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21668The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21669specified command
21670or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21671This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21672transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21673implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21674to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21675has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21676.code
21677TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
21678.endd
21679.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21680is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21681included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21682as follows:
21683
21684.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21685See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21686
21687
21688.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21689This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21690Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21691good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21692batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21693
21694
21695.option command lmtp string&!! unset
21696This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21697is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21698arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21699number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21700is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21701LMTP protocol.
21702
21703.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21704.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21705If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21706commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21707in its response to the LHLO command.
21708
21709.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21710This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21711be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21712delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21713
21714
21715.option timeout lmtp time 5m
21716The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21717respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21718is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21719LMTP transport:
21720.code
21721lmtp:
21722 driver = lmtp
21723 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21724 batch_max = 20
21725 user = exim
21726.endd
21727This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21728necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21729
21730
21731
21732. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21733. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21734
21735.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21736.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21737.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21738The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21739running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21740pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21741(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21742their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21743following ways:
21744
21745.ilist
21746.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21747A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21748transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21749contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21750is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21751.next
21752.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21753If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21754transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21755more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21756(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21757(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21758that are routed to the transport.
21759.next
21760.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21761A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21762alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21763pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
21764&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
21765(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
21766this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
21767.endlist
21768
21769
21770The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21771deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21772implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21773
21774In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21775&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21776other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21777transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21778directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21779details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21780for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21781
21782
21783.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21784If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21785delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21786any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21787write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21788
21789
21790
21791
21792.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21793.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21794If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21795have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21796the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21797in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21798later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21799logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21800&"local delivery failed"&.
21801
21802If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21803the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21804will be sent as normal.
21805
21806If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21807script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21808value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21809apply in this case.
21810
21811If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21812return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21813asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21814a non-existent command may be the problem.
21815
21816The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21817set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21818error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21819return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21820included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21821similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21822failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21823&%temp_errors%&.
21824
21825
21826
21827.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21828.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21829The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21830by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21831&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21832run.
21833
21834.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21835Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21836double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21837way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21838
21839String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21840traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21841expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21842For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21843quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21844.code
21845command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21846.endd
21847will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21848arguments. You have to write
21849.code
21850command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21851.endd
21852to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21853argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21854result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21855interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21856generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21857expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21858example:
21859.code
21860command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21861.endd
21862
21863.cindex "transport" "filter"
21864.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21865.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21866Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21867&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21868place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21869transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21870inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21871avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21872&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21873
21874.new
21875If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
21876for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
21877is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
21878argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
21879&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
21880the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
21881should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
21882run while preserving the argument vector separation.
21883.wen
21884
21885After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21886in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21887message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21888standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21889read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21890may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21891control what is done with it.
21892
21893Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21894in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21895taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21896explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21897where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21898under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21899an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21900works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21901as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21902&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21903with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21904
21905
21906
21907.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21908.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21909.cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21910The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21911This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21912the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21913environment.
21914.display
21915&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21916&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21917&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21918&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21919&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21920&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21921&`LOGNAME `& see below
21922&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21923&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21924&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21925&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21926&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21927&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21928&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21929&`USER `& see below
21930.endd
21931When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21932router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21933called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21934the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21935removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21936LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21937same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21938
21939.cindex "HOST"
21940HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21941associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21942pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21943the router.
21944
21945.cindex "HOME"
21946If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21947for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21948by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21949user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21950
21951
21952.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21953.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21954
21955
21956
21957.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21958.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21959The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21960permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21961permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21962paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21963&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21964in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21965the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21966&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21967otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21968example, if
21969.code
21970allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21971.endd
21972and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21973&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21974&%use_shell%& is set.
21975
21976
21977.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21978See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21979
21980
21981.option batch_max pipe integer 1
21982This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21983See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21984
21985
21986.option check_string pipe string unset
21987As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21988&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21989by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21990&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21991any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21992of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21993the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21994ignored.
21995
21996
21997.option command pipe string&!! unset
21998This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21999obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22000set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22001the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22002Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22003&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22004
22005
22006.option environment pipe string&!! unset
22007.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22008.cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22009This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22010command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22011a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22012environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22013
22014
22015.option escape_string pipe string unset
22016See &%check_string%& above.
22017
22018
22019.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22020.cindex "exec failure"
22021.cindex "failure of exec"
22022.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22023Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22024any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22025is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22026frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22027
22028
22029.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22030.cindex "signal exit"
22031.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22032Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22033a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22034frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22035
22036
22037.new
22038.option force_command pipe boolean false
22039.cindex "force command"
22040.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22041Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22042the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22043is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22044useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22045command. For example:
22046.code
22047command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22048force_command
22049.endd
22050
22051Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22052&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22053separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22054.wen
22055
22056.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22057If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22058run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22059Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22060from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22061&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22062
22063&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22064See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22065
22066.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22067.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22068If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22069one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22070and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22071
22072
22073.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22074If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22075return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22076&%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22077written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22078Only one of them may be set.
22079
22080
22081
22082.option log_output pipe boolean false
22083If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22084output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22085&%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22086
22087
22088
22089.option max_output pipe integer 20K
22090This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22091standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22092process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22093catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22094the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22095&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22096exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22097
22098
22099.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22100The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22101The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22102.code
22103message_prefix = \
22104 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22105 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22106.endd
22107.cindex "Cyrus"
22108.cindex "&%tmail%&"
22109.cindex "&""From""& line"
22110This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22111However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22112or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22113setting
22114.code
22115message_prefix =
22116.endd
22117&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22118&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22119
22120
22121.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22122The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22123The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22124The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22125.code
22126message_suffix =
22127.endd
22128&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22129&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22130
22131
22132.option path pipe string "see below"
22133This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22134variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22135.code
22136/bin:/usr/bin
22137.endd
22138If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22139sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22140apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22141
22142
22143.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22144Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22145a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22146during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22147It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22148for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22149resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22150installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22151of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22152
22153
22154.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22155.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22156If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22157process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22158to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22159&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22160accept the message is used.
22161
22162
22163.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22164When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22165contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22166in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22167command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22168handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22169
22170
22171.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22172If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22173return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22174is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22175However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22176message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22177&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22178
22179
22180
22181.option return_output pipe boolean false
22182If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22183deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22184is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22185However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22186output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22187option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22188of them may be set.
22189
22190
22191
22192.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22193.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22194This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22195asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22196and &%return_output%& is not set,
22197and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22198temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22199numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22200codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22201defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22202compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22203and 73, respectively.
22204
22205
22206.option timeout pipe time 1h
22207If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22208causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22209specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22210command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22211and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22212if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22213
22214.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22215A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22216runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22217treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22218is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22219delivery to be deferred.
22220
22221.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22222This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22223
22224
22225.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22226.cindex "envelope sender"
22227If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22228SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22229commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22230you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22231&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22232
22233.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22234.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22235This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22236BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22237resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22238limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22239class database.
22240
22241
22242.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22243.cindex "carriage return"
22244.cindex "linefeed"
22245This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22246(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22247of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22248of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22249
22250The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22251written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22252are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22253&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22254values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22255
22256
22257.option use_shell pipe boolean false
22258.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22259If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22260instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22261&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22262where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22263modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22264&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22265command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22266its &%-c%& option.
22267
22268
22269
22270.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22271.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22272.cindex "&'procmail'&"
22273.cindex "external local delivery"
22274.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22275.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22276The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22277delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22278this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22279uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22280by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22281necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22282appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22283configuration for &%procmail%&:
22284.code
22285# transport
22286procmail_pipe:
22287 driver = pipe
22288 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22289 return_path_add
22290 delivery_date_add
22291 envelope_to_add
22292 check_string = "From "
22293 escape_string = ">From "
22294 umask = 077
22295 user = $local_part
22296 group = mail
22297
22298# router
22299procmail:
22300 driver = accept
22301 check_local_user
22302 transport = procmail_pipe
22303.endd
22304In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22305&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22306or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22307user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22308&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22309home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22310
22311&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22312.code
22313IFS=" "
22314.endd
22315as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22316use a shell to run pipe commands.
22317
22318.cindex "Cyrus"
22319The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22320deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22321.code
22322# transport
22323local_delivery_cyrus:
22324 driver = pipe
22325 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22326 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22327 user = cyrus
22328 group = mail
22329 return_output
22330 log_output
22331 message_prefix =
22332 message_suffix =
22333
22334# router
22335local_user_cyrus:
22336 driver = accept
22337 check_local_user
22338 local_part_suffix = .*
22339 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22340.endd
22341Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22342&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22343sender.
22344.ecindex IIDpiptra1
22345.ecindex IIDpiptra2
22346
22347
22348. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22349. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22350
22351.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22352.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22353.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22354The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22355or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22356that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22357explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22358&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22359
22360
22361.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22362The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22363two ways:
22364
22365.ilist
22366If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22367routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22368that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22369the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22370does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22371value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22372section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22373.next
22374.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22375When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22376looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22377connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22378for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22379process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22380process.
22381.endlist
22382
22383
22384For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22385incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22386no further messages are sent over that connection.
22387
22388
22389
22390.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22391.vindex "&$host$&"
22392.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22393At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22394&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22395passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22396specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22397&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22398that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22399&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22400
22401
22402.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22403.vindex &$tls_bits$&
22404.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22405.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22406.vindex &$tls_sni$&
22407At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22408&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22409are the values that were set when the message was received.
22410These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22411SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22412variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22413appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22414are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22415&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22416
22417.new
22418These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22419and will be removed in a future release.
22420.wen
22421
22422
22423.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22424.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22425The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22426
22427
22428.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22429.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22430When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22431is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22432runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22433reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22434setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22435problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22436
22437.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22438.cindex "local host" "sending to"
22439.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22440When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22441to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22442deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22443the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22444configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22445configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22446
22447
22448.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22449.cindex "Cyrus"
22450When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22451is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22452overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22453forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22454to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22455ignored.
22456
22457The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22458started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22459&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22460particular connection.
22461
22462If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22463&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22464deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22465unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22466
22467This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22468deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22469&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22470.code
22471authenticated_sender = $local_part
22472.endd
22473This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22474allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22475
22476Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22477domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22478value.
22479
22480
22481.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22482If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22483is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22484authenticated as a client.
22485
22486
22487.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22488This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22489sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22490remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22491
22492
22493.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22494This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22495to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22496several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22497less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22498systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22499option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22500
22501
22502.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22503.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22504.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22505.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22506This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22507over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22508For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22509option.
22510
22511
22512.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22513This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22514the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22515of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22516
22517
22518.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22519This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22520domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22521cutoff times.
22522
22523In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22524them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22525Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22526retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22527a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22528unhappy at this prospect, so...
22529
22530If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22531addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22532IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22533none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22534delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22535addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22536continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22537&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22538to them.
22539
22540
22541.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22542If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22543and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22544the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22545in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22546
22547
22548.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22549If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22550&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22551See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22552details.
22553
22554
22555.new
22556.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22557.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22558This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22559of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22560The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22561Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22562&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22563
22564The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22565(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22566that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22567equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22568Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22569.wen
22570
22571
22572.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22573.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22574String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22575colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22576port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22577&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22578item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22579in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22580
22581Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22582addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22583&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22584not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22585&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22586However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22587
22588If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22589the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22590transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22591address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22592list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22593
22594Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22595re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22596addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22597copy of the message is sent.
22598
22599The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22600&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22601both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22602from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22603fails"& facility.
22604
22605
22606.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22607This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22608line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22609zero.
22610
22611.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22612If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22613being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22614(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22615instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22616it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22617
22618.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22619This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22620server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22621implementations of TLS.
22622
22623.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22624.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22625.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22626.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22627The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22628been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22629command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22630option is:
22631.code
22632$primary_hostname
22633.endd
22634During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22635the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22636&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22637used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22638servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22639that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22640interface address, you could use this:
22641.code
22642helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22643 {$primary_hostname}}
22644.endd
22645The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22646callouts.
22647
22648.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22649Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22650finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22651&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22652email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22653all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22654
22655The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22656processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22657&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22658&%hosts_override%& is set.
22659
22660The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22661list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22662separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22663&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22664item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22665in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22666of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22667
22668If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22669the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22670well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22671address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22672&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22673&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22674that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22675address are used.
22676
22677During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22678unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22679
22680
22681.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22682.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22683.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22684.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22685.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22686This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22687example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22688matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22689start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22690facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22691
22692
22693.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22694.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22695Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22696that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22697
22698
22699.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22700.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22701Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22702matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22703
22704.new
22705.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
22706.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22707Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
22708or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
22709to any host that matches this list.
22710Note that the default is to not use TLS.
22711.wen
22712
22713
22714.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22715.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22716.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22717.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22718.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22719This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22720delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22721&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22722
22723
22724.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22725This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22726tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22727why it exists.
22728
22729
22730
22731.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22732.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22733.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22734.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22735For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22736been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22737message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22738explanation of when this might be needed.
22739
22740
22741.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22742If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22743attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22744&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22745&%fallback_hosts%&.
22746
22747
22748.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22749.cindex "randomized host list"
22750.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22751.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22752If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22753&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22754were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22755router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22756is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22757list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22758
22759When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22760order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22761behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22762&`+`& in the host list. For example:
22763.code
22764hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22765.endd
22766The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22767randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22768If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22769
22770.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22771.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22772This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22773before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22774servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22775authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22776temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22777hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22778&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22779
22780
22781.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22782.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22783Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22784matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22785&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22786incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22787
22788.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22789.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22790This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22791authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22792connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22793unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22794&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22795
22796.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22797.cindex "bind IP address"
22798.cindex "IP address" "binding"
22799.vindex "&$host$&"
22800.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22801This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22802call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22803&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22804message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22805&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22806outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22807interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22808unknown.
22809
22810During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22811&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22812during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22813string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22814string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22815separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22816.code
22817interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22818.endd
22819The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22820connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22821&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22822interface to use if the host has more than one.
22823
22824
22825.option keepalive smtp boolean true
22826.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22827This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22828connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22829periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22830of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22831or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22832that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22833that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22834TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22835unreachable hosts.
22836
22837
22838.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22839.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22840If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22841string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22842has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22843
22844.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22845.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22846This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22847SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22848so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22849permits this.
22850
22851
22852.option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22853.vindex "&$domain$&"
22854When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22855addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22856to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22857handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22858&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22859is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22860
22861
22862.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22863.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22864.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22865This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22866&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22867received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22868The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22869variable that contains an outgoing port.
22870
22871If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22872otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22873normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22874&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22875is deferred.
22876
22877
22878
22879.option protocol smtp string smtp
22880.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22881.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22882.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22883.vindex "&$port$&"
22884If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22885the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22886protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22887deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22888over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22889
22890If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22891changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22892connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22893The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22894
22895
22896.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22897Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22898constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22899means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22900tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22901addresses is not affected.
22902
22903However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22904each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22905the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22906Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22907instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22908hosts.
22909
22910
22911.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22912.cindex "serializing connections"
22913.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22914Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22915host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22916the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22917slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22918Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22919&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22920
22921.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22922Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22923written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22924is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22925records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22926guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22927
22928If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22929relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22930start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22931may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22932are used for ETRN serialization.
22933
22934
22935.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22936.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22937.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22938.cindex "size" "of message"
22939.cindex "transport" "filter"
22940.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22941If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22942MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22943an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22944sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22945configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22946this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22947
22948Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22949the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22950
22951
22952.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22953.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22954.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22955.vindex "&$host$&"
22956.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22957The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22958client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22959connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22960address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22961details of TLS.
22962
22963&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22964certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22965name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22966assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22967client.
22968
22969
22970.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22971.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22972.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22973This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22974be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22975
22976
22977.new
22978.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
22979.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
22980When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
22981key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
22982for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
22983If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
22984will fail.
22985
22986Only supported when using GnuTLS.
22987.wen
22988
22989
22990.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22991.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22992.vindex "&$host$&"
22993.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22994The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22995client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22996connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22997&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22998expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22999result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23000the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23001
23002
23003.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23004.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23005.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23006.vindex "&$host$&"
23007.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23008The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23009when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23010the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23011&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23012expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23013is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23014&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23015ciphers is a preference order.
23016
23017
23018
23019.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23020.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23021.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23022If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23023TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23024the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23025certificate and private key for the session.
23026
23027See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23028
23029Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23030TLS extensions.
23031
23032
23033
23034
23035.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23036.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23037When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23038setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23039to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23040current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23041option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23042response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23043TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23044unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23045in clear.
23046
23047
23048.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
23049.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23050.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23051.vindex "&$host$&"
23052.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23053The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
23054permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23055Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
23056&%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
23057files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
23058single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
23059&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23060expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23061
23062
23063
23064
23065.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23066 "SECTvalhosmax"
23067.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23068.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23069There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23070tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23071&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23072
23073
23074The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23075for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23076option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23077multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23078retrying.
23079
23080Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23081multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23082created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23083
23084Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23085several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23086problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23087&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23088delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23089
23090Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23091arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23092limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23093some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23094&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23095that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23096see below for an exception).
23097
23098Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23099list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23100If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23101but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23102that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23103
23104Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23105higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23106hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23107which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23108tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23109reached their retry times.
23110
23111However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23112large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23113Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23114of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23115time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23116without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23117all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23118there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23119the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23120every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23121reached.
23122
23123The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23124particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23125out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23126reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23127been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23128take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23129
23130The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23131Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23132and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23133possible IP addresses have been tried.
23134.ecindex IIDsmttra1
23135.ecindex IIDsmttra2
23136
23137
23138
23139
23140
23141. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23142. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23143
23144.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23145.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23146There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23147addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23148(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23149abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23150
23151Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23152messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23153&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23154appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23155locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23156unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23157lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23158
23159One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23160when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23161such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23162do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23163
23164
23165.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23166This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23167main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23168&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23169
23170Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23171Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23172facility; you do not have to use it.
23173
23174The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23175configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23176addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23177address to which it applies.
23178
23179Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23180the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23181rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23182those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23183by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23184are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23185rules.
23186
23187Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23188applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23189well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23190headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23191
23192
23193In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23194legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23195in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23196used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23197Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23198discouraged.
23199
23200There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23201illustrated by these examples:
23202
23203.ilist
23204The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23205exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23206gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23207&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23208.next
23209A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23210&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23211.endlist
23212
23213
23214
23215.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23216.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23217.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23218Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23219message's processing.
23220
23221.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23222At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23223by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23224ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23225is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23226rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23227rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23228RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23229rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23230
23231.vindex "&$domain$&"
23232.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23233Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23234may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23235rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23236from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23237for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23238value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23239as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23240SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23241
23242As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23243recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23244the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23245any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23246.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23247before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23248
23249When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23250rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23251redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23252
23253.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23254.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23255.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23256At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23257specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23258This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23259section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23260header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23261applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23262
23263The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23264transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23265transport time.
23266
23267
23268
23269
23270.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23271.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23272.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23273Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23274configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23275&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
232762822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23277transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23278appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23279envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23280.code
23281exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23282.endd
23283might produce the output
23284.code
23285sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23286from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23287to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23288cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23289bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23290reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23291env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23292env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23293.endd
23294which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23295the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23296present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23297set for a particular transport.
23298
23299
23300.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23301.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23302The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23303rules in the form
23304.display
23305<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23306.endd
23307Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23308transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23309takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23310any colons must be doubled, of course).
23311
23312The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23313Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23314case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23315characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23316ignored.
23317
23318For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23319order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23320replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23321
23322The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23323releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23324received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23325lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23326address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23327(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23328that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23329
23330.vindex "&$domain$&"
23331.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23332The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23333string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23334rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23335.code
23336*@* ${lookup ...
23337.endd
23338where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23339refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23340
23341
23342.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23343.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23344.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23345The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23346address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23347single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23348against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23349you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23350facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23351
23352Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23353case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23354can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23355
23356.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23357After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23358depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23359replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23360refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23361numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23362of pattern they are set as follows:
23363
23364.ilist
23365If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23366refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23367the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23368pattern
23369.code
23370*queen@*.fict.example
23371.endd
23372is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23373.code
23374$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23375$1 = hearts-
23376$2 = wonderland
23377.endd
23378Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23379does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23380
23381.next
23382If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23383of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23384for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23385rewriting rule of the form
23386.display
23387&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23388.endd
23389and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23390.code
23391$1 = foo
23392$2 = bar
23393$3 = baz.example
23394.endd
23395If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23396wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23397&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23398partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23399whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23400.endlist
23401
23402
23403.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23404.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23405If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23406match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23407rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23408.code
23409hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23410.endd
23411specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23412&'From:'& headers.
23413
23414.vindex "&$domain$&"
23415.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23416If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23417yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23418&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23419Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23420cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23421matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23422the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23423current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23424expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23425entry written to the panic log.
23426
23427
23428
23429.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23430There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23431
23432.ilist
23433Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23434c, f, h, r, s, t.
23435.next
23436A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23437.next
23438Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23439.endlist
23440
23441For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23442E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23443
23444
23445
23446.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23447 "SECID154"
23448.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23449If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23450&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23451and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23452transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23453rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23454.display
23455&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23456&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23457&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23458&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23459&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23460&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23461&`h`& rewrite all headers
23462&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23463&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23464&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23465.endd
23466"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23467individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23468other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23469
23470You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23471restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23472
23473
23474.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23475.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23476.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23477.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23478The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23479SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23480before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23481required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23482data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23483
23484.vindex "&$domain$&"
23485.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23486This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23487compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23488input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23489the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23490expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23491original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23492
23493
23494.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23495There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23496take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23497correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23498
23499.ilist
23500If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23501unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23502absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23503.next
23504If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23505even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23506expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23507(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23508.next
23509The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23510address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23511rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23512.next
23513.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23514When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23515to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23516left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23517.code
23518From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23519.endd
23520into
23521.code
23522From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23523.endd
23524.cindex "RFC 2047"
23525Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23526done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23527causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23528replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
235292822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23530brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23531(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23532is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23533
23534When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23535rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23536.endlist
23537
23538
23539.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23540Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23541.code
23542*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23543*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23544 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23545.endd
23546Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23547the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23548has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23549consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23550present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23551explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23552at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23553error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23554
23555The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23556domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23557.code
23558root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23559.endd
23560were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23561local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23562
23563Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23564&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23565messages that originate outside the local host:
23566.code
23567*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23568 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23569.endd
23570The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23571space.
23572
23573.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23574.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23575Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23576an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23577the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23578remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23579sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23580components. For example, the rule
23581.code
23582\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23583.endd
23584rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23585&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23586a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23587method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23588to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23589use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23590can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23591.ecindex IIDaddrew
23592
23593
23594
23595
23596
23597. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23598. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23599
23600.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23601.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23602.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23603The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23604retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23605be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23606empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23607errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23608general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23609line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23610address, domain and error.
23611
23612The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23613host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23614Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23615address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23616been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23617tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23618log selector is set, the message
23619.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23620&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23621skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23622the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23623
23624Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23625in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23626actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23627failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23628the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23629added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23630same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23631domain are maintained independently.
23632
23633When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23634receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23635always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23636behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23637quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23638suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23639subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23640the local address is reached.
23641
23642.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23643If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23644whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23645files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23646always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23647
23648The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23649rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23650record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23651timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23652and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23653messages that it should now be retaining.
23654
23655
23656
23657.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23658.cindex "retry" "rules"
23659Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23660separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23661addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23662enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23663in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23664present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23665message's sender, respectively.
23666
23667
23668The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23669&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23670which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23671has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23672list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23673which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23674example,
23675.code
23676lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23677.endd
23678provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23679whereas
23680.code
23681alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23682.endd
23683applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23684In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23685part.
23686
23687.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23688&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
23689must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23690expressions work in address lists.
23691.display
23692&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23693&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23694.endd
23695
23696
23697.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23698When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23699example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23700against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23701router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23702regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23703A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23704&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23705&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23706
23707Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23708failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23709configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23710&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23711local transports).
23712
23713.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23714However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23715suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23716whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23717rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23718failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23719recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23720reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23721&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23722lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23723commands.
23724
23725
23726
23727.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23728 "SECID160"
23729For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23730example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23731twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23732&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23733the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23734suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23735.code
23736a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23737 MX 6 p.q.r.example
23738 MX 7 m.n.o.example
23739.endd
23740and the retry rules are
23741.code
23742p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23743a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23744.endd
23745and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23746first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23747rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23748to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23749tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23750first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23751
23752In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23753first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23754&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23755routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23756
23757&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23758However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23759host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23760.code
23761route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23762.endd
23763then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23764textual form of the IP address.
23765
23766.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23767.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23768The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23769asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23770
23771.vlist
23772.vitem &%auth_failed%&
23773Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23774&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23775
23776.vitem &%data_4xx%&
23777A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23778after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23779
23780.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23781A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23782
23783.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23784A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23785.endlist
23786
23787For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23788as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23789recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23790and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23791retry rule of this form:
23792.code
23793the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23794.endd
23795These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23796LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23797
23798.vlist
23799.vitem &%lost_connection%&
23800A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23801legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23802for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23803
23804.vitem &%refused_MX%&
23805A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23806
23807.vitem &%refused_A%&
23808A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23809
23810.vitem &%refused%&
23811A connection was refused.
23812
23813.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23814A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23815
23816.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23817A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23818
23819.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23820A connection attempt timed out.
23821
23822.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23823There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23824obtained from an MX record.
23825
23826.vitem &%timeout_A%&
23827There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23828obtained from an MX record.
23829
23830.vitem &%timeout%&
23831There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23832
23833.vitem &%tls_required%&
23834The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23835&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23836to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23837
23838.vitem &%quota%&
23839A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23840transport.
23841
23842.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23843.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23844.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23845A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23846transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23847&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23848for four days.
23849.endlist
23850
23851.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23852The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23853timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23854it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23855However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23856heuristic rules:
23857
23858.ilist
23859If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23860used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23861quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23862.next
23863.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23864For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23865subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23866the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23867change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23868MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23869time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23870.next
23871For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23872obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23873.endlist
23874
23875The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23876mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23877when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23878error).
23879
23880
23881
23882.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23883.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23884You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23885specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23886apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23887form:
23888.display
23889&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23890.endd
23891The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23892.code
23893* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23894.endd
23895matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23896host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23897For example:
23898.code
23899a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23900.endd
23901&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23902(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23903only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23904its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23905all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23906
23907When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23908&%-f%& command line option, like this:
23909.code
23910exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23911.endd
23912If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23913list is never matched.
23914
23915
23916
23917
23918
23919.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23920.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23921The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23922sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23923.display
23924<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23925.endd
23926The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23927time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23928arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23929time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23930relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23931
23932.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23933.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23934.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23935.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23936The available algorithms are:
23937
23938.ilist
23939&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23940the interval.
23941.next
23942&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23943specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23944is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23945.next
23946&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23947retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23948maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23949the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23950rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23951members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23952queue processing times.
23953.endlist
23954
23955When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23956order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23957used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23958case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23959current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23960computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23961interval is found. The main configuration variable
23962.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23963.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23964.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23965&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23966cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23967
23968A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23969host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23970basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23971for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23972generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23973time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23974time.
23975
23976.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23977Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23978run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23979starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23980new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23981If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23982occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23983messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23984processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23985your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23986number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23987sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23988
23989The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23990&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23991&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23992&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23993are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23994deliveries that have been deferred.
23995
23996
23997.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23998Here are some example retry rules:
23999.code
24000alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24001wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24002wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24003lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24004* refused_A F,2h,20m;
24005* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24006.endd
24007The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24008&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24009mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24010hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24011parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24012effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24013fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24014days.
24015
24016The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24017happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24018intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24019first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24020so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24021
24022The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24023They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24024all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24025were not obtained from an MX record.
24026
24027The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24028first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24029not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24030hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
240311.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24032
24033
24034
24035.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24036.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24037.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24038.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24039.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24040Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24041consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24042set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24043been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24044arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24045failing for the first time.
24046
24047This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24048backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24049Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24050down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24051
24052If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24053every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24054message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24055
24056
24057
24058
24059.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24060.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24061.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24062Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24063that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24064default retry rule:
24065.code
24066* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24067.endd
24068the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24069long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24070failure for the recipient address that counts.
24071
24072When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24073addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24074causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24075In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24076time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24077
24078For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24079messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24080post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24081
24082If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24083.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24084&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24085default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24086reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24087attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24088those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24089the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24090
24091In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24092for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24093times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24094behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24095to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24096notice.
24097
24098If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24099addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24100addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24101no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24102words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24103addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24104If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24105&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24106deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24107true.
24108
24109.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24110.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24111Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24112intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24113its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24114because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24115host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24116failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24117reached.
24118
24119Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24120applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24121Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24122examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24123commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24124time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24125is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24126time out the address.
24127
24128The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24129the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24130given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24131time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24132not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24133considered immediately.
24134.ecindex IIDretconf1
24135.ecindex IIDregconf2
24136
24137
24138
24139
24140
24141
24142. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24143. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24144
24145.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24146.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24147.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24148The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24149with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24150described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24151to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24152permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24153transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24154other.
24155
24156.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24157Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24158
24159.ilist
24160The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24161the client's EHLO command.
24162.next
24163The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24164may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24165.next
24166The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24167appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24168just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24169any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24170with the AUTH command.
24171.next
24172The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24173.next
24174If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24175option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24176mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24177connection.
24178.next
24179If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24180authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24181unauthenticated connection.
24182.endlist
24183
24184If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24185mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24186SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24187includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24188.display
24189&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24190&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24191&`Connected to server.example.`&
24192&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
24193&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24194&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24195&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24196&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24197&`250-PIPELINING`&
24198&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
24199&`250 HELP`&
24200.endd
24201The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24202authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24203mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24204routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24205controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24206included by setting
24207.code
24208AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
24209AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24210AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
24211AUTH_GSASL=yes
24212AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24213AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
24214AUTH_SPA=yes
24215.endd
24216in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24217authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24218the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24219The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24220work via a socket interface.
24221The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24222provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24223The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24224supporting setting a server keytab.
24225The sixth can be configured to support
24226the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24227not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24228supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24229
24230The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24231section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24232authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24233authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24234is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24235messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24236options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24237
24238To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24239&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24240either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24241functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24242to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24243both sets of options, is required. For example:
24244.code
24245cram:
24246 driver = cram_md5
24247 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24248 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24249 client_name = ph10
24250 client_secret = secret2
24251.endd
24252The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24253&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24254
24255Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24256The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24257authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24258in Exim.
24259
24260&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24261per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24262account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24263authenticating data.
24264
24265Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24266&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24267and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24268Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24269used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24270second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24271user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24272configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24273&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24274as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24275choose to honour.
24276
24277A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24278to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24279mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24280typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24281
24282
24283
24284.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24285.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24286.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24287
24288.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24289When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24290&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24291used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24292encrypted by a setting such as:
24293.code
24294client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24295.endd
24296
24297
24298.new
24299.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24300When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24301result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24302Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24303.wen
24304
24305
24306.option driver authenticators string unset
24307This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24308authenticators is to be used.
24309
24310
24311.option public_name authenticators string unset
24312This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24313implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24314contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24315but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24316defaults to the driver's instance name.
24317
24318
24319.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24320When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24321is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24322mechanism is not advertised.
24323If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24324forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24325See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24326
24327
24328.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24329This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24330is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24331for details.
24332
24333For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24334mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24335
24336For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24337authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24338authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24339authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24340to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24341error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24342string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24343expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24344other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24345the error text.
24346
24347
24348.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24349If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24350command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24351output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24352out the values of variables.
24353If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24354output, and Exim carries on processing.
24355
24356
24357.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24358.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24359When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24360expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24361messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24362lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24363configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24364refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24365If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24366
24367
24368.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24369This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24370as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24371driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24372as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24373remembered for later use.
24374How it is used is described in the following section.
24375
24376
24377
24378
24379
24380.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24381.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24382.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24383When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24384the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24385message:
24386
24387.ilist
24388If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24389than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24390.next
24391If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24392.next
24393.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24394If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24395running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24396from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24397&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24398return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24399given for the MAIL command.
24400.next
24401If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24402is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24403authenticated.
24404.next
24405If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24406the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24407&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24408valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24409fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24410&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24411the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24412message.
24413.endlist
24414
24415
24416When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24417hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24418&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24419process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24420
24421.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24422Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24423MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24424therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24425value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24426ACL is run.
24427
24428
24429
24430.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24431.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24432When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24433authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24434conditions:
24435
24436.ilist
24437The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24438.next
24439It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24440yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24441.endlist
24442
24443The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24444the mechanisms are advertised.
24445
24446Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24447provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24448even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24449set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24450You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24451For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24452that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24453.code
24454auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24455.endd
24456so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24457
24458The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24459authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24460advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24461such as:
24462.code
24463server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24464.endd
24465.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24466If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24467yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24468
24469When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24470immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24471command. This is the case if
24472
24473.ilist
24474The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24475.next
24476No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24477.next
24478Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24479server authenticators.
24480.endlist
24481
24482
24483Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24484to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24485AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24486
24487If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24488server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24489that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24490the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24491fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24492rejected with a 504 error.
24493
24494.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24495.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24496When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24497&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24498or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24499public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24500client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24501no successful authentication.
24502
24503
24504
24505
24506.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24507.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24508.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24509.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24510Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24511configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24512encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24513script:
24514.code
24515use MIME::Base64;
24516printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24517.endd
24518.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24519This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24520interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24521some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24522command line to run this script on such data might be
24523.code
24524encode '\0user\0password'
24525.endd
24526Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24527backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24528whose code value is zero.
24529
24530&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24531digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24532you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24533interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24534
24535&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24536specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24537example, a command such as
24538.code
24539encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24540.endd
24541gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24542
24543If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24544base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24545.code
24546echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24547.endd
24548The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24549in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24550output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24551should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24552
24553
24554
24555.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24556.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24557The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24558&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24559announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24560of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24561
24562.ilist
24563For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24564they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24565mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24566of the authenticator.
24567.next
24568.vindex "&$host$&"
24569.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24570When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24571variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24572that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24573any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24574Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24575delivery to be deferred.
24576.next
24577If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24578Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24579try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24580usual way.
24581.next
24582If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24583carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24584possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24585no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24586what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24587&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24588delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24589turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24590deliver the message unauthenticated.
24591.endlist
24592
24593.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24594When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24595parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24596the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24597is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24598incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24599allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24600to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24601&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24602&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24603the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24604.ecindex IIDauthconf1
24605.ecindex IIDauthconf2
24606
24607
24608
24609
24610
24611
24612. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24613. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24614
24615.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24616.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24617.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24618The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24619LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24620plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24621security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24622(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24623use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24624connections as you do for login accounts.
24625
24626.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24627.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24628When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24629
24630.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24631This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24632configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24633
24634.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24635The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24636prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24637given.
24638
24639.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24640.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24641.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24642.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24643 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24644.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24645.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24646
24647When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24648expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24649response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24650values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24651a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24652are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24653(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24654
24655For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24656the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24657variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24658string expansions that also use them for other things.
24659
24660If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24661supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24662data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24663
24664.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24665Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24666&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24667authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24668to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24669&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24670expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24671generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24672For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24673string as the error text
24674.new ", and the failed id saved in &$authenticated_fail_id$&."
24675
24676&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24677password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24678There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24679
24680
24681
24682.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24683.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24684.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24685.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24686The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24687sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24688separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24689subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24690
24691The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24692Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24693configured as follows:
24694.code
24695fixed_plain:
24696 driver = plaintext
24697 public_name = PLAIN
24698 server_prompts = :
24699 server_condition = \
24700 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24701 server_set_id = $auth2
24702.endd
24703Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24704are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24705password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24706or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24707
24708The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24709the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24710AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24711authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24712.code
24713250-AUTH PLAIN
24714.endd
24715and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24716.code
24717AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24718.endd
24719As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24720data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24721.code
24722AUTH PLAIN
24723.endd
24724to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24725prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24726
24727The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24728when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24729represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24730is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24731second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24732
24733Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24734realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24735authenticating clients it could make sense.
24736
24737A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24738&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24739comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24740this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24741This is an incorrect example:
24742.code
24743server_condition = \
24744 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24745.endd
24746The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24747which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24748incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24749non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24750strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24751the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24752name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24753.code
24754server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24755 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24756.endd
24757In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24758fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24759used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24760always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24761writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24762
24763
24764.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24765.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24766.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24767The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24768in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24769user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24770plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24771.code
24772fixed_login:
24773 driver = plaintext
24774 public_name = LOGIN
24775 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24776 server_condition = \
24777 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24778 server_set_id = $auth1
24779.endd
24780Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24781with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24782if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24783strings are used to obtain two data items.
24784
24785Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24786example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24787&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24788strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24789name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24790.code
24791login:
24792 driver = plaintext
24793 public_name = LOGIN
24794 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24795 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24796 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
24797 ldapauth{\
24798 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24799 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24800 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24801 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24802.endd
24803We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24804does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24805operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24806&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24807correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24808the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24809uninterpreted string.
24810
24811
24812.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24813A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24814interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24815traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24816Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24817&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
24818
24819
24820
24821
24822.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24823.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24824The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24825
24826.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24827If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24828authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24829the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24830usual.
24831
24832.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24833The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24834string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24835string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24836to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24837most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24838with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24839way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24840(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24841so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24842&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24843&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24844
24845&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24846splitting takes priority and happens first.
24847
24848Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24849the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24850there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24851NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24852the string.
24853
24854This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24855authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24856.code
24857fixed_plain:
24858 driver = plaintext
24859 public_name = PLAIN
24860 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24861.endd
24862The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24863command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24864that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24865.code
24866fixed_login:
24867 driver = plaintext
24868 public_name = LOGIN
24869 client_send = : username : mysecret
24870.endd
24871The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24872the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24873prompts.
24874.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24875.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24876
24877
24878
24879
24880. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24881. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24882
24883.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24884.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24885.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24886.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24887.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24888The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24889sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24890name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24891string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24892is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24893secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24894available in plain text at either end.
24895
24896
24897.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24898.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24899This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24900authenticator as a server:
24901
24902.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24903.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24904When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24905the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24906obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24907that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24908string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24909fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24910returned to the client.
24911
24912For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24913in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24914deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24915numeric variables for other things.
24916
24917For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24918client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24919user name, authentication fails.
24920.code
24921fixed_cram:
24922 driver = cram_md5
24923 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24924 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24925 server_set_id = $auth1
24926.endd
24927.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24928If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24929name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24930secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24931.code
24932lookup_cram:
24933 driver = cram_md5
24934 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24935 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24936 {$value}fail}
24937 server_set_id = $auth1
24938.endd
24939Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24940because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24941
24942As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24943using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24944lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24945realm, with:
24946.code
24947cyrusless_crammd5:
24948 driver = cram_md5
24949 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24950 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24951 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24952 server_set_id = $auth1
24953.endd
24954
24955.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24956.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24957When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24958
24959
24960
24961.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24962This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24963computing the response to the server's challenge.
24964
24965
24966.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24967This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24968expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24969
24970
24971.vindex "&$host$&"
24972.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24973Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24974to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24975expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24976prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24977authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24978send the message to the current server.
24979
24980A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24981strings, is:
24982.code
24983fixed_cram:
24984 driver = cram_md5
24985 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24986 client_name = ph10
24987 client_secret = secret
24988.endd
24989.ecindex IIDcramauth1
24990.ecindex IIDcramauth2
24991
24992
24993
24994. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24995. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24996
24997.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24998.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24999.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25000.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25001.cindex "Kerberos"
25002The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25003Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25004
25005The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25006library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25007Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25008including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25009directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25010
25011The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25012the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25013then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25014name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25015
25016Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25017or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25018user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25019by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25020depending on the driver you are using.
25021
25022The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25023be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25024Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25025changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25026layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25027implementation.
25028
25029For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25030may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25031variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25032Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25033With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25034environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25035is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25036the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25037
25038
25039.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25040The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25041(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25042previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25043use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25044confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25045things.
25046
25047
25048.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25049This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25050library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25051SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25052
25053
25054.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25055This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25056default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25057you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25058example:
25059.code
25060sasl:
25061 driver = cyrus_sasl
25062 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25063 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25064 server_set_id = $auth1
25065.endd
25066
25067.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25068This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25069
25070
25071.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25072This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25073
25074
25075For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25076private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25077the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25078PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25079.code
25080sasl_cram_md5:
25081 driver = cyrus_sasl
25082 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25083 server_set_id = $auth1
25084
25085sasl_plain:
25086 driver = cyrus_sasl
25087 public_name = PLAIN
25088 server_set_id = $auth2
25089.endd
25090Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25091not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25092but it is present in many binary distributions.
25093.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25094.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25095
25096
25097
25098
25099. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25100. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25101.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25102.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25103.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25104This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25105Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25106If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25107to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25108authenticator only. There is only one option:
25109
25110.option server_socket dovecot string unset
25111
25112This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25113authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25114mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25115authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25116.code
25117dovecot_plain:
25118 driver = dovecot
25119 public_name = PLAIN
25120 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25121 server_set_id = $auth2
25122
25123dovecot_ntlm:
25124 driver = dovecot
25125 public_name = NTLM
25126 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25127 server_set_id = $auth1
25128.endd
25129If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25130&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25131option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25132connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25133option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25134who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25135.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25136.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25137
25138
25139. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25140. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25141.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25142.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25143.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25144.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25145.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25146.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25147.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25148.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25149.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25150.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25151.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25152.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25153The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25154library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25155and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25156scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25157made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25158without code changes in Exim.
25159
25160
25161.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25162Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25163of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25164authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25165ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25166context.
25167
25168This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25169as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25170see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25171
25172This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25173only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25174writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25175
25176This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25177this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25178of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25179
25180
25181.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25182This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25183library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25184Some mechanisms will use this data.
25185
25186
25187.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25188This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25189default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25190you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25191example:
25192.code
25193sasl:
25194 driver = gsasl
25195 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25196 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25197 server_set_id = $auth1
25198.endd
25199
25200
25201.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25202Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25203that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25204the password itself.
25205
25206The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25207In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25208The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25209if available, else the empty string.
25210The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25211else the empty string.
25212
25213A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25214
25215If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25216option to be simply "true".
25217
25218
25219.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25220This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25221Some mechanisms will use this data.
25222
25223
25224.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25225This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25226&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25227(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25228
25229
25230.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25231This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25232&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25233(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25234
25235
25236.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25237This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25238Some mechanisms will use this data.
25239
25240
25241.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25242.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25243These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25244They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25245
25246Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25247meanings for these variables:
25248
25249.ilist
25250.vindex "&$auth1$&"
25251&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25252.next
25253.vindex "&$auth2$&"
25254&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25255.next
25256.vindex "&$auth3$&"
25257&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25258.endlist
25259
25260On a per-mechanism basis:
25261
25262.ilist
25263.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25264EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25265the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25266.next
25267.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25268ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25269the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25270.next
25271.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25272GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25273&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25274the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25275.endlist
25276
25277An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25278identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25279email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25280
25281
25282An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25283and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25284.code
25285gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25286 driver = gsasl
25287 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25288 server_realm = imap.example.org
25289 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25290 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25291 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25292 server_condition = yes
25293.endd
25294
25295
25296. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25297. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25298
25299.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25300.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25301.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25302.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25303.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25304The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25305Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25306reliably.
25307
25308.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25309This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25310for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25311identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25312
25313.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25314If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25315&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25316The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25317
25318.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25319This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25320&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25321from the keytab.
25322
25323
25324.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25325Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25326to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25327not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25328
25329The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25330Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25331Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25332role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25333
25334.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25335.ilist
25336.vindex "&$auth1$&"
25337&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25338.next
25339.vindex "&$auth2$&"
25340&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25341authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25342GSS Display Name.
25343.endlist
25344
25345
25346. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25347. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25348
25349.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25350.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25351.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25352.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25353.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25354.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25355.cindex "NTLM authentication"
25356The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25357Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25358which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25359this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25360taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25361server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25362follows:
25363
25364.ilist
25365After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25366authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25367.next
25368The server sends back a challenge.
25369.next
25370The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25371and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25372.endlist
25373
25374Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25375
25376
25377
25378.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25379.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25380The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25381
25382.option server_password spa string&!! unset
25383.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25384This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25385authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25386compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25387&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25388it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25389for other things. For example:
25390.code
25391spa:
25392 driver = spa
25393 public_name = NTLM
25394 server_password = \
25395 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25396.endd
25397If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25398failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25399
25400
25401
25402
25403
25404.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25405.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25406The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25407
25408
25409
25410.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25411This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25412
25413
25414.option client_password spa string&!! unset
25415This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25416
25417
25418.option client_username spa string&!! unset
25419This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25420configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25421&'msn.com'&:
25422.code
25423msn:
25424 driver = spa
25425 public_name = MSN
25426 client_username = msn/msn_username
25427 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25428 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25429.endd
25430.ecindex IIDspaauth1
25431.ecindex IIDspaauth2
25432
25433
25434
25435
25436
25437. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25438. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25439
25440.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25441 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25442.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25443.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25444.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25445.cindex "OpenSSL"
25446.cindex "GnuTLS"
25447Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25448Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25449GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25450cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25451order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25452version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25453You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25454level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25455certificates are used.
25456
25457RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25458connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25459server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25460mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25461between them is encrypted.
25462
25463Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25464and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25465certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25466possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25467encryption state.
25468
25469&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25470disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25471in order to get TLS to work.
25472
25473
25474
25475.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25476 "SECID284"
25477.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25478.cindex "smtps protocol"
25479.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25480.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25481Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25482SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25483waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25484port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25485allocated for this purpose.
25486
25487This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25488still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25489the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25490numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25491.code
25492tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25493.endd
25494The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25495via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25496the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25497the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25498an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25499defined elsewhere.
25500
25501There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25502&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25503
25504
25505
25506
25507
25508
25509.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25510.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25511The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25512followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25513to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25514.code
25515USE_GNUTLS=yes
25516.endd
25517in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25518.code
25519SUPPORT_TLS=yes
25520.endd
25521You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25522include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25523
25524There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25525
25526.ilist
25527The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25528name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25529.next
25530The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25531.next
25532.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25533.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25534Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25535separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25536affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25537.next
25538OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25539DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25540RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25541in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25542for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25543to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25544&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25545option).
25546.next
25547The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25548sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25549.next
25550.new
25551The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25552When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25553(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25554let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25555.wen
25556.next
25557Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25558This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25559explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25560implementation, then patches are welcome.
25561.endlist
25562
25563
25564.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25565This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25566an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25567but not the chosen filename.
25568By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25569See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25570
25571GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25572to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25573Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25574&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25575of bits requested.
25576The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25577its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25578parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25579that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25580renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25581this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25582place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25583
25584For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25585recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25586If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25587are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25588not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25589
25590Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25591values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25592parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25593If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25594until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25595a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25596
25597The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25598in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25599generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25600
25601To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25602and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25603&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25604renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25605.code
25606# ls
25607[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25608# rm -f new-params
25609# touch new-params
25610# chown exim:exim new-params
25611# chmod 0600 new-params
25612# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25613# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25614[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25615 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25616 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25617# chmod 0400 new-params
25618# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25619.endd
25620If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25621stalling is removed.
25622
25623The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25624Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25625the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25626a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25627and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25628failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25629of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25630which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25631GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25632to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25633limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25634
25635The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25636value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25637&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
256382432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25639
25640In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25641increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25642bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25643procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25644the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25645
25646
25647.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25648.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25649.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25650There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25651suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25652are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25653DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25654directly to this function call.
25655Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25656&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25657The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25658documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25659
25660.ilist
25661It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25662.next
25663It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25664or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25665ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25666SSL v3 algorithms.
25667.next
25668Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25669the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25670SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25671algorithms.
25672.endlist
25673
25674Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25675&`-`& or &`+`&.
25676.ilist
25677If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25678ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25679stated.
25680.next
25681If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25682of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25683.next
25684If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25685option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25686.endlist
25687
25688If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25689a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25690includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25691not be moved to the end of the list.
25692.endlist
25693
25694The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25695string:
25696.code
25697# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25698$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25699.endd
25700
25701This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25702there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25703submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25704choice of clients used:
25705.code
25706# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25707tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25708 {DEFAULT}\
25709 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
25710.endd
25711
25712
25713
25714.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25715 "SECTreqciphgnu"
25716.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25717.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25718.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25719.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25720.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25721.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25722.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25723The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25724as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25725ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25726
25727The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25728
25729The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25730controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25731&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25732the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25733the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25734aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25735
25736Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25737"Priority strings". This is online as
25738&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25739but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25740installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25741&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
25742on that site can be used to test a given string.
25743
25744Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25745additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25746"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25747
25748This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25749there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25750by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25751where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25752used:
25753.code
25754# GnuTLS variant
25755tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25756 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
25757 {SECURE128}}
25758.endd
25759
25760
25761.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25762.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25763When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25764the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25765but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25766that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25767need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25768sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25769
25770If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25771problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25772persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25773with the error
25774.code
25775554 Security failure
25776.endd
25777If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25778rejected with a 554 error code.
25779
25780To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25781match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25782However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25783without some further configuration at the server end.
25784
25785It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25786encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25787.code
25788tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25789tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25790.endd
25791These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25792the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25793contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25794that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25795always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25796certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25797set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25798is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25799certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25800the server's certificate.
25801
25802If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25803source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25804few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25805
25806&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25807they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25808Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25809transport.
25810
25811With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25812require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25813this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25814.code
25815tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25816.endd
25817is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25818with the parameters contained in the file.
25819Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25820available:
25821.code
25822tls_dhparam = none
25823.endd
25824This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25825DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25826used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25827documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25828
25829See the command
25830.code
25831openssl dhparam
25832.endd
25833for a way of generating file data.
25834
25835The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25836host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25837for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25838in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25839forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25840
25841.cindex "cipher" "logging"
25842.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25843.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25844The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25845an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25846incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25847also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25848&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25849condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25850
25851Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25852can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25853cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25854example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25855contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25856documentation for more details.
25857
25858.new
25859For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
25860(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
25861.wen
25862
25863
25864.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25865.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25866.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25867If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25868session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25869&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25870apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25871Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25872contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25873expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25874for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25875&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25876
25877A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25878directory is used
25879(OpenSSL only),
25880each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25881of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25882certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25883.code
25884openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25885.endd
25886where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25887
25888The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25889what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25890does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25891&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25892attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25893dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25894session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25895fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25896example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25897relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25898
25899.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25900When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25901the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25902&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25903
25904.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25905Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25906&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25907&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25908&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25909certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
25910
25911
25912.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25913.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25914.cindex "revocation list"
25915.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25916Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25917certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25918server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25919an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25920of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25921CRL in PEM format.
25922
25923
25924.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25925.cindex "cipher" "logging"
25926.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25927.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25928.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25929The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25930deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25931server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25932within the &(smtp)& transport.
25933
25934It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25935transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25936server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25937this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25938transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25939
25940If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25941to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25942&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25943those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25944set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25945usual way.
25946
25947When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25948the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25949a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25950session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25951&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25952delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25953it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25954STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25955negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25956unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25957unencrypted.
25958
25959The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25960transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25961if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25962&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25963
25964If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25965must name a file or,
25966for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25967expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25968against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25969in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25970
25971If
25972&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25973list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25974the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25975alternative hosts, if any.
25976
25977 &*Note*&:
25978These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25979is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25980by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25981client.
25982
25983.vindex "&$host$&"
25984.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25985All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25986&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25987which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25988behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25989
25990.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
25991.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
25992.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
25993.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
25994Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25995&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
25996variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25997that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25998successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25999outgoing connection.
26000
26001
26002
26003.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26004.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26005.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26006.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26007With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26008information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26009extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26010&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26011client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26012within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26013for this session.
26014
26015This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26016which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26017address.
26018
26019With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26020against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26021provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26022be of limited use in that environment.
26023
26024With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26025connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26026choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26027wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26028different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26029
26030The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26031if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26032nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26033only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26034for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26035
26036Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26037received from a client.
26038It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26039
26040If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26041option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26042during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26043
26044.ilist
26045.vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26046&%tls_certificate%&
26047.next
26048.vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26049&%tls_crl%&
26050.next
26051.vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26052&%tls_privatekey%&
26053.next
26054.vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26055&%tls_verify_certificates%&
26056.endlist
26057
26058Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26059attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26060can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26061arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26062
26063The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26064are re-expanded.
26065
26066When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26067for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26068enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26069see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26070
26071When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
260720.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26073built, then you have SNI support).
26074
26075
26076
26077.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26078 "SECTmulmessam"
26079.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26080.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26081Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26082an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26083one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26084of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26085connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26086to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26087session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26088try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26089if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26090
26091The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26092after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26093just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26094reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26095successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26096SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26097should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26098subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26099and delay other deliveries to that host.
26100
26101To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26102closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26103closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26104information is recorded.
26105
26106There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26107&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26108connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26109
26110
26111
26112
26113.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
26114.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
26115In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
26116certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
26117place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
26118myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
26119to Apache, currently at
26120.display
26121&url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
26122.endd
26123Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
26124links to further files.
26125Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
261260-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
26127Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
26128.display
26129&url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
26130.endd
26131
26132
26133.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
26134The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
26135certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
26136sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
26137not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
26138First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
26139certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
26140intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
26141certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
26142The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
26143validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
26144root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
26145install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
26146
26147
26148.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
26149.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
26150You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
26151with OpenSSL, like this:
26152.new
26153. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
26154. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
26155.wen
26156.code
26157openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
26158 -days 9999 -nodes
26159.endd
26160&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
26161delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
26162specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
26163important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
26164that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
26165prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
26166this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
26167
26168.new
26169. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
26170. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
26171. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
26172. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
26173. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
26174. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
26175. ==== -pdp, 2012
26176NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
26177epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
26178the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
26179the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
26180of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
26181writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
26182progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
26183be a sensible resolution).
26184.wen
26185
26186A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
26187may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
26188encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
26189
26190However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
26191user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
26192certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
26193must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
26194authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
26195signed with that self-signed certificate.
26196
26197For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
26198user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
26199Open-source PKI book, available online at
26200&url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
26201.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
26202.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
26203
26204
26205
26206. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26207. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26208
26209.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
26210.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
26211.cindex "control of incoming mail"
26212.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
26213.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
26214Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
26215configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
26216name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
26217one very small ACL:
26218.code
26219begin acl
26220small_acl:
26221 accept hosts = one.host.only
26222.endd
26223You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
26224which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26225
26226The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26227certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26228when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26229option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26230in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26231local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26232a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26233&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26234
26235
26236.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26237The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26238configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26239The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26240relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26241
26242
26243
26244.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26245.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26246In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26247options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26248.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26249.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26250.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26251.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26252.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26253.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26254.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26255.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26256.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26257.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26258.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26259.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26260.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26261.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26262
26263.table2 140pt
26264.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26265.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26266.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26267.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26268.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26269.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26270.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26271.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26272.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26273.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26274.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26275.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26276.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26277.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26278.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26279.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26280.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26281.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26282.endtable
26283
26284For example, if you set
26285.code
26286acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26287.endd
26288the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26289in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26290done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26291sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26292command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26293trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26294testing as possible at RCPT time.
26295
26296
26297.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26298.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26299The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26300apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26301really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26302the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26303relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26304are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26305&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26306&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26307in any of these ACLs.
26308
26309The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26310non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26311analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26312batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26313result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26314really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26315on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26316controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26317.code
26318control = suppress_local_fixups
26319.endd
26320This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26321run, it is too late.
26322
26323The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26324content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26325
26326The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26327kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26328temporary error for these kinds of message.
26329
26330
26331.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26332.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26333.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26334The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26335session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26336an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26337accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26338the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26339&%smtp_banner%& option.
26340
26341
26342.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26343.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26344.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26345The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26346EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26347&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26348Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26349session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26350setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26351
26352If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26353modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26354at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26355affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26356an EHLO response.
26357
26358
26359.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26360.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26361Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26362command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26363When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26364is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26365the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26366response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26367added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26368are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26369
26370You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26371in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26372tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26373received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26374the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26375associated with the DATA command.
26376
26377For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26378error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26379MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26380before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26381and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26382your resources.
26383
26384.new
26385The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after both the &%acl_smtp_dkim%& and
26386the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
26387.wen
26388
26389.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26390The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26391enabled (which is the default).
26392
26393The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26394received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26395otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26396
26397.new
26398This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26399
26400For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
26401.wen
26402
26403
26404.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26405The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26406content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26407
26408This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26409
26410
26411.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26412.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26413The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26414does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26415does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26416permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26417
26418This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26419session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26420messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26421more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26422
26423&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26424the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26425
26426You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26427&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26428response to QUIT.
26429
26430This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26431failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26432because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26433client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26434connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26435
26436
26437.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26438.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26439The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26440an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
26441trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26442because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26443situation even worse.
26444
26445Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26446logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26447modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26448and &%warn%&.
26449
26450.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26451When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26452to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26453connection. The possible values are:
26454.table2
26455.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26456.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26457.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26458.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26459.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26460.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26461.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26462.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26463.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26464.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26465.endtable
26466In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26467Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26468With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26469overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26470&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26471used.
26472
26473
26474.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26475.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26476The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26477you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26478.code
26479acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26480 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26481.endd
26482In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26483providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26484non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26485expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26486more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26487
26488The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26489configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26490string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26491
26492.ilist
26493If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26494contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26495Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26496lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26497If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26498causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26499.code
26500acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26501 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26502 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26503.endd
26504This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26505back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26506file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26507can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26508.next
26509If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26510Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26511matches the string.
26512.next
26513If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26514the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26515want to have something like
26516.code
26517acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26518.endd
26519in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26520newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26521.endlist
26522
26523
26524
26525
26526.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26527.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26528Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26529section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26530&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26531database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26532return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26533&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26534This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26535
26536For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26537&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26538submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26539
26540
26541ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26542has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26543individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26544blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26545
26546If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26547ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26548RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26549recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26550run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26551remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26552&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26553
26554
26555.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26556The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26557recipients; it may create new recipients.
26558
26559
26560
26561.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26562.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26563The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26564all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26565not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26566reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26567
26568For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26569these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26570used to accept or reject anything.
26571
26572For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26573&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26574&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26575when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26576
26577For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26578&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26579This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26580messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26581configuration file.
26582
26583
26584
26585
26586.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26587.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26588.vindex &$domain$&
26589.vindex &$local_part$&
26590.vindex &$sender_address$&
26591.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26592.vindex &$smtp_command$&
26593When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26594that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26595&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26596statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26597&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26598is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26599
26600When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26601contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26602set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26603how it is used.
26604
26605.vindex "&$message_size$&"
26606The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26607the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26608that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26609the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26610received).
26611
26612.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26613.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26614The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26615The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26616accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26617of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26618&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26619&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26620
26621
26622
26623
26624
26625.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26626.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26627.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26628.vindex &$smtp_command$&
26629When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26630the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26631and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26632These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26633here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26634encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26635does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26636unencrypted connections.
26637.code
26638acl_check_auth:
26639 accept encrypted = *
26640 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26641 {CRAM-MD5}}
26642 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26643.endd
26644(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26645that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26646encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26647option to do this.)
26648
26649
26650
26651.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26652.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26653.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26654An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26655with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26656Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26657set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26658
26659If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26660used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26661provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26662example:
26663.code
26664deny dnslists = list1.example
26665dnslists = list2.example
26666.endd
26667If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26668the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26669happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26670all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26671test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26672
26673
26674.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26675The ACL verbs are as follows:
26676
26677.ilist
26678.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26679&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26680of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26681appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26682is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26683after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26684check a RCPT command:
26685.code
26686accept domains = +local_domains
26687endpass
26688verify = recipient
26689.endd
26690If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26691passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26692the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26693fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26694&%endpass%&.
26695
26696The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26697use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26698that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26699configuration.
26700
26701.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26702If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26703depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26704(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26705statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26706SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26707.display
26708&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26709&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26710.endd
26711You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26712response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26713same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26714
26715If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26716an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26717for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26718of &%endpass%&.
26719
26720
26721.next
26722.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26723&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26724an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26725&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26726temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26727&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26728be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26729
26730
26731.next
26732.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26733&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26734the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26735example,
26736.code
26737deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26738.endd
26739rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26740
26741
26742.next
26743.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26744&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26745&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26746that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26747the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26748recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26749recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26750message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26751do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26752
26753If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26754its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26755The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26756
26757
26758.next
26759.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26760&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26761forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26762.code
26763drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26764 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26765.endd
26766There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26767The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26768
26769.next
26770.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26771&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26772statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26773example, when checking a RCPT command,
26774.code
26775require message = Sender did not verify
26776 verify = sender
26777.endd
26778passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26779verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26780&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26781discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26782
26783.next
26784.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26785&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26786&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26787to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26788written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26789message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26790duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26791
26792If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26793and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26794&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
26795first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26796&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26797
26798If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26799some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26800This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26801is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26802conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26803is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26804onwards.
26805
26806
26807.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26808When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26809text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26810want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26811.code
26812warn !verify = sender
26813 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26814.endd
26815.endlist
26816
26817At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26818
26819As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26820written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26821subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26822continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26823mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26824
26825
26826
26827.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26828.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26829There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26830can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26831of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26832transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26833variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26834an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26835alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26836the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26837.ilist
26838The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26839throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26840while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26841on the same SMTP connection.
26842.next
26843The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26844while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26845reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26846.endlist
26847
26848When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26849preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26850time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26851.code
26852accept hosts = whatever
26853 set acl_m4 = some value
26854accept authenticated = *
26855 set acl_c_auth = yes
26856.endd
26857&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26858be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26859&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26860
26861.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26862What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26863referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26864false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26865error is generated.
26866
26867Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26868their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26869
26870
26871.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26872.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26873.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26874An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26875.code
26876deny domains = *.dom.example
26877 !verify = recipient
26878.endd
26879causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26880&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26881negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26882two statements are equivalent:
26883.code
26884deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26885deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26886.endd
26887However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26888side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26889
26890The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26891of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26892condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26893.code
26894accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26895 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26896accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26897 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26898.endd
26899Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26900the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26901different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26902condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26903therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26904the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26905and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26906
26907ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26908specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26909others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26910warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26911message is handled.
26912
26913The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
26914processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26915modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26916consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26917.code
26918require message = Can't verify sender
26919 verify = sender
26920 message = Can't verify recipient
26921 verify = recipient
26922 message = This message cannot be used
26923.endd
26924If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26925&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26926so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26927recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26928verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26929because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26930
26931For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26932modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26933happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26934the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26935.code
26936deny hosts = ...
26937 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26938 message = Invalid sender from client host
26939.endd
26940The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26941by which time Exim has set up the message.
26942
26943
26944
26945.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26946.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26947The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26948
26949.vlist
26950.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26951This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26952incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26953accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26954
26955.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26956.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26957.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26958This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26959continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26960the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26961update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26962write rather ugly lines like this:
26963.display
26964&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26965.endd
26966Instead, all you need is
26967.display
26968&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26969.endd
26970
26971.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26972.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26973This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26974incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26975lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26976lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26977controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26978even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26979
26980As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26981separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26982in several different ways. For example:
26983
26984. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26985. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26986. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26987. ==== way.
26988
26989.ilist
26990It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26991.code
26992 accept ...some conditions
26993 control = queue_only
26994.endd
26995In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26996other words, when the conditions are all true.
26997
26998.next
26999It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27000.code
27001 accept ...some conditions...
27002 control = queue_only
27003 ...some more conditions...
27004.endd
27005If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27006statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27007In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27008to be relevant.
27009
27010.next
27011It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27012decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27013example:
27014.code
27015 warn ...some conditions...
27016 control = freeze
27017 accept ...
27018.endd
27019This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27020&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27021log entry.
27022
27023.next
27024If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27025&%require%& verb. For example:
27026.code
27027 require control = no_multiline_responses
27028.endd
27029.endlist
27030
27031.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27032.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27033.oindex "&%-bh%&"
27034This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27035the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27036&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27037output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27038happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27039output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27040
27041Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27042example:
27043.code
27044deny ...some conditions...
27045 delay = 30s
27046.endd
27047The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27048&"deny"&. Compare this with:
27049.code
27050deny delay = 30s
27051 ...some conditions...
27052.endd
27053which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27054can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27055.code
27056warn ...some conditions...
27057 delay = 2m
27058 control = freeze
27059accept ...
27060.endd
27061
27062If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27063responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
27064they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
27065delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
27066appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
27067unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
27068using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
27069
27070
27071.vitem &*endpass*&
27072.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
27073This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
27074&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
27075failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
27076failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
27077confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
27078&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
27079
27080
27081.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27082.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
27083This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
27084ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
27085.code
27086require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
27087 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
27088.endd
27089&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
27090example:
27091.display
27092&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
27093&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
27094.endd
27095When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
27096that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
27097recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
27098message.
27099
27100The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
27101the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
27102denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
27103available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
27104variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
27105&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
27106ignored.
27107
27108.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27109If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
27110verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
27111error message.
27112
27113If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
27114the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
27115more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
27116actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
27117of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
27118is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
27119
27120If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
27121example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
27122the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
27123logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
27124both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
27125logging rejections.
27126
27127
27128.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
27129.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
27130.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
27131This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
27132about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
27133be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
27134may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
27135ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
27136.display
27137&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
27138&` log_reject_target =`&
27139.endd
27140This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
27141permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
27142current ACL.
27143
27144
27145.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27146.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
27147.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
27148This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
27149processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
27150&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
27151access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
27152ACLs. For example:
27153.display
27154&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
27155&` control = freeze`&
27156&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
27157.endd
27158By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
27159with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
27160another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
27161example:
27162.code
27163logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
27164logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
27165.endd
27166
27167
27168.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27169.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27170This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
27171message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
27172or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
27173there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
27174&%accept%& for details.)
27175
27176The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
27177to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
27178generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
27179&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
27180the &%hosts%& condition fails:
27181.code
27182require message = Host not recognized
27183 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
27184.endd
27185(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
27186processed.)
27187
27188.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
27189.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
27190For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
27191of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
27192is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
27193is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
27194overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
27195accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
27196truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
27197EHLO options.
27198
27199When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
27200consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
27201of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
27202.code
27203deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
27204 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
27205.endd
27206The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
27207by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
27208access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
272092&'xx'&.
27210
27211Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
27212the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
27213
27214The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
27215literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
27216anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
27217response.
27218
27219.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27220If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
27221specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
27222However, the original message is available in the variable
27223&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
27224wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
27225routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
27226use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
27227
27228For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27229is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27230modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27231all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27232&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27233&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27234effect.
27235
27236
27237.new
27238.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27239This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27240 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27241the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27242.wen
27243
27244
27245.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27246.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27247This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27248&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27249
27250
27251.new
27252.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
27253This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
27254collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
27255the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
27256of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
27257server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
27258separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
27259example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
27260when:
27261.code
27262udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
27263 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
27264.endd
27265.wen
27266.endlist
27267
27268
27269
27270
27271.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27272.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27273The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27274
27275.vlist
27276.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27277This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27278has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27279apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27280HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27281really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27282not work without it. For example:
27283.code
27284warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27285 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27286.endd
27287Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27288the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27289matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27290mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27291by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27292
27293
27294.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27295 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27296.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27297.cindex "case of local parts"
27298.vindex "&$local_part$&"
27299These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27300(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27301are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27302any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27303for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27304is encountered.
27305
27306These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27307local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27308in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27309handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27310configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27311
27312This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27313containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27314spam score:
27315.code
27316warn control = caseful_local_part
27317 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27318 $acl_m4 + \
27319 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27320 }
27321 control = caselower_local_part
27322.endd
27323Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27324is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27325
27326
27327.new
27328.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
27329.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
27330.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
27331This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
27332It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
27333from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
27334requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
27335after the ACL completes.
27336.new "Note that routers are used in verify mode."
27337
27338Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
27339a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
27340If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27341usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27342is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27343line.
27344
27345Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27346sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27347.wen
27348
27349
27350.new
27351.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27352.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27353.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27354This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27355with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27356&'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27357may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27358the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27359option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27360contexts):
27361.code
27362 control = debug
27363 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27364 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27365 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27366.endd
27367.wen
27368
27369
27370.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
27371.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
27372.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
27373This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
27374the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27375
27376
27377.new
27378.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27379.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27380.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27381This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27382connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27383strings or to numeric value.
27384The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27385Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27386&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27387
27388The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27389(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27390that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27391equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27392Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27393.wen
27394
27395
27396.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27397 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27398.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27399.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27400These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27401is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27402state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27403in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27404
27405The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27406connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27407messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27408&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27409before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27410synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27411work with.
27412
27413
27414.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27415.cindex "fake defer"
27416.cindex "defer, fake"
27417This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27418except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27419550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27420messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27421use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27422
27423.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27424.cindex "fake rejection"
27425.cindex "rejection, fake"
27426This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27427words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27428message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27429However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27430only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27431the same SMTP connection.
27432
27433The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27434message is supplied, the following is used:
27435.code
27436550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27437550-kept for evaluation.
27438550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27439550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27440.endd
27441This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27442
27443.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27444.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27445This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27446other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27447it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27448current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27449SMTP connection.
27450
27451This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27452&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27453is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27454are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27455
27456.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27457.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27458Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27459avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27460use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27461disables such output flushing.
27462
27463.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27464.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27465Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27466avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27467use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27468that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
27469
27470.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
27471This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
27472extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
27473of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
27474or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
27475needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
27476only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27477the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
27478to be useful in production.
27479
27480.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
27481.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
27482This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
27483It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
27484SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
27485
27486If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
27487suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
27488one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
27489(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
27490responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
27491sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
27492
27493.ilist
27494Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
27495sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
27496verification failed"&) is sent.
27497.next
27498If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
27499line is output.
27500.endlist
27501
27502The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
27503calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
27504
27505.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27506.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27507This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27508the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27509response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27510controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27511&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27512
27513.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27514.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27515.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27516This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27517other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27518it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27519runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27520effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27521to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27522same SMTP connection.
27523
27524.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27525.cindex "message" "submission"
27526.cindex "submission mode"
27527This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27528latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27529the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27530operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27531necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27532This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27533late (the message has already been created).
27534
27535Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27536messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27537submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27538The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27539that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27540
27541.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27542.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27543This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27544complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27545normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27546
27547.ilist
27548Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27549dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27550.next
27551No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27552.next
27553There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27554.endlist ilist
27555
27556This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27557passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27558used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27559and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27560data is read.
27561
27562&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27563that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27564.endlist vlist
27565
27566
27567.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27568All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27569
27570.ilist
27571Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27572.next
27573Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27574&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27575.next
27576Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27577.next
27578Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27579.endlist
27580
27581
27582
27583.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27584.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27585.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27586.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
27587The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27588to an incoming message, as in this example:
27589.code
27590warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27591 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27592 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27593.endd
27594The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27595MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27596receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27597&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27598any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27599RCPT ACL).
27600
27601Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
27602the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
27603contains one or more newlines that
27604are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27605lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27606front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27607
27608Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27609They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27610However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27611is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27612during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27613with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27614lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27615In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27616non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27617message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27618are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27619
27620.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27621Header lines are not visible in string expansions
27622of message headers
27623until they are added to the
27624message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27625ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27626header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27627ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27628passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27629this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27630&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27631
27632.new
27633The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
27634.wen
27635
27636The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27637processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27638.display
27639&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27640&` `&<&'some condition'&>
27641
27642&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27643&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27644.endd
27645In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27646condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27647condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27648ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27649honoured.
27650
27651.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27652For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27653&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27654effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27655them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27656usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27657are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27658specifications.
27659
27660By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27661header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27662be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27663after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27664that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27665
27666This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27667&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27668header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27669to be a header name first.) For example:
27670.code
27671warn add_header = \
27672 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27673.endd
27674If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27675each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27676you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27677up in reverse order.
27678
27679&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27680added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27681system filter or in a router or transport.
27682
27683
27684
27685.new
27686.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
27687.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
27688.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
27689.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
27690The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
27691from an incoming message, as in this example:
27692.code
27693warn message = Remove internal headers
27694 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27695.endd
27696The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27697MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27698receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27699&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
27700with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
27701any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
27702
27703More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
27704list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
27705not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
27706create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
27707are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
27708.code
27709warn hosts = +internal_hosts
27710 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27711warn message = Remove internal headers
27712 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
27713.endd
27714Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27715They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27716There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
27717a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
27718during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
27719if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
27720accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
27721all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
27722ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
27723would have been removed.
27724
27725.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
27726Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
27727is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
27728not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
27729removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
27730this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
27731passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
27732you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
27733&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27734
27735The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27736processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27737.display
27738&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
27739&` `&<&'some condition'&>
27740
27741&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27742&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
27743.endd
27744In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
27745condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
27746condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
27747same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
27748are honoured.
27749
27750&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27751present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
27752in a system filter or in a router or transport.
27753.wen
27754
27755
27756
27757
27758.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27759.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27760Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27761compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27762for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27763content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27764
27765Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27766senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27767result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27768done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27769can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27770same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27771The conditions are as follows:
27772
27773
27774.vlist
27775.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27776.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27777.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27778.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
27779.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27780The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27781&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27782&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27783false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27784condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27785condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27786ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27787
27788.new
27789If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
27790can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
27791and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
27792Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
27793The name and values are expanded separately.
27794.wen
27795
27796If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27797the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27798&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27799conditions are tested.
27800
27801ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27802loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27803circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27804for different local users or different local domains.
27805
27806.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27807.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27808.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27809.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27810If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27811the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27812authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27813.code
27814authenticated = *
27815.endd
27816
27817.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27818.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27819.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27820.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27821.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27822This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27823expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27824&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27825number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27826any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27827&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27828ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27829negative.
27830
27831.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27832.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27833This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27834content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27835&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27836If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27837problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27838chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27839
27840.vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27841.cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27842This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27843content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27844&<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27845
27846.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27847.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27848.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27849.cindex "black list (DNS)"
27850.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27851This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27852&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27853use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27854different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27855&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27856
27857.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27858.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27859.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27860.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27861.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27862This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27863of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27864enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27865lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27866&%domains%& test.
27867
27868&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27869use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27870
27871
27872.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27873.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27874.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27875.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27876If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27877name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27878encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27879.code
27880encrypted = *
27881.endd
27882
27883
27884.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
27885.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27886.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27887.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27888This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27889name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27890you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27891.code
27892accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27893.endd
27894The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27895the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27896and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27897
27898The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27899Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27900but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27901find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27902opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27903found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27904
27905If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27906address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27907.code
27908accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27909accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27910.endd
27911The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27912is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27913statement can then check the IP address.
27914
27915.vindex "&$host_data$&"
27916If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27917of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27918allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27919.code
27920deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27921message = $host_data
27922.endd
27923which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27924
27925.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27926.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27927.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27928.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27929.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27930This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27931part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27932enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27933result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27934the next &%local_parts%& test.
27935
27936.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27937.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27938.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27939.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27940This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27941content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27942viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27943
27944.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27945.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27946.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27947This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27948content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27949&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27950with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27951&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27952
27953.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27954.cindex "rate limiting"
27955This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27956messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27957
27958.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27959.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27960.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27961.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27962This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27963recipient address against a list of recipients.
27964
27965.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27966.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27967.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27968This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27969content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27970non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27971any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27972
27973.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27974.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27975.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27976.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27977.vindex "&$domain$&"
27978.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27979This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27980domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27981&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27982of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27983lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27984RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27985influence the sender checking.
27986
27987&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27988relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27989
27990.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27991.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27992.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27993.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27994This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27995for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27996.code
27997senders = :
27998.endd
27999&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28000relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28001
28002.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28003.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28004.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28005This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28006content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28007SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28008
28009.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28010.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28011.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28012.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28013.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28014.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28015This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28016certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28017server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28018or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28019
28020.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28021.cindex "CSA verification"
28022This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28023send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28024&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28025
28026.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
28027.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28028.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
28029.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
28030.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
28031.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
28032This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28033received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28034&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
28035of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
28036is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
28037However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
28038that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
28039to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
28040might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
28041
28042Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
28043section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
28044&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
28045condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
28046.code
28047deny senders = :
28048 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
28049 !verify = header_sender
28050.endd
28051
28052.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
28053.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28054.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
28055.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
28056.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
28057This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28058received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28059&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
28060lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
28061and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
28062permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
28063&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
28064appropriate.
28065
28066Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
28067ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
28068.code
28069To: @
28070.endd
28071and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
28072common as they used to be.
28073
28074.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
28075.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28076.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
28077.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
28078.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
28079.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
28080.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
28081This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
28082client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
28083attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
28084condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
28085&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
28086independently of this condition.
28087
28088For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
28089option), this condition is always true.
28090
28091
28092.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
28093.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
28094.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
28095This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
28096Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
28097&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
28098case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
28099&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
28100used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
28101
28102There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
28103recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
28104
28105
28106.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
28107.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28108.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
28109.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
28110.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
28111.vindex "&$address_data$&"
28112This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
28113recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
28114&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
28115of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
28116This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
28117verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
28118address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
28119value for the child address.
28120
28121.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
28122.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28123.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
28124.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
28125This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
28126address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
28127was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
28128Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
28129one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
28130original IP address.
28131
28132If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
28133is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
28134
28135.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
28136.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28137.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
28138.cindex "sender" "verifying"
28139.cindex "verifying" "sender"
28140This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
28141message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
28142the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
28143condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
28144
28145.vindex "&$address_data$&"
28146.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
28147If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
28148value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
28149value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
28150statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
28151want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
28152
28153Details of verification are given later, starting at section
28154&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
28155to avoid doing it more than once per message.
28156
28157.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
28158.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28159This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
28160verified as a sender.
28161.endlist
28162
28163
28164
28165.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
28166.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28167.cindex "black list (DNS)"
28168.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28169In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
28170is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
28171address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
28172domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
28173special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
28174address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
28175.code
28176deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
28177 dialups.mail-abuse.org
28178.endd
28179the following records are looked up:
28180.code
2818143.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
2818243.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
28183.endd
28184As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
28185Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
28186to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
28187use two separate conditions:
28188.code
28189deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28190 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28191.endd
28192If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
28193behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
28194record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
28195processed.
28196
28197This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
28198(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
28199blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
28200following special items in the list:
28201.display
28202&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
28203&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
28204&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
28205.endd
28206.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
28207.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
28208.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
28209Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
28210.code
28211deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
28212.endd
28213Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
28214warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
28215.code
28216deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28217warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
28218 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28219.endd
28220DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
28221so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
28222connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
28223connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
28224
28225
28226
28227.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
28228.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
28229By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
28230of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
28231after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
28232.code
28233deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
28234.endd
28235This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
28236use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
28237MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
28238&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
28239
28240
28241
28242
28243.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
28244.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
28245There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
28246addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
28247&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
28248with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
28249listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28250.code
28251deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28252 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28253.endd
28254This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28255RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28256example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28257up by this example is
28258.code
28259tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28260.endd
28261A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28262addresses. For example:
28263.code
28264deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28265 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28266.endd
28267The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28268name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28269
28270
28271
28272
28273.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28274.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28275The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28276names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28277name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28278As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28279this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28280either to double the separators like this:
28281.code
28282dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28283.endd
28284or to change the separator character, like this:
28285.code
28286dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28287.endd
28288If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28289blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28290occurs. Consider this condition:
28291.code
28292dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28293.endd
28294The DNS lookups that occur are:
28295.code
282962.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28297a.domain.black.list.tld
28298.endd
28299Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
28300address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
28301are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
28302or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
28303only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
28304successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
28305error for a previous item.
28306
28307The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
28308syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
28309.code
28310dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
28311dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
28312.endd
28313However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
28314is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
28315.code
28316deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
28317 $sender_address_domain \
28318 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
28319 see $dnslist_text.
28320 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
28321 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
28322 $sender_address_domain} }} }
28323.endd
28324Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
28325multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
28326and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
28327of expanding the condition might be something like this:
28328.code
28329dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
28330.endd
28331Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
28332domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
28333
28334The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
28335&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
28336
28337
28338
28339
28340.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
28341.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
28342DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
28343just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
28344RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
28345The values used on the RBL+ list are:
28346.display
28347127.1.0.1 RBL
28348127.1.0.2 DUL
28349127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
28350127.1.0.4 RSS
28351127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
28352127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
28353127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
28354.endd
28355Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
28356different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
28357see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
28358
28359
28360.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
28361.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
28362.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
28363.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
28364.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
28365.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
28366.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
28367When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
28368the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
28369&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
28370(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
28371the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
28372&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
28373cases, for example:
28374.code
28375deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
28376.endd
28377the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
28378&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
28379For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
28380might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
28381.code
28382deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
28383.endd
28384If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
28385&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
28386
28387If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
28388addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
28389The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
28390record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
28391very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
28392information.
28393
28394You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
28395&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
28396expanded until after it has failed. For example:
28397.code
28398deny hosts = !+local_networks
28399 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
28400 at $dnslist_domain
28401 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
28402.endd
28403
28404
28405
28406.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
28407.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
28408You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
28409in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
28410For example,
28411.code
28412deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
28413.endd
28414rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
28415any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
28416that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
28417describes how multiple records are handled.
28418
28419More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
28420separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
28421&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
28422.code
28423deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28424.endd
28425If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
28426addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
28427first. For example:
28428.code
28429deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
28430 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
28431.endd
28432
28433If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
28434listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
28435In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
28436true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
28437tested. For example:
28438.code
28439dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
28440.endd
28441matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
28442want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
28443being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
28444.code
28445dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28446.endd
28447matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
28448an odd number.
28449
28450
28451
28452.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
28453You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
28454condition. Whereas
28455.code
28456deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28457.endd
28458means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28459IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
28460.code
28461deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28462.endd
28463means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28464IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
28465words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
28466the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
28467
28468&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
28469host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
28470
28471If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
28472previous example is precisely equivalent to
28473.code
28474deny dnslists = a.b.c
28475 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28476.endd
28477However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
28478Consider this example:
28479.code
28480deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28481 list.dsbl.org : \
28482 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
28483 relays.ordb.org
28484.endd
28485Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
28486.code
28487deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28488 list.dsbl.org
28489deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
28490 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
28491deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
28492.endd
28493which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
28494
28495
28496
28497
28498.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
28499A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
28500thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
28501is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
28502the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
28503the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
28504.code
28505dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
28506.endd
28507What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
28508127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
28509condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
28510because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
28511affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
28512additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
28513
28514.ilist
28515If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
28516IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
28517condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28518.next
28519If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
28520looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
28521changed to:
28522.code
28523dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
28524.endd
28525and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28526false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
28527.code
28528dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
28529.endd
28530for the condition to be true.
28531.endlist
28532
28533When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
28534the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
28535.ilist
28536If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
28537addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
28538.code
28539dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
28540.endd
28541If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28542false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28543.next
28544If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
28545looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
28546.code
28547dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
28548.endd
28549If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28550true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
28551.code
28552dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28553.endd
28554for the condition to be false.
28555.endlist
28556When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
28557between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
28558
28559
28560
28561
28562.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
28563.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
28564When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
28565the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
28566the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
28567address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
28568only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
28569can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
28570in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
28571lists.
28572
28573A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
28574two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
28575do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
28576If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
28577restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
28578a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
28579domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
28580.code
28581reject message = \
28582 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
28583 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
28584 dnslists = \
28585 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
28586 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28587.endd
28588For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
28589&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
28590match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
28591value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
28592record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
28593The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
28594
28595If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
28596given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
28597the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
28598.code
28599reject dnslists = \
28600 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
28601 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
28602 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
28603 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28604.endd
28605In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
28606values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
28607done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
28608
28609
28610
28611.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
28612.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
28613.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
28614If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
28615nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
286163ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
28617.code
286181.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
28619 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28620.endd
28621(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
28622lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
28623IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
28624.code
28625*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
28626.endd
28627is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
28628Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
28629
28630You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
28631&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
28632.code
28633deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
28634 dnslists = some.list.example
28635.endd
28636
28637.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
28638.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
28639.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
28640.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
28641The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
28642which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
28643&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
28644commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
28645works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28646host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28647.display
28648&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28649.endd
28650If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28651period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28652
28653As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28654&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28655configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28656of &'p'&.
28657
28658The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28659time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28660means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28661parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28662send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28663in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28664constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28665changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28666both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28667
28668There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28669log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28670when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28671instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28672
28673The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28674sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28675retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28676which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28677By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28678of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28679user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28680&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28681example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28682authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28683
28684The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28685rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28686&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28687ACL.
28688
28689Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28690specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28691or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28692&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28693using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28694separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28695
28696Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28697any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28698stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28699remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28700remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28701behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28702the &%count=%& option.
28703
28704
28705.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28706.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28707The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28708normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28709&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28710
28711The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28712the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28713&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28714&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28715
28716The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28717the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28718in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28719used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28720in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28721follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28722in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28723
28724The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28725accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28726&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28727&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28728ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28729in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28730recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28731
28732The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28733number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28734last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28735recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28736&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
28737
28738The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28739condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28740command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28741multiple different commands.
28742
28743The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28744measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28745&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28746increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28747other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28748
28749The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28750
28751
28752.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28753.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28754You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28755control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28756mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28757
28758If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28759previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28760
28761For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28762it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28763can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28764in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28765new rate.
28766.code
28767acl_check_connect:
28768 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28769 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28770 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28771# ...
28772acl_check_mail:
28773 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28774 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28775 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28776.endd
28777
28778If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28779processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28780it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28781in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28782same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28783multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28784checks.
28785
28786The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28787use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28788update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28789&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28790next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28791
28792
28793.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28794.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28795If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28796engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28797&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28798counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28799rest of the ACL.
28800
28801The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28802updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28803client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28804the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28805counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28806email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28807is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28808For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28809from getting any email through.
28810
28811The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28812updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28813of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28814actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28815counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28816pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28817again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28818attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28819.code
28820 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28821.endd
28822
28823
28824.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28825.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28826The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28827rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28828mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28829sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28830&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28831measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28832options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28833
28834For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28835has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28836rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28837per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28838go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28839recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28840
28841When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28842&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28843rate.
28844
28845The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28846other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28847unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28848required increases with larger limits.
28849
28850The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28851will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28852the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28853the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28854events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28855times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28856throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28857limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28858are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28859as intended.
28860
28861
28862.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28863Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28864when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28865(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28866policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28867message. For example:
28868.code
28869# Log all senders' rates
28870warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28871 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28872
28873# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28874# at the decimal point.
28875warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28876 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28877 $sender_rate_limit }s
28878
28879# Keep authenticated users under control
28880deny authenticated = *
28881 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28882
28883# System-wide rate limit
28884defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28885 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28886
28887# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28888# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28889defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28890 messages per $sender_rate_period
28891 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28892 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28893 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28894.endd
28895&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28896especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28897bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28898making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28899RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28900this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28901hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28902
28903
28904
28905.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28906.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28907.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28908Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28909&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28910&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28911The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28912verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28913other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28914.code
28915verify = sender/callout
28916verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28917.endd
28918The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28919address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28920difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28921be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28922(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28923The available options are as follows:
28924
28925.ilist
28926If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28927remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28928check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28929.next
28930If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28931normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28932options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28933verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28934.next
28935The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28936discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28937.next
28938The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28939immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28940generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28941discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28942.endlist
28943
28944.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28945.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28946.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28947.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28948After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28949error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28950coding like this:
28951.code
28952warn !verify = sender
28953 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28954.endd
28955If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28956denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28957verification failure.
28958
28959In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28960appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28961
28962.ilist
28963&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28964was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28965.next
28966&%route%&: Routing failed.
28967.next
28968&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28969occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28970connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28971.next
28972&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28973.next
28974&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28975.endlist
28976
28977The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28978rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28979
28980
28981
28982
28983.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28984.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28985.cindex "callout" "verification"
28986.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28987For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28988checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28989the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28990&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28991a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28992address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28993sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28994deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28995sender's domain.
28996
28997Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28998request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28999described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29000lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29001cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29002caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29003
29004Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29005the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29006callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29007callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29008on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29009
29010If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29011second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29012one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29013&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29014router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29015&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
29016&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
29017supplies a host list.
29018
29019The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
29020remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
29021specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
29022specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
29023specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
29024the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
29025&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
29026
29027For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
29028test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
29029following SMTP commands are sent:
29030.display
29031&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
29032&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
29033&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
29034&`QUIT`&
29035.endd
29036LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
29037set to &"lmtp"&.
29038
29039.new
29040The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
29041settings.
29042.wen
29043
29044A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
29045for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
29046the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
29047that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
29048do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
29049&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
29050
29051If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
29052succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
29053Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
29054hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
29055&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
29056
29057.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29058A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
29059output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
29060clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
29061disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
29062
29063
29064
29065
29066.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
29067.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
29068The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
29069optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
29070.code
29071verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
29072.endd
29073The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
29074separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
29075deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
29076
29077
29078.vlist
29079.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
29080.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
29081This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
29082For example:
29083.code
29084verify = sender/callout=5s
29085.endd
29086The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
29087remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
29088the &%connect%& parameter.
29089
29090
29091.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29092.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
29093This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
29094for making the SMTP connection. For example:
29095.code
29096verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
29097.endd
29098If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
29099
29100.vitem &*defer_ok*&
29101.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
29102When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
29103of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
29104updated in this circumstance.
29105
29106.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
29107.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
29108This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
29109&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
29110accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
29111unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
29112
29113
29114.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29115.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
29116When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
29117verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
29118sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
29119whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
29120MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
29121as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
29122(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
29123address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
29124.code
29125require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
29126.endd
29127This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
29128
29129
29130.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29131.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
29132This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
29133For example:
29134.code
29135verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
29136.endd
29137This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
29138commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
29139be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
29140very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
29141(for example, when network connections are timing out).
29142
29143
29144.vitem &*no_cache*&
29145.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
29146.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
29147When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
29148
29149.vitem &*postmaster*&
29150.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
29151When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
29152check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
29153rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
29154the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
29155used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
29156made, until the cache record expires.
29157
29158.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29159The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
29160You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
29161For example:
29162.code
29163require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
29164.endd
29165If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
29166one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
29167.code
29168require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
29169.endd
29170&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
29171account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
29172a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
29173postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
29174
29175
29176.vitem &*random*&
29177.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
29178When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
29179check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
29180really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
29181&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
29182.code
29183$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
29184.endd
29185The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
29186parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
29187specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
29188a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
29189succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
29190
29191.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
29192.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
29193This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29194.code
29195deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
29196.endd
29197.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29198It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
29199performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
29200that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
29201domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
29202
29203.vitem &*use_sender*&
29204This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29205.code
29206require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
29207.endd
29208It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
29209command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
29210need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
29211sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
29212usefulness of callout caching.
29213.endlist
29214
29215If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
29216command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
29217&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
29218usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
29219that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
29220Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
29221these circumstances.
29222
29223However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
29224host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
29225callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
29226sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
29227callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
29228own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
29229is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
29230
29231Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
29232caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
29233by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
29234actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
29235
29236
29237
29238
29239.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
29240.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
29241.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
29242.cindex "caching" "callout"
29243Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
29244used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
29245option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
29246different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
29247a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
29248entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
29249
29250When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
29251the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
29252is not available.
29253
29254The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29255independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29256(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29257
29258If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29259commands up to and including
29260.code
29261MAIL FROM:<>
29262.endd
29263(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29264any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29265domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29266making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29267separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29268&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29269&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29270
29271Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29272cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29273Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29274ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29275will eventually be noticed.
29276
29277The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29278being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29279behaviour will be the same.
29280
29281
29282
29283.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29284.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29285See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29286verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29287failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29288relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29289you might see:
29290.code
29291MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29292250 OK
29293RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
29294550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
29295550-Called: 192.168.34.43
29296550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
29297550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
29298550 Sender verification failed
29299.endd
29300If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
29301only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
29302out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
29303&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
29304example:
29305.code
29306verify = sender/no_details
29307.endd
29308
29309.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
29310.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
29311.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
29312A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
29313during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
29314or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
29315it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
29316
29317.ilist
29318When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
29319continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
29320verification also fails.
29321.next
29322When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
29323verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
29324.endlist
29325
29326This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
29327way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
29328example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
29329.code
29330A.Wol: aw123
29331aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
29332.endd
29333work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
29334redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
29335mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
29336verification to succeed.
29337
29338It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
29339redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
29340generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
29341option. For example:
29342.code
29343require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
29344.endd
29345In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
29346the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
29347
29348When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
29349redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
29350also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
29351address and a report is output for each of them.
29352
29353
29354
29355.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
29356.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
29357Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
29358which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
29359special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
29360domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
29361Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
29362.code
29363verify = csa
29364.endd
29365This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
29366valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
29367succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
29368&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
29369&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
29370be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
29371
29372The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
29373detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
29374looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
29375address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
29376
29377.ilist
29378The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
29379.next
29380The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
29381.next
29382The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
29383(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
29384.next
29385The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
29386that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
29387.endlist
29388
29389The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
29390use for the DNS query. The default is:
29391.code
29392verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
29393.endd
29394This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
29395is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
29396address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
29397the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
29398meaningful to say:
29399.code
29400verify = csa/$sender_host_address
29401.endd
29402In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
29403This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
29404&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
29405
29406If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
29407is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
29408making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
29409using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
29410default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
29411default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
29412(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
29413of legitimate HELO domains.
29414
29415The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
29416direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
29417search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
29418addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
29419lookup such as:
29420.code
29421${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
29422.endd
29423has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
29424The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
29425authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
29426
29427
29428
29429
29430.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
29431.cindex "BATV, verifying"
29432Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
29433of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
29434Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
29435recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
29436bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
29437spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
29438
29439There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
29440&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
29441the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
29442address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
29443item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
29444The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
29445&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
29446
29447As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
29448database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
29449like this:
29450.code
29451PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
29452 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
29453 }{$value}}
29454.endd
29455Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
29456list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
29457use this:
29458.code
29459# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
29460deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
29461 senders = :
29462 recipients = +batv_senders
29463
29464# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
29465deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
29466 senders = :
29467 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
29468 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
29469 !condition = $prvscheck_result
29470.endd
29471The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
29472to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
29473send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
29474recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
29475the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
29476
29477A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
29478&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
29479prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
29480the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
29481the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
29482timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
29483of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
29484
29485There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
29486you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
29487deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
29488router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
29489.code
29490batv_redirect:
29491 driver = redirect
29492 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
29493.endd
29494This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
29495of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
29496address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
29497local addresses.
29498
29499To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
29500can be used:
29501.code
29502external_smtp_batv:
29503 driver = smtp
29504 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
29505 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
29506 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
29507 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
29508 {$value}fail}}}
29509.endd
29510If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
29511
29512
29513
29514.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
29515.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
29516.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
29517.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
29518An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
29519delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
29520within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
29521passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
29522.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
29523but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
29524
29525Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
29526A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
29527relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
29528a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
29529with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
29530same host is fulfilling both functions,
29531. ///
29532. as illustrated in the diagram below,
29533. ///
29534but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
29535not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
29536system to arbitrary domains.
29537
29538
29539You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
29540runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
29541Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
29542example, suppose you want to do the following:
29543
29544.ilist
29545Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
29546locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
29547&'my.dom2.example'&.
29548.next
29549Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
29550These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
29551.next
29552Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
29553Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
29554.endlist
29555
29556
29557In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
29558.code
29559domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
29560domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
29561hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
29562.endd
29563Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
29564command:
29565.code
29566acl_check_rcpt:
29567 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
29568 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
29569.endd
29570The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
29571the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
29572statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
29573hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
29574than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
29575default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
29576in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29577
29578
29579
29580.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
29581.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
29582You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
29583that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
29584the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29585
29586For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
29587&'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
29588host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
29589will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
29590patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
29591trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
29592results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
29593.ecindex IIDacl
29594
29595
29596
29597. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29598. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29599
29600.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
29601.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
29602The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
29603as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
29604was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
29605maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
29606specification.
29607
29608It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
29609&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
29610scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
29611messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
29612chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
29613
29614If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
29615Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
29616&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
29617
29618.ilist
29619Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
29620for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
29621.next
29622Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
29623&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
29624run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
29625.next
29626An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
29627of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
29628.next
29629Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
29630conditions.
29631.next
29632Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
29633.endlist
29634
29635There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
29636called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
29637condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
29638
29639Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
29640added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
29641changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
29642EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
29643this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
29644&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
29645
29646All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
29647temporarily created in a file called:
29648.display
29649<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29650.endd
29651The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29652expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29653first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29654scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29655removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29656.code
29657control = no_mbox_unspool
29658.endd
29659has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29660same directory by default.
29661
29662
29663
29664.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29665.cindex "virus scanning"
29666.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29667.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29668The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29669It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29670specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29671in memory and thus are much faster.
29672
29673
29674.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29675You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29676file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29677are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29678.display
29679&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29680.endd
29681If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29682.code
29683av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29684.endd
29685If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29686before use.
29687The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
29688The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29689
29690.vlist
29691.vitem &%aveserver%&
29692.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29693This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29694at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29695which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29696example:
29697.code
29698av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29699.endd
29700
29701
29702.vitem &%clamd%&
29703.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29704This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29705&url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29706unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29707in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29708required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29709number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29710.code
29711av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29712av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29713av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29714av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
29715.endd
29716If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29717keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29718to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29719more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29720Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29721There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29722you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29723
29724.new
29725The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
29726randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
29727that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
29728socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
29729unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
29730When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
29731not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
29732selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
29733email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
29734.code
297352013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
29736 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
29737 (Connection refused)
29738.endd
29739.wen
29740
29741If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29742contributing the code for this scanner.
29743
29744.vitem &%cmdline%&
29745.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29746This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29747used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29748type takes 3 mandatory options:
29749
29750.olist
29751The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29752and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29753
29754.next
29755A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29756virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29757absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29758the &"trigger"& expression.
29759
29760.next
29761Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29762match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29763&"name"& expression.
29764.endlist olist
29765
29766For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29767.code
29768Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29769.endd
29770For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29771name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29772for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29773configuration setting:
29774.code
29775av_scanner = cmdline:\
29776 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29777 found in file:'(.+)'
29778.endd
29779.vitem &%drweb%&
29780.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29781The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29782argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29783separated by white space, as in these examples:
29784.code
29785av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29786av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29787.endd
29788If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29789is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29790
29791.vitem &%fsecure%&
29792.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29793The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29794argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29795.code
29796av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29797.endd
29798If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29799Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29800
29801.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29802.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29803This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29804Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29805scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29806For example:
29807.code
29808av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29809.endd
29810The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29811
29812.vitem &%mksd%&
29813.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29814This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29815parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29816&url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29817the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29818provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29819been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29820.code
29821av_scanner = mksd:2
29822.endd
29823You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29824
29825.vitem &%sophie%&
29826.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29827Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29828You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29829for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29830client communication. For example:
29831.code
29832av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29833.endd
29834The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29835the option.
29836.endlist
29837
29838When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29839the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29840ACL.
29841
29842The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29843makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29844The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29845for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29846However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29847which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29848message.
29849
29850The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29851use. It can then be one of
29852
29853.ilist
29854&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29855The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29856recommended usage.
29857.next
29858&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29859the condition fails immediately.
29860.next
29861A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29862condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29863expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29864.endlist
29865
29866You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29867even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29868causes the ACL to defer.
29869
29870.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29871When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29872&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29873&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29874logging data.
29875
29876If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29877use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29878&%malware%& condition.
29879
29880Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29881imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29882
29883Here is a very simple scanning example:
29884.code
29885deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29886 demime = *
29887 malware = *
29888.endd
29889The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29890.code
29891deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29892 demime = *
29893 malware = */defer_ok
29894.endd
29895The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29896aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29897.code
29898av_scanner = $acl_m0
29899.endd
29900in the main Exim configuration.
29901.code
29902deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29903 set acl_m0 = sophie
29904 malware = *
29905
29906deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29907 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29908 malware = *
29909.endd
29910
29911
29912.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29913.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29914.cindex "spam scanning"
29915.cindex "SpamAssassin"
29916The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29917score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29918&url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29919installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29920.code
29921perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29922.endd
29923SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29924documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29925nicely, however.
29926
29927.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29928After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29929By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29930port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29931part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29932.code
29933spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29934.endd
29935You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29936&%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29937these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29938address/port pair:
29939.code
29940spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29941.endd
29942You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29943reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29944&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29945option, separated with colons:
29946.code
29947spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29948 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29949 192.168.2.12 783
29950.endd
29951Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29952fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29953servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29954condition defers.
29955
29956&*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29957multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29958
29959The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29960a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29961used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29962expansion.
29963
29964.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29965Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29966.code
29967deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29968 spam = joe
29969.endd
29970The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29971relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29972to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29973default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29974However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29975
29976The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29977principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29978have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29979&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29980read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29981are not set.
29982
29983The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29984you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29985&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29986
29987
29988Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29989large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29990are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29991example:
29992.code
29993deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29994 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29995 spam = nobody
29996.endd
29997
29998The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29999SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
30000&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
30001it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
30002
30003.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
30004When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
30005variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
30006available for use at delivery time.
30007
30008.vlist
30009.vitem &$spam_score$&
30010The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
30011for inclusion in log or reject messages.
30012
30013.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
30014The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
30015example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
30016because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
30017The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
30018
30019.vitem &$spam_bar$&
30020A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
30021integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
30022&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
30023headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
30024
30025.vitem &$spam_report$&
30026A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
30027message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
30028.endlist
30029
30030The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
30031spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
30032does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
30033
30034The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
30035the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
30036failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
30037statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
30038spam condition, like this:
30039.code
30040deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30041 spam = joe/defer_ok
30042.endd
30043This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
30044
30045Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
30046condition:
30047.code
30048# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
30049warn spam = nobody:true
30050 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
30051 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
30052
30053# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
30054# is over threshold
30055warn spam = nobody
30056 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
30057
30058# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
30059deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
30060 spam = nobody:true
30061 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
30062.endd
30063
30064
30065
30066.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
30067.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
30068.cindex "MIME content scanning"
30069.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
30070.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
30071The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
30072each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
30073of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
30074specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
30075options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
30076cases.
30077
30078These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
30079ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
30080the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
30081message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
30082ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
30083result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
30084&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
30085
30086You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
30087only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
30088condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
30089&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
30090&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
30091
30092At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
30093information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
30094of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
30095parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
30096part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
30097syntax is:
30098.display
30099&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
30100.endd
30101The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
30102the value can be:
30103
30104.olist
30105&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
30106.next
30107The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
30108&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
30109a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
30110full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
30111.next
30112A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
30113directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
30114is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
30115the full path and file name.
30116.next
30117If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
30118filename, and the default path is then used.
30119.endlist
30120The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
30121errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
30122a file with its original, proposed filename using
30123.code
30124decode = $mime_filename
30125.endd
30126However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
30127anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
30128automatically unlinked.
30129
30130For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
30131content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
30132as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
30133variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
30134before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
30135
30136The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
30137used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
30138respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
30139
30140.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
30141The following list describes all expansion variables that are
30142available in the MIME ACL:
30143
30144.vlist
30145.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
30146If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
30147have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
30148has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
30149contains the empty string.
30150
30151.vitem &$mime_charset$&
30152This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
30153&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
30154.code
30155us-ascii
30156gb2312 (Chinese)
30157iso-8859-1
30158.endd
30159Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
30160case-insensitively.
30161
30162.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
30163This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
30164header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
30165implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
30166only used for display purposes.
30167
30168.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
30169This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
30170header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
30171
30172.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
30173This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
30174This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
30175
30176.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
30177This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30178successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
30179size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
30180has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
30181
30182.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
30183This variable contains the normalized content of the
30184&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
30185type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
30186
30187.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
30188If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
30189value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
30190are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
30191.code
30192text/plain
30193text/html
30194application/octet-stream
30195image/jpeg
30196audio/midi
30197.endd
30198If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
30199empty string.
30200
30201.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
30202This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30203successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
30204containing the decoded data.
30205.endlist
30206
30207.cindex "RFC 2047"
30208.vlist
30209.vitem &$mime_filename$&
30210This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
30211proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
30212&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
30213RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
30214found, this variable contains the empty string.
30215
30216.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
30217This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
30218attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
30219content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
30220
30221The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
30222cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
30223follows:
30224
30225.olist
30226The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
30227
30228.next
30229If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
30230so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
30231
30232.next
30233If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
30234and the rest are attachments.
30235
30236.next
30237All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
30238.endlist olist
30239
30240As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
30241alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
30242coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
30243.code
30244deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
30245!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
30246condition = $mime_is_coverletter
30247condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
30248.endd
30249.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
30250This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
30251&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
30252Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
30253want to carry out specific actions on them.
30254
30255.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
30256This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
30257checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
30258decoding is fully recursive.
30259
30260.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
30261This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
30262starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
30263counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
30264&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
30265complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
30266parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
30267.endlist
30268
30269
30270
30271.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
30272.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
30273.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
30274You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
30275the message, or on individual MIME parts.
30276
30277The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
30278matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
30279MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
30280linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
30281have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
30282
30283The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
30284to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
30285part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
30286is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
30287and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3028832K characters are checked.
30289
30290The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
30291literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
30292expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
30293with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
30294Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
30295.code
30296deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
30297 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
30298.endd
30299The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
30300&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
30301matching regular expression.
30302
30303&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
30304CPU-intensive.
30305
30306
30307
30308
30309.section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
30310.cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
30311.cindex "MIME content scanning"
30312The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
30313extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
30314&%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
30315ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
30316condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
30317the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
30318use the &%demime%& condition.
30319
30320The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
30321errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
30322against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
30323parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
30324scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
30325antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
30326
30327On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
30328colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
30329example:
30330.code
30331deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
30332 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
30333.endd
30334If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
30335false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
30336full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
30337the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
30338
30339The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
30340conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
30341zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
30342
30343The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
30344
30345.vlist
30346.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
30347.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
30348When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
30349severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
30350severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
30351zero, no error occurred.
30352
30353.vitem &$demime_reason$&
30354.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
30355When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
30356human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
30357.endlist
30358
30359.vlist
30360.vitem &$found_extension$&
30361.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
30362When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
30363extension it found.
30364.endlist
30365
30366Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
30367the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
30368
30369If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
30370condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
30371right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
30372facility:
30373.code
30374# Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
30375deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
30376 demime = *
30377 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
30378
30379# Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
30380# Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
30381deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
30382 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
30383
30384# Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
30385# examine them and eventually thaw them.
30386deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
30387 demime = exe:doc
30388 control = freeze
30389.endd
30390.ecindex IIDcosca
30391
30392
30393
30394
30395. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30396. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30397
30398.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
30399 "Local scan function"
30400.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
30401.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
30402.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
30403In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
30404want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
30405
30406The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
30407passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
30408a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
30409condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
30410non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
30411
30412To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
30413possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
30414in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
30415can of course use a little C stub to call it.
30416
30417The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
30418when Exim is just about to accept the message.
30419It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
30420well as messages arriving via SMTP.
30421
30422Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
30423option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
30424Zero means &"no timeout"&.
30425Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
30426before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
30427are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
30428incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
30429For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
30430code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
30431
30432
30433
30434.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
30435.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
30436To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
30437function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
30438&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
30439directory, so you might set
30440.code
30441LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
30442.endd
30443for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
30444Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
30445be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
30446function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
30447commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
30448_src/local_scan.c_.
30449
30450If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
30451for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
30452.code
30453LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30454.endd
30455in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
30456
30457
30458
30459
30460.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
30461.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
30462You must include this line near the start of your code:
30463.code
30464#include "local_scan.h"
30465.endd
30466This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
30467prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
30468almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
30469for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
30470It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
30471strings and pointers to character strings:
30472.code
30473#define CS (char *)
30474#define CCS (const char *)
30475#define CSS (char **)
30476#define US (unsigned char *)
30477#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
30478#define USS (unsigned char **)
30479.endd
30480The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
30481.code
30482extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
30483.endd
30484The arguments are as follows:
30485
30486.ilist
30487&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
30488(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
30489recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
30490
30491The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
30492character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
30493id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
30494macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
30495case this changes in some future version.
30496.next
30497&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
30498string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
30499.endlist
30500
30501The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
30502
30503.vlist
30504.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
30505.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
30506The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
30507the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
30508newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
30509maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
30510
30511.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
30512This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30513queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
30514
30515.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
30516This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30517queued without immediate delivery.
30518
30519.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
30520The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
30521passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
30522they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
30523&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
30524used.
30525
30526.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
30527The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
30528message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
30529problem"& is used.
30530
30531.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30532This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
30533message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
30534&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
30535&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
30536&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
30537same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30538
30539.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30540This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
30541LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30542.endlist
30543
30544If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
30545reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
30546&%-oe%& command line options.
30547
30548
30549
30550.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
30551.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
30552It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
30553that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
30554want to do this, you must have the line
30555.code
30556LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30557.endd
30558in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
30559&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
30560file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
30561to define them.
30562
30563The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
30564&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
30565and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
30566alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
30567variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
30568entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
30569.code
30570static int my_integer_option = 42;
30571static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
30572
30573optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
30574 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
30575 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
30576};
30577
30578int local_scan_options_count =
30579 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
30580.endd
30581The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
30582configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
30583.code
30584begin local_scan
30585my_integer = 99
30586my_string = some string of text...
30587.endd
30588The available types of option data are as follows:
30589
30590.vlist
30591.vitem &*opt_bool*&
30592This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
30593variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
30594that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
30595whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
30596TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
30597values.)
30598
30599.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
30600This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
30601The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
30602multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
30603
30604.vitem &*opt_int*&
30605This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
30606&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
30607Exim.
30608
30609.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
30610This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
30611&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
30612printed with the suffix K or M.
30613
30614.vitem &*opt_octint*&
30615This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
30616octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
30617always output in octal.
30618
30619.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
30620This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
30621variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
30622
30623.vitem &*opt_time*&
30624This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
30625type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
30626.endlist
30627
30628If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
30629out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
30630
30631
30632
30633.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
30634.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
30635The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
30636are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
30637Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
30638including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
30639C variables are as follows:
30640
30641.vlist
30642.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
30643This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
30644
30645.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
30646This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
30647
30648.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
30649This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
30650is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
30651&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
30652
30653.ilist
30654The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
30655testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
30656other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
30657
30658.next
30659The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
30660by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
30661of debugging bits.
30662.endlist ilist
30663
30664Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
30665selected, you should use code like this:
30666.code
30667if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30668 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30669.endd
30670.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
30671After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30672variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30673
30674.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30675A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30676discussed below.
30677
30678.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30679A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30680
30681.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30682The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30683
30684.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30685This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30686&%-bh%& command line option.
30687
30688.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30689The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30690is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30691
30692.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30693The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30694command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30695specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30696
30697.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30698This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30699&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30700
30701.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30702The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30703
30704.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30705The number of accepted recipients.
30706
30707.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30708.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30709.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30710The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30711&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30712can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30713below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30714adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30715&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30716value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30717blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30718and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30719
30720.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30721The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30722
30723.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30724The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30725locally-submitted messages.
30726
30727.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30728The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30729was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30730
30731.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30732The name of the sending host, if known.
30733
30734.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30735The port on the sending host.
30736
30737.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30738This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30739
30740.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30741This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30742
30743.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30744The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30745requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30746.endlist
30747
30748
30749.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30750The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30751You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30752(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30753their type to *.
30754
30755
30756.vlist
30757.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30758A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30759
30760.vitem &*int&~type*&
30761A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30762characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30763Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30764with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30765rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30766lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30767
30768.vitem &*int&~slen*&
30769The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30770internal newlines.
30771
30772.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30773A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30774a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30775.endlist
30776
30777
30778
30779.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30780The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30781
30782.vlist
30783.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30784This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30785
30786.vitem &*int&~pno*&
30787This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30788the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30789and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30790
30791.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30792If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30793recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30794envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30795router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30796an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30797&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30798is NULL for all recipients.
30799.endlist
30800
30801
30802
30803.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30804.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30805The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30806These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30807release:
30808
30809.vlist
30810.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30811 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30812
30813This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30814&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30815be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30816for the process in &%newumask%&.
30817
30818Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30819and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30820standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30821descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30822argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30823
30824The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30825
30826.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30827This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30828seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30829return value is as follows:
30830
30831.ilist
30832>= 0
30833
30834The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30835ending status.
30836
30837.next
30838< 0 and > &--256
30839
30840The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30841signal number.
30842
30843.next
30844&--256
30845
30846The process timed out.
30847.next
30848&--257
30849
30850The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30851.endlist
30852
30853.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30854This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30855Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30856want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30857forks a subprocess that is running
30858.code
30859exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30860.endd
30861and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30862that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30863of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30864recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30865
30866When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30867finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30868fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30869addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30870
30871
30872.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30873 *sender_authentication)*&
30874This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30875that it runs is:
30876.display
30877&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30878.endd
30879The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30880
30881
30882.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30883This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30884output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30885calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30886conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30887.code
30888if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30889 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30890.endd
30891
30892.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30893This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30894expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30895The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30896expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30897the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30898block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30899&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30900
30901.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30902This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30903existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30904character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30905substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30906if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30907
30908.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30909 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30910This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30911chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30912
30913If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30914&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30915NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30916matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30917&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30918found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30919marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30920option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30921top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30922headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30923.code
30924header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30925 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30926.endd
30927Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30928there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30929
30930
30931.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30932This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30933occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30934particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30935match the specification, the function does nothing.
30936
30937
30938.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30939 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30940This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30941a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30942colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30943&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30944.code
30945if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30946.endd
30947.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30948.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30949This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30950The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30951back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30952zero-terminated.
30953
30954.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30955This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30956zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30957to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30958string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30959yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30960easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30961added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30962
30963.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30964This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30965matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30966.display
30967&`OK `& match succeeded
30968&`FAIL `& match failed
30969&`DEFER `& match deferred
30970.endd
30971DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30972inability to contact a database.
30973
30974.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30975 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30976This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30977controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30978&'lss_match_domain()'&.
30979
30980.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30981 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30982This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30983controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30984matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30985
30986.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30987 uschar&~*list)*&"
30988This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30989expected to be
30990.code
30991lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30992.endd
30993.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30994An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30995is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30996looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30997values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30998returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30999failed.
31000
31001.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
31002 *format,&~...)*&"
31003This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
31004is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
31005&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
31006them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
31007arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
31008contain any newlines, not even at the end.
31009
31010
31011.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
31012This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
31013is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
31014with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
31015
31016This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
31017described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
31018the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
31019value afterwards. For example:
31020.code
31021 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
31022 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
31023 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
31024.endd
31025
31026.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
31027This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
31028recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
31029matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
31030address.
31031.endlist
31032
31033
31034.cindex "RFC 2047"
31035.vlist
31036.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
31037 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
31038This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
31039these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
31040from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
31041a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
31042made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
31043binary string is returned with an error message.
31044
31045The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
31046maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
31047encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
31048
31049.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
31050.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
31051If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
31052contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
31053not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
31054
31055The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
31056&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
31057which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
31058
31059If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
31060argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
31061set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
31062returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
31063with translation.
31064
31065
31066.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
31067This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
31068below.
31069
31070.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31071The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
31072output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
31073stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
31074SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
31075is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
31076opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
31077test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
31078is involved.
31079
31080If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
31081output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
31082
31083Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
31084must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
31085LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
31086LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
31087initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
31088to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
31089that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
31090.code
31091smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
31092return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
31093.endd
31094Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
31095the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
31096&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
31097multiple output lines.
31098
31099The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
31100does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
31101the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
31102detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
31103you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
31104dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
31105arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
31106is an error.
31107
31108.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
31109This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
31110chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
31111runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31112
31113.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
31114This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
31115permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31116
31117.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
31118See below.
31119
31120.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
31121See below.
31122
31123.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
31124These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
31125The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
31126number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
31127and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
31128pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
31129more discussion.
31130.endlist
31131
31132
31133
31134.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
31135.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
31136No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
31137The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
31138recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
31139to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
31140message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
31141terminates.
31142
31143Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
31144data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
31145connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
31146one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
31147
31148If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
31149in the same SMTP connection, you should set
31150.code
31151store_pool = POOL_PERM
31152.endd
31153before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
31154restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
31155the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
31156set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
31157
31158The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
31159&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
31160There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
31161block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
31162&%store_pool%&.
31163.ecindex IIDlosca
31164
31165
31166
31167
31168. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31169. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31170
31171.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
31172.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
31173.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
31174.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
31175The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
31176that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
31177also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
31178they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
31179
31180The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
31181is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
31182It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
31183commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
31184The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
31185
31186The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
31187is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
31188the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
31189If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
31190of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
31191prevent it happening on retries.
31192
31193.vindex "&$domain$&"
31194.vindex "&$local_part$&"
31195&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
31196specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
31197&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
31198you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
31199independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
31200described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
31201
31202
31203.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
31204.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
31205.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
31206The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
31207setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
31208other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
31209&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
31210.code
31211system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
31212system_filter_user = exim
31213.endd
31214If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
31215&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
31216specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
31217&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
31218&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
31219by the &%reply%& command.
31220
31221
31222.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
31223You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
31224filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
31225are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
31226
31227If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
31228you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
31229
31230
31231
31232.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
31233The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
31234files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
31235mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
31236available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
31237If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
31238they cause errors.
31239
31240.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
31241There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
31242files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
31243is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
31244&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
31245subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
31246manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
31247
31248&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
31249specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
31250succeed, it will not be tried again.
31251If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
31252arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
31253
31254When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
31255&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
31256users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
31257to which users' filter files can refer.
31258
31259
31260
31261.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
31262.vindex "&$recipients$&"
31263The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
31264of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
31265filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
31266
31267
31268
31269.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
31270.cindex "freezing messages"
31271.cindex "message" "freezing"
31272.cindex "message" "forced failure"
31273.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
31274.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
31275.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
31276There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
31277always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
31278filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
31279for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
31280word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
31281.code
31282fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
31283.endd
31284The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
31285
31286The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
31287message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
31288and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
31289delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
31290that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
31291run.
31292
31293The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
31294not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
31295filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
31296is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
31297
31298.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
31299.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
31300The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
31301well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
31302up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
31303log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
31304two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
31305strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
31306message. For example:
31307.code
31308fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
31309 because it contains attachments that we are \
31310 not prepared to receive."
31311.endd
31312
31313.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
31314Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
31315the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
31316the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
31317command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
31318Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
31319use, for example
31320.code
31321if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
31322then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
31323.endd
31324though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
31325alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
31326generated by the filter.
31327
31328The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
31329&%defer%&,
31330&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
31331set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
31332as
31333.code
31334mail ...
31335freeze
31336.endd
31337to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
31338failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
31339take place.
31340
31341
31342
31343.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
31344.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
31345.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
31346.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
31347Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
31348.code
31349headers add <string>
31350headers remove <string>
31351.endd
31352The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
31353added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
31354filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
31355space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
31356forced to fail, the command has no effect.
31357
31358You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
31359continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
31360including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
31361example:
31362.code
31363headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
31364 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
31365 X-header-2: ...."
31366.endd
31367Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
31368be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
31369space after input continuations is ignored.
31370
31371The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
31372This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
31373those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
31374&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
31375header with the same name, they are all removed.
31376
31377The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
31378of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
31379from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
31380modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
31381Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
31382used for all recipients of the message.
31383
31384During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
31385header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
31386that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
31387routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
31388routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
31389until the message is actually being written (see section
31390&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
31391
31392If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
31393added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
31394present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
31395present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
31396message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
31397conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
31398modified more than once.
31399
31400Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
31401use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
31402For example:
31403.code
31404headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
31405headers remove "Subject"
31406headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
31407headers remove "Old-Subject"
31408.endd
31409
31410
31411
31412.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
31413.cindex "envelope sender"
31414In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
31415.code
31416errors_to <some address>
31417.endd
31418in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
31419delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
31420user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
31421might use
31422.code
31423unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
31424.endd
31425to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
31426address if its delivery failed.
31427
31428
31429
31430.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
31431.vindex "&$domain$&"
31432.vindex "&$local_part$&"
31433In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
31434delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
31435operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
31436such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
31437filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
31438which implements such a filter:
31439.code
31440central_filter:
31441 check_local_user
31442 driver = redirect
31443 domains = +local_domains
31444 file = /central/filters/$local_part
31445 no_verify
31446 allow_filter
31447 allow_freeze
31448.endd
31449The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
31450&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
31451the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
31452use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
31453
31454Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
31455specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
31456its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
31457address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
31458normal way.
31459.ecindex IIDsysfil1
31460.ecindex IIDsysfil2
31461.ecindex IIDsysfil3
31462
31463
31464
31465
31466
31467
31468. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31469. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31470
31471.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
31472.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
31473Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
31474all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
31475these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
31476this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
31477removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
31478before it is placed on Exim's queue.
31479
31480Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
31481&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
31482that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
31483its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
31484set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
31485
31486&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
31487or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
31488loopback interface specially in any way.
31489
31490If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
31491that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
31492
31493
31494
31495
31496.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
31497.cindex "message" "submission"
31498.cindex "submission mode"
31499Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
31500&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
31501received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
31502state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
31503.code
31504control = submission
31505.endd
31506in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
31507&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
31508a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
31509known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
31510example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
31511interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
31512.code
31513warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
31514 control = submission
31515.endd
31516.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
31517There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
31518is used to separate options. For example:
31519.code
31520control = submission/sender_retain
31521.endd
31522Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
31523true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
31524of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
31525the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
31526authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
31527&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
31528attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
31529
31530When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
31531domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
31532example:
31533.code
31534control = submission/domain=some.domain
31535.endd
31536The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
31537&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
31538that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
31539&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
31540.code
31541accept authenticated = *
31542 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
31543 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
31544 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
31545.endd
31546Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
31547option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
31548the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
31549.code
31550bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
31551.endd
31552then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
31553line would be:
31554.code
31555Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
31556.endd
31557.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
31558By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
31559used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
31560specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
31561
31562&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
31563ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
31564untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
31565specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
31566does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
31567spoof another's address.
31568
31569.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
31570.cindex "line endings"
31571.cindex "carriage return"
31572.cindex "linefeed"
31573RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
31574linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
31575SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
31576conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
31577use CRLF or just CR.
31578
31579Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
31580using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
31581receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
31582Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
31583MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
31584has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
31585that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
31586other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
31587follows:
31588
31589.ilist
31590LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
31591.next
31592CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
31593is ignored.
31594.next
31595The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
31596nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
31597terminator.
31598.next
31599If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
31600the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
31601is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
31602people trying to play silly games.
31603.next
31604If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
31605bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
31606line.
31607.endlist
31608
31609
31610
31611
31612
31613.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
31614.cindex "unqualified addresses"
31615.cindex "address" "qualification"
31616By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
31617host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
31618SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
31619messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
31620requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
31621
31622Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
31623sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
31624&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
31625cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
31626value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
31627
31628.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
31629.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
31630Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
31631that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
31632line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
31633are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
31634other words, such qualification is also controlled by
31635&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
31636
31637
31638
31639
31640.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
31641.cindex "&""From""& line"
31642.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
31643.cindex "sender" "address"
31644.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
31645.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
31646.cindex "envelope sender"
31647.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31648Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
31649with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
31650&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
31651.code
31652From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
31653From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
31654.endd
31655This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
31656Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
31657via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
31658such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
31659&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
31660and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
31661regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
31662default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
31663that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
31664
31665.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
31666When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
31667a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
31668contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
31669then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
31670qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
31671the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31672
31673If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31674sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31675that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31676
31677Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31678treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31679as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31680incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31681
31682
31683
31684.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31685.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31686RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31687&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31688recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31689&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31690&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31691
31692.blockquote
31693&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31694processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31695.endblockquote
31696
31697This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31698address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31699follows:
31700
31701.ilist
31702A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31703is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31704.next
31705If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31706&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31707&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31708.next
31709For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31710also removed.
31711.next
31712For a locally-submitted message,
31713if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31714&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31715the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31716included in log lines in this case.
31717.next
31718The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31719&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31720.endlist
31721
31722
31723
31724
31725.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31726Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31727includes the header line:
31728.code
31729Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31730.endd
31731
31732.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31733.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31734If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31735message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31736extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31737existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31738
31739
31740.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31741.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31742If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31743Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31744&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31745
31746.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31747.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31748.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31749&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31750set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31751the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31752in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31753set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31754messages.
31755
31756
31757.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31758.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31759.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31760&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31761Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31762generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31763messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31764(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31765messages.
31766
31767
31768.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31769.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31770.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31771.cindex "message" "submission"
31772.cindex "submission mode"
31773If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31774adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31775
31776.ilist
31777The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31778message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31779.next
31780.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31781The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31782.olist
31783.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31784If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31785&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31786.next
31787If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31788part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31789.next
31790If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31791&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31792.endlist
31793.endlist
31794
31795A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31796
31797If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31798line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31799containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31800are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31801They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31802&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31803&%qualify_domain%&.
31804
31805For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31806&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31807user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31808name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31809
31810
31811.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31812.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31813.cindex "message" "submission"
31814.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31815If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31816&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31817&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31818to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31819creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31820message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31821followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31822in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31823&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31824
31825
31826.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31827.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31828A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31829contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31830Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31831
31832The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31833have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31834line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31835that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31836
31837Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31838changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31839-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31840
31841
31842.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31843.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31844Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31845header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31846section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31847header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31848responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31849processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31850than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31851incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3185211 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31853
31854
31855
31856.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31857.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31858.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31859&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31860it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31861transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31862transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31863default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31864
31865
31866
31867.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31868.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31869.cindex "message" "submission"
31870For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31871existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31872these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31873&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31874control setting.
31875
31876When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31877&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31878control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31879&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31880that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31881&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31882be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31883appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31884line is added to the message.
31885
31886If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31887the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31888&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31889options true at the same time.
31890
31891.cindex "submission mode"
31892By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31893received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31894a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31895not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31896
31897.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31898First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31899authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31900created as follows:
31901
31902.ilist
31903.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31904If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31905&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31906.next
31907If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31908is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31909.next
31910If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31911&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31912.endlist
31913
31914This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31915are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31916added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31917by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31918
31919.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31920&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31921the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31922except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31923
31924
31925
31926.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31927 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31928.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31929.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31930When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31931specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31932process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31933modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31934as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31935
31936In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31937specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31938addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31939changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31940transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31941they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31942
31943&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31944the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31945expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31946
31947For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31948option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31949newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31950.code
31951headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31952 X-added-second: another added header line
31953.endd
31954Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31955
31956.new
31957Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
31958specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating newline
31959added) before expansion.
31960.wen
31961
31962The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31963list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31964often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31965not part of the names. For example:
31966.code
31967headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31968.endd
31969
31970Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
31971specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating colon
31972added) before expansion.
31973
31974When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31975is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31976accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31977an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31978forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31979
31980.oindex "&%unseen%&"
31981However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31982the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31983&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31984
31985Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31986settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31987dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31988requirements.
31989
31990The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31991with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31992these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31993recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31994consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31995names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31996instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31997
31998After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31999lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
32000the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
32001header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
32002
32003This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
32004the following consequences:
32005
32006.ilist
32007The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
32008remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
32009to it, at all times.
32010.next
32011Header lines that are added by a router's
32012&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
32013expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
32014.next
32015Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
32016in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
32017.next
32018Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
32019a later router or by a transport.
32020.next
32021An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
32022removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
32023.code
32024headers_remove = subject
32025headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
32026.endd
32027.endlist
32028
32029&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
32030for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
32031
32032
32033
32034
32035
32036.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
32037.cindex "address" "constructed"
32038.cindex "constructed address"
32039When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
32040the form
32041.display
32042<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
32043.endd
32044For example:
32045.code
32046Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
32047.endd
32048The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
32049otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
32050&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
32051ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
32052upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
32053&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
32054The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
32055there is no password file entry.
32056
32057.cindex "RFC 2047"
32058In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
32059parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
32060characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
32061including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
32062&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
32063characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
32064&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
32065is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
32066
32067
32068
32069.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
32070.cindex "case of local parts"
32071.cindex "local part" "case of"
32072RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
32073be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
32074addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
32075because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
32076routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
32077original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
32078router option.
32079
32080.cindex "mixed-case login names"
32081If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
32082assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
32083your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
32084correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
32085.code
32086correct_case:
32087 driver = redirect
32088 domains = +local_domains
32089 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
32090 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
32091 @$domain
32092.endd
32093For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
32094(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
32095up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
32096on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
32097local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
32098
32099
32100
32101.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
32102.cindex "dot" "in local part"
32103.cindex "local part" "dots in"
32104RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
32105part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
32106middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
32107empty components for compatibility.
32108
32109
32110
32111.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
32112.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
32113Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
32114happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
32115in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
32116&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
32117
32118Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
32119in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
32120routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
32121example, a header such as
32122.code
32123To: hare@teaparty
32124.endd
32125might get rewritten as
32126.code
32127To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
32128.endd
32129Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
32130does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
32131been routed.
32132
32133Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
32134addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
32135result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
32136deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
32137immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
32138routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
32139.ecindex IIDmesproc
32140
32141
32142
32143. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32144. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32145
32146.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
32147.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
32148.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
32149Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
32150LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
32151closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
32152processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
32153
32154.ilist
32155SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
32156.next
32157SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
32158.next
32159Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
32160.endlist
32161
32162For mail delivery, the following are available:
32163
32164.ilist
32165SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
32166.next
32167LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
32168&"lmtp"&);
32169.next
32170LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
32171transport);
32172.next
32173Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
32174the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
32175.endlist
32176
32177&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
32178stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
32179used to contain the envelope information.
32180
32181
32182
32183.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
32184.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
32185.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
32186.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
32187.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
32188.cindex "EHLO"
32189.cindex "HELO"
32190.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32191Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
32192The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
32193processing is the same in both cases.
32194
32195If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
32196parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
32197command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
32198&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
32199such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
32200.cindex "transport" "filter"
32201.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
32202transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
32203suppressed.
32204
32205If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
32206pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
32207required for the transaction.
32208
32209If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
32210was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
32211server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
32212Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
32213is called for verification.
32214
32215If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
32216the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
32217in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
32218
32219.cindex "carriage return"
32220.cindex "linefeed"
32221Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32222LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
32223order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32224line terminator.
32225
32226If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
32227characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
32228same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
32229even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
32230of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
32231they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
32232each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
32233in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
32234significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
32235
32236When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
32237message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
32238records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
32239particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
32240
32241.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
32242Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
32243a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
32244See the next section for more detail about error handling.
32245
32246.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32247.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
32248When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
32249looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
32250messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
32251creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
32252a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
32253so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
32254does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
32255turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
32256
32257The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
32258limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
32259
32260.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32261The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
32262identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
32263square bracket of the IP address.
32264
32265
32266
32267
32268.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
32269.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
32270.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
32271.cindex "host" "error"
32272Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
32273message errors, and recipient errors.
32274
32275.vlist
32276.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
32277A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
32278particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
32279
32280.ilist
32281Connection refused or timed out,
32282.next
32283Any error response code on connection,
32284.next
32285Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
32286.next
32287Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
32288.next
32289I/O errors at any time,
32290.next
32291Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
32292the &"."& at the end of the data.
32293.endlist ilist
32294
32295For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
32296EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
32297error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
32298host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
32299the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
32300alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
32301host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
32302made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
32303
32304.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
32305.cindex "message" "error"
32306A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
32307particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
32308message errors are:
32309
32310.ilist
32311Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
32312the data,
32313.next
32314Timeout after MAIL,
32315.next
32316Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
32317timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
32318connection at any other time.
32319.endlist ilist
32320
32321For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
32322to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
32323temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
32324addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
32325a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
32326message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
32327that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
32328time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
32329affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
32330it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
32331
32332If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
32333to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
32334over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
32335response to MAIL.
32336
32337.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
32338.cindex "recipient" "error"
32339A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
32340recipient errors are:
32341
32342.ilist
32343Any error response to RCPT,
32344.next
32345Timeout after RCPT.
32346.endlist
32347
32348For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
32349recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
32350sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
32351address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
32352used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
32353routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
32354operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
32355to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
32356if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
32357(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
32358have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
32359the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
32360the retry clock is reset.
32361
32362The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
32363host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
32364other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
32365in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
32366proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
32367than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
32368if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
32369through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
32370recipient's retry time.
32371.endlist
32372
32373In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
32374current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
32375tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
32376own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
32377until the next delivery attempt.
32378
32379Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
32380MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
32381would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
32382host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
32383What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
32384is created.
32385
32386The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
32387these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
32388procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
32389response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
32390it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
32391message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
32392helpful to treat this case as a message error.
32393
32394Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
32395host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
32396or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
32397the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
32398then to be treated as a host error.
32399
32400There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
32401terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
32402reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
32403should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
32404host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
32405
32406
32407
32408
32409.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
32410.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
32411.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
32412.cindex "inetd"
32413.cindex "daemon"
32414Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
32415listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
32416&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
32417.code
32418smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
32419.endd
32420Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
32421agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
32422a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
32423the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
32424with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
32425stream and exits with an error code.
32426
32427By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
32428disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
32429unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
32430&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
32431
32432.cindex "carriage return"
32433.cindex "linefeed"
32434Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32435LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
32436order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32437line terminator.
32438Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
32439sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
32440sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
32441
32442.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
32443.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
32444One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
32445HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
32446commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
32447the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
32448Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
32449match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
32450
32451.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32452.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
32453The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
32454a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
32455&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
32456false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
32457&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
32458value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
32459message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
32460
32461When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
32462its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
32463logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
32464
32465The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
32466prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
32467number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
32468&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
32469rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
32470
32471The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
32472subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
32473for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
32474things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
32475processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
32476sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
32477it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
32478
32479When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
32480and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
32481high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
32482&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
32483applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
32484
32485Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
32486can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
32487&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
32488number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
32489SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
32490&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
32491subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
32492a delivery process.
32493
32494The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
32495&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
32496started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
32497handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
32498however, available with &'inetd'&.
32499
32500Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
32501are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
32502to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
32503section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
32504
32505Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
32506MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
32507&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
32508
32509
32510
32511.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
32512.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
32513If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
32514commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
32515the error response to the last command. The default value for
32516&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
32517abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
32518circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
32519
32520
32521.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
32522.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
32523.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
32524A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
32525something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
32526address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
32527sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
32528&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
32529drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
32530default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
32531broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
32532
32533
32534
32535.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
32536.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
32537The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
32538DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
32539many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
32540denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
32541client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
32542defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
32543
32544When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
32545allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
32546but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
32547or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
32548starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
32549counted.
32550
32551The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
32552STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
32553RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
32554
32555You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
32556&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
32557&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
32558the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
32559specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
32560
32561
32562
32563
32564.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
32565When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
32566runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
32567appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
32568If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32569
32570.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
32571When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
32572called with the &%-bv%& option.
32573
32574.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
32575When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
32576EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
32577than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
32578as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
32579of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
32580VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
32581RCPT failures.
32582
32583
32584
32585.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
32586.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
32587RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
32588overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
32589disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
32590the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
32591should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32592
32593The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
32594delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
32595the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
32596text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
32597specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
32598the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
32599argument. For example,
32600.code
32601ETRN #brigadoon
32602.endd
32603runs the command
32604.code
32605exim -R brigadoon
32606.endd
32607which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
32608containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
32609default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
32610for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
32611a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
32612
32613.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
32614Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
32615record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
32616the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
32617the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
32618a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
32619left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
32620Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
32621
32622.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
32623For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
32624used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
32625whatever the form of its argument. For
32626example:
32627.code
32628smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
32629 $sender_host_address
32630.endd
32631.vindex "&$domain$&"
32632The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
32633expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
32634and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
32635wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
32636under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
32637for it to change them before running the command.
32638
32639
32640
32641.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
32642.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
32643Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
32644standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
32645line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
32646&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
32647messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
32648sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
32649an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
32650identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
32651runs for RCPT commands:
32652.code
32653accept hosts = :
32654.endd
32655This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
32656
32657
32658
32659.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
32660.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
32661.cindex "batched SMTP output"
32662Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
32663batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
32664be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
32665delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
32666envelope along with the message.
32667
32668The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
32669MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
32670the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
32671HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
32672can be used to specify it.
32673
32674Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
32675one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
32676to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
32677this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
32678chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
32679
32680.vindex "&$host$&"
32681When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
32682sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
32683transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32684router:
32685.code
32686begin routers
32687route_append:
32688 driver = manualroute
32689 transport = smtp_appendfile
32690 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32691
32692begin transports
32693smtp_appendfile:
32694 driver = appendfile
32695 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32696 batch_max = 1000
32697 use_bsmtp
32698 user = exim
32699.endd
32700This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32701format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32702message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32703
32704
32705
32706.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32707.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32708.cindex "batched SMTP input"
32709The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32710reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32711is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32712sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32713rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32714and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32715as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32716
32717Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32718ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32719
32720If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32721the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32722standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32723make some use of automatically, for example:
32724.code
32725554 Unexpected end of file
32726Transaction started in line 10
32727Error detected in line 14
32728.endd
32729It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32730file, for example:
32731.code
32732An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32733The error message was:
32734
32735501 '>' missing at end of address
32736
32737The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32738The error was detected in line 12.
32739The SMTP command at fault was:
32740
32741rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32742
327431 previous message was successfully processed.
32744The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32745.endd
32746The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32747messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32748accepted.
32749.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32750.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32751
32752
32753
32754. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32755. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32756
32757.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32758 "Customizing messages"
32759When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32760configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32761to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32762the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32763string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32764
32765The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32766cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32767option. Exim also adds the line
32768.code
32769Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32770.endd
32771to all warning and bounce messages,
32772
32773
32774.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32775.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32776.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32777If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32778message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32779delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32780&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32781
32782When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32783constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32784separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32785opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32786logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32787item.
32788
32789.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32790.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32791Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32792expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32793the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32794&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32795option, rounded to a whole number.
32796
32797The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32798
32799.ilist
32800The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32801&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32802.next
32803The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32804failing addresses with their error messages.
32805.next
32806The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32807returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32808.next
32809The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32810as part of the error report.
32811.next
32812The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32813truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32814.next
32815The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32816.endlist
32817
32818The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32819following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32820other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32821.code
32822Subject: Mail delivery failed
32823 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32824 {: returning message to sender}}
32825****
32826This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32827
32828A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32829 {that you sent }{sent by
32830
32831<$sender_address>
32832
32833}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32834This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32835****
32836The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32837****
32838------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32839 ------
32840****
32841------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32842 only the first
32843------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32844****
32845.endd
32846.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32847.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32848.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32849The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32850warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32851text sections:
32852
32853.ilist
32854The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32855&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32856.next
32857The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32858the delayed addresses.
32859.next
32860The third item then ends the message.
32861.endlist
32862
32863The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32864have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32865.code
32866Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32867 $warn_message_delay
32868****
32869This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32870
32871A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32872{that you sent }{sent by
32873
32874<$sender_address>
32875
32876}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32877more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32878
32879The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32880The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32881The date of the message is: $h_date
32882
32883The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32884****
32885No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32886continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32887intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32888mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32889the message will be returned to you.
32890.endd
32891.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32892.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32893However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32894appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32895&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32896minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32897of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32898multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32899handled them.
32900
32901
32902
32903
32904. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32905. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32906
32907.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32908This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32909common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32910
32911
32912
32913.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32914.cindex "smart host" "example router"
32915If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32916should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32917routing explicitly:
32918.code
32919send_to_smart_host:
32920 driver = manualroute
32921 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32922 transport = remote_smtp
32923.endd
32924You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32925If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32926receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32927synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32928&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32929
32930
32931
32932
32933.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32934.cindex "mailing lists"
32935Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32936requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32937Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32938
32939The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32940is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32941independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32942lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32943.code
32944lists:
32945 driver = redirect
32946 domains = lists.example
32947 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32948 forbid_pipe
32949 forbid_file
32950 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32951 no_more
32952.endd
32953This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32954in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32955such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32956routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32957
32958The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32959expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32960a mailing list.
32961
32962.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32963The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32964taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32965original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32966the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32967
32968For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32969&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32970&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32971&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32972There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32973the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32974such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32975or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32976&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32977
32978
32979
32980.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32981.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32982If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32983delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32984list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32985list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32986addresses are not rigorously checked.
32987
32988If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32989entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32990&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32991whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32992&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32993
32994
32995
32996.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32997.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32998Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32999in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
33000recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
33001cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
33002delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
33003account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
33004the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
33005message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
33006
33007If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
33008on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
33009router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
33010&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
33011&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
33012subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
33013failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
33014pre-existing messages.
33015
33016The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
33017addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
33018addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
33019&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
33020one level of expansion anyway.
33021
33022
33023
33024.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
33025.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
33026The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
33027send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
33028from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
33029&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
33030
33031The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
33032of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
33033.code
33034lists_request:
33035 driver = redirect
33036 domains = lists.example
33037 local_part_suffix = -request
33038 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
33039 no_more
33040
33041lists_post:
33042 driver = redirect
33043 domains = lists.example
33044 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
33045 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
33046 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33047 forbid_pipe
33048 forbid_file
33049 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33050 no_more
33051
33052lists_closed:
33053 driver = redirect
33054 domains = lists.example
33055 allow_fail
33056 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
33057.endd
33058All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
33059they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
33060&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
33061mailing list.
33062
33063The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
33064checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
33065checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
33066necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
33067because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
33068not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
33069means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
33070&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
33071&"unrouteable address"& error.
33072
33073The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
33074a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
33075the address, giving a suitable error message.
33076
33077
33078
33079
33080.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
33081.cindex "VERP"
33082.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
33083.cindex "envelope sender"
33084Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
33085are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
33086address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
33087the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
33088if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
33089original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
33090
33091.oindex &%errors_to%&
33092.oindex &%return_path%&
33093Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
33094facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
33095list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
33096these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
33097host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
33098of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
33099of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
33100.code
33101verp_smtp:
33102 driver = smtp
33103 max_rcpt = 1
33104 return_path = \
33105 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33106 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33107.endd
33108This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
33109SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
33110&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
33111local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
33112example, that a message whose return path has been set to
33113&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
33114&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
33115rewritten as
33116.code
33117somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
33118.endd
33119.vindex "&$local_part$&"
33120For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
33121have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
33122achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
33123might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
33124&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
33125
33126Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
33127probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
33128extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
33129can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
33130.code
33131dnslookup:
33132 driver = dnslookup
33133 domains = ! +local_domains
33134 transport = \
33135 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33136 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
33137 no_more
33138.endd
33139If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
33140of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
33141routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
33142errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
33143address.
33144
33145On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
33146&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
33147SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
33148and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
33149of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
33150.code
33151verp_dnslookup:
33152 driver = dnslookup
33153 domains = ! +local_domains
33154 transport = remote_smtp
33155 errors_to = \
33156 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
33157 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33158 no_more
33159.endd
33160Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
33161configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
33162Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
33163router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
33164them.
33165
33166The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
33167message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
33168host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
33169a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
33170a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
33171than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
33172used).
33173
33174
33175
33176
33177
33178
33179.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
33180.cindex "virtual domains"
33181.cindex "domain" "virtual"
33182The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
33183meanings:
33184
33185.ilist
33186A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
33187aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
33188top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
33189.next
33190One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
33191with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
33192have login accounts on that host.
33193.endlist
33194
33195The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
33196the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
33197aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
33198virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
33199whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
33200to a router of this form:
33201.code
33202virtual:
33203 driver = redirect
33204 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
33205 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
33206 no_more
33207.endd
33208The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
33209is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
33210domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
33211part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
33212setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
33213string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
33214
33215This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
33216follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
33217can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
33218a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
33219
33220The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
33221way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
33222valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
33223.code
33224my_domains:
33225 driver = accept
33226 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
33227 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
33228 transport = my_mailboxes
33229.endd
33230The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
33231can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
33232file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
33233option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
33234because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
33235follows:
33236.code
33237my_mailboxes:
33238 driver = appendfile
33239 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
33240 user = mail
33241.endd
33242This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
33243required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
33244
33245The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
33246requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
33247up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
33248information about the domains.
33249
33250
33251
33252.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
33253.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
33254.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
33255.cindex "local part" "prefix"
33256.cindex "local part" "suffix"
33257Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
33258incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
33259allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
33260identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
33261parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
33262&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
33263example, consider this router:
33264.code
33265userforward:
33266 driver = redirect
33267 check_local_user
33268 file = $home/.forward
33269 local_part_suffix = -*
33270 local_part_suffix_optional
33271 allow_filter
33272.endd
33273.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
33274It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
33275&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
33276cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
33277.code
33278if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
33279save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
33280endif
33281.endd
33282If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
33283fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
33284&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
33285control over which suffixes are valid.
33286
33287Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
33288&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
33289another MTA:
33290.code
33291userforward:
33292 driver = redirect
33293 check_local_user
33294 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
33295 local_part_suffix = -*
33296 local_part_suffix_optional
33297 allow_filter
33298.endd
33299If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
33300example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
33301does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
33302subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
33303&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
33304
33305
33306
33307.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
33308.cindex "vacation processing"
33309The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
33310a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
33311(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
33312This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
33313that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
33314
33315.ilist
33316A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
33317can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
33318alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
33319&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
33320.code
33321spqr, vacation-spqr
33322.endd
33323.next
33324The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
33325vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
33326user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
33327ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
33328to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
33329message.
33330.endlist
33331
33332Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
33333use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
33334
33335
33336
33337.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
33338.cindex "message" "copying every"
33339Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
33340be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
33341command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
33342each day's messages.
33343
33344There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
33345messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
33346delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
33347notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
33348
33349
33350
33351.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
33352.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
33353It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
33354Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
33355arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
33356permanently connected.
33357
33358Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
33359particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
33360Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
33361
33362
33363.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
33364It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
33365host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
33366approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
33367being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
33368some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
33369to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
33370resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
33371
33372A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
33373intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
33374into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
33375format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
33376destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
33377in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
33378if required.
33379
33380On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
33381you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
33382intermittent host. For example:
33383.code
33384cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
33385.endd
33386This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
33387which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
33388online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
33389options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
33390causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
33391connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
33392immediately.
33393
33394If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
33395issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
33396mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
33397used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
33398avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
33399Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
33400arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
33401
33402
33403
33404.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
33405The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
33406increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
33407connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
33408delivered immediately.
33409
33410.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33411.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
33412.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
33413Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
33414not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
33415possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
33416each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
33417avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
33418&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
33419first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
33420normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
33421destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
33422single SMTP connection.
33423
33424
33425
33426. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33427. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33428
33429.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
33430 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
33431.cindex "client, non-queueing"
33432.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
33433On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
33434email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
33435configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
33436However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
33437configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
33438&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
33439messages this way.
33440
33441If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
33442run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
33443any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
33444continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
33445email is not desirable.
33446
33447There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
33448&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
33449any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
33450host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
33451informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
33452to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
33453to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
33454
33455There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
33456that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
33457ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
33458before sending a message to the smart host.
33459
33460Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
33461tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
33462overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
33463
33464.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
33465There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
33466Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
33467assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
33468just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
33469compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
33470router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
33471
33472When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
33473following ways:
33474
33475.ilist
33476A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
33477In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
33478.next
33479Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
33480assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
33481&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
33482does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
33483successful, a zero return code is given.
33484.next
33485Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
33486be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
33487the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
33488must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
33489deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
33490are.
33491.next
33492If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
33493failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
33494successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
33495.next
33496Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
33497is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
33498smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
33499the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
33500there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
33501.next
33502If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
33503connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
33504failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
33505.next
33506When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
33507(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
33508value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
33509are ever generated.
33510.next
33511No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
33512.next
33513A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
33514true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
33515&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
33516.endlist
33517
33518The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
33519the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
33520deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
33521privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
33522to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
33523the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
33524
33525
33526
33527
33528. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33529. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33530
33531.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
33532.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
33533.cindex "log" "types of"
33534Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
33535and the panic log:
33536
33537.ilist
33538.cindex "main log"
33539The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
33540line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
33541down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
33542out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
33543them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
33544they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
33545analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
33546&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
33547.next
33548.cindex "reject log"
33549The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
33550of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
33551The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
33552the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
33553is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
33554lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
33555reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
33556host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
33557can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
33558false.
33559.next
33560.cindex "panic log"
33561.cindex "system log"
33562When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
33563error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
33564are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
33565other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
33566therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
33567regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
33568panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
33569is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
33570message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
33571.endlist
33572
33573Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
33574example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
33575In the log file, this would be all on one line:
33576.code
335772001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
33578 by QUIT
33579.endd
33580By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
33581ways of changing this:
33582
33583.ilist
33584You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
33585you set
33586.code
33587timezone = UTC
33588.endd
33589the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
33590.next
33591If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
33592example:
33593.code
335942003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
33595.endd
33596.endlist
33597
33598.cindex "log" "process ids in"
33599.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33600Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
33601request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
33602&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
33603brackets, immediately after the time and date.
33604
33605
33606
33607
33608.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
33609.cindex "log" "destination"
33610.cindex "log" "to file"
33611.cindex "log" "to syslog"
33612.cindex "syslog"
33613The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
33614should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
33615are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
33616arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
33617It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
33618need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
33619Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
33620
33621The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
33622&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
33623configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
33624references to the host name:
33625.code
33626log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
33627.endd
33628It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
33629rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
33630start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
33631before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
33632configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
33633log at all.
33634
33635The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
33636list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
33637facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
33638colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
33639otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
33640point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
33641implying the use of a default path.
33642
33643When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
33644LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
33645&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
33646mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
33647files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
33648equivalent to the setting:
33649.code
33650log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
33651.endd
33652If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
33653logs are written.
33654
33655A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
33656are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
33657
33658Here are some examples of possible settings:
33659.display
33660&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
33661&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
33662&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
33663&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
33664.endd
33665If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
33666error is logged.
33667
33668
33669
33670.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
33671.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33672.cindex "cycling logs"
33673.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33674.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
33675Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
33676log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
33677provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
33678main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
33679keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
33680
33681An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
33682and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
33683example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
33684message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33685that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33686something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33687ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33688&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33689does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33690tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33691for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33692renamed.
33693
33694
33695
33696.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33697.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33698Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33699periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33700for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33701&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33702the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33703point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33704.code
33705log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33706log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33707log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33708log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33709.endd
33710As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33711examples of names generated by the above examples:
33712.code
33713/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33714/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33715/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33716/var/log/exim/main.200212
33717.endd
33718When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33719files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33720will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33721run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33722
33723The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33724is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33725When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33726the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33727non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33728character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33729log names:
33730.code
33731/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33732/var/log/exim-panic.log
33733/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33734/var/log/exim/panic
33735.endd
33736
33737
33738.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33739.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33740The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33741except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33742Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33743that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33744&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33745by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33746&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33747SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33748&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33749LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33750the time and host name to each line.
33751The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33752
33753.ilist
33754&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33755.next
33756&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33757.next
33758&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33759.endlist
33760
33761Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33762written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33763these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33764by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33765
33766Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33767entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33768these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33769calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33770870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33771additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33772replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33773RFC 3164, you should set
33774.code
33775SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33776.endd
33777in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33778lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33779
33780To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33781entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33782where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33783components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33784because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33785delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33786870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33787&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33788name, and pid as added by syslog:
33789.code
33790[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33791[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33792[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33793[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33794[5/5] mple>)
33795.endd
33796The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33797(LOG_NOTICE):
33798.code
33799[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33800[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33801[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33802[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33803[5\18] .example>)
33804[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33805[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33806[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33807[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33808[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33809[11\18] 09:43 +0100
33810[12\18] F From: <>
33811[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33812[18\18] X-something: this is another header
33813[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33814[16\18] le>
33815[17\18] B Bcc:
33816[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33817.endd
33818Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33819without modification.
33820
33821If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33822display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33823the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33824where it is.
33825
33826
33827
33828.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33829One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33830successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33831picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33832timestamp. The flags are:
33833.display
33834&`<=`& message arrival
33835&`=>`& normal message delivery
33836&`->`& additional address in same delivery
33837.new
33838&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
33839.wen
33840&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33841&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33842&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33843.endd
33844
33845
33846.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33847.cindex "log" "reception line"
33848The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33849message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33850several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33851.code
338522002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33853 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33854 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33855.endd
33856The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33857bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33858generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33859.code
33860R=<message id>
33861.endd
33862which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33863
33864.cindex "HELO"
33865.cindex "EHLO"
33866For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33867record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33868received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33869host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33870above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33871&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33872by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33873verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33874EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33875name in parentheses.
33876
33877Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33878without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33879the log containing text like these examples:
33880.code
33881H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33882H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33883.endd
33884This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33885on.
33886
33887For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33888the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33889of Exim.
33890
33891.cindex "authentication" "logging"
33892.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33893For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33894message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33895of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33896extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33897session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33898suite that was used.
33899
33900The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33901hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33902value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33903there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33904was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33905&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33906authenticator name.
33907
33908.cindex "size" "of message"
33909The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33910received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33911headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33912message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33913other).
33914
33915The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33916data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33917
33918
33919
33920.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33921.cindex "log" "delivery line"
33922The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33923delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33924deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33925to fit it on the page:
33926.code
339272002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33928 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
339292002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33930 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33931 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33932.endd
33933For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33934after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33935intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33936last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33937fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33938
33939.new
33940If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
33941followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
33942If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
33943option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
33944.wen
33945
33946If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33947for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33948.display
33949&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33950.endd
33951If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33952parentheses afterwards.
33953
33954.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33955When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33956SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33957flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33958down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33959lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33960
33961.new
33962.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
33963.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
33964When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
33965line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
33966rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
33967.wen
33968
33969The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33970&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33971
33972The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33973data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33974
33975
33976.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33977.cindex "discarded messages"
33978.cindex "message" "discarded"
33979.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33980When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33981obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33982.code
339832002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33984 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33985.endd
33986is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33987because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33988.code
339891999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33990 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33991.endd
33992
33993
33994.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33995When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33996.code
339972002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33998 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33999.endd
34000In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
34001last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
34002written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
34003.code
340042002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
34005 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
34006.endd
34007When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
34008a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
34009appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
34010
34011
34012
34013.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
34014.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
34015If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
34016following form is logged:
34017.code
340181995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
34019 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
34020.endd
34021If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
34022the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
34023.code
340242002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
34025 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
34026 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
34027 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
34028 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
34029.endd
34030The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
34031used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
34032disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
34033flagged with &`**`&.
34034
34035
34036
34037.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
34038.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
34039If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
34040used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
34041&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
34042
34043
34044
34045.section "Completion" "SECID257"
34046A line of the form
34047.code
340482002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
34049.endd
34050is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
34051at the end of its processing.
34052
34053
34054
34055
34056.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
34057.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
34058A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
34059the following table:
34060.display
34061&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
34062&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
34063&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34064&`CV `& certificate verification status
34065&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34066&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
34067&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
34068&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
34069&`H `& host name and IP address
34070&`I `& local interface used
34071&`id `& message id for incoming message
34072&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
34073&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
34074&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
34075&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
34076&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
34077&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
34078&`S `& size of message
34079&`ST `& shadow transport name
34080&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
34081&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
34082&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
34083&`X `& TLS cipher suite
34084.endd
34085
34086
34087.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
34088Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
34089self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
34090
34091.ilist
34092.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
34093&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
34094during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
34095This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
34096during the first delivery attempt.
34097.next
34098&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
34099temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
34100for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
34101.next
34102.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
34103&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
34104some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
34105common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
34106&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
34107doing.
34108.next
34109.cindex "error" "ignored"
34110&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
34111message:
34112.olist
34113Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
34114&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
34115.next
34116A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
34117failed. The delivery was discarded.
34118.next
34119A delivery set up by a router configured with
34120. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
34121. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
34122.code
34123 errors_to = <>
34124.endd
34125failed. The delivery was discarded.
34126.endlist olist
34127.endlist ilist
34128
34129
34130
34131
34132
34133.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
34134.cindex "log" "selectors"
34135By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
34136default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
34137&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
34138example:
34139.code
34140log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
34141.endd
34142The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
34143selection marked by asterisks:
34144.display
34145.new
34146&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
34147.wen
34148&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
34149&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
34150&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
34151&` arguments `& command line arguments
34152&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
34153&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
34154&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
34155&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
34156&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
34157&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
34158&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
34159&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
34160&` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
34161&` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
34162&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
34163&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
34164&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
34165&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
34166&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
34167&` pid `& Exim process id
34168&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
34169&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
34170&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
34171&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
34172&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
34173&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
34174&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
34175&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
34176&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
34177.new
34178&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
34179.wen
34180&` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
34181&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
34182.new
34183&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
34184.wen
34185&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
34186&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
34187&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
34188&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
34189&` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
34190&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
34191&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
34192&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
34193&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
34194
34195&` all `& all of the above
34196.endd
34197More details on each of these items follows:
34198
34199.ilist
34200.new
34201.cindex "8BITMIME"
34202.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
34203&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
34204which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
34205that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
34206&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
34207&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
34208.wen
34209.next
34210.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
34211&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
34212its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
34213this log selector is set.
34214.next
34215.cindex "log" "rewriting"
34216.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
34217&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
34218rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
34219such users cannot access the log).
34220.next
34221.cindex "log" "full parentage"
34222&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
34223delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
34224parentheses between them.
34225.next
34226.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
34227.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
34228&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
34229to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
34230feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
34231&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
34232privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
34233that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
34234are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
34235because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
34236only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
34237between the caller and Exim.
34238.next
34239.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
34240&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
34241connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
34242.next
34243.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
34244.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
34245&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
34246started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
34247messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
34248process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
34249.next
34250.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
34251&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
34252perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
34253.next
34254.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
34255.cindex "size" "of message"
34256&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
34257the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
34258.next
34259.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
34260.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
34261.cindex "black list (DNS)"
34262&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
34263DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
34264.next
34265.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
34266.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
34267&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
34268is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
34269command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
34270selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
34271.next
34272.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
34273&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
34274any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
34275log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
34276routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
34277.next
34278.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
34279.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
34280&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
34281client's ident port times out.
34282.next
34283.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
34284.cindex "interface" "logging"
34285&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
34286to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
34287followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
34288added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
34289rejection lines.
34290.next
34291.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
34292.cindex "port" "logging remote"
34293.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
34294.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
34295.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
34296&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
34297added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
34298in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
34299changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
34300&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
34301important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
34302.next
34303.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
34304&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
34305connection is unexpectedly dropped.
34306.next
34307.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
34308.cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
34309.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
34310&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
34311containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
34312the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
34313number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
34314.next
34315.cindex "log" "process ids in"
34316.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34317&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
34318immediately after the time and date.
34319.next
34320.cindex "log" "queue run"
34321.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
34322&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
34323.next
34324.cindex "log" "queue time"
34325&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
34326local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
34327&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
34328includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
34329This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
34330delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
34331message has been successfully received.
34332.next
34333&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
34334the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
34335example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
34336message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
34337.next
34338.cindex "log" "recipients"
34339&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
34340as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
34341that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
34342addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
34343has taken place.
34344Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
34345in the list.
34346.next
34347.cindex "log" "sender reception"
34348&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
34349the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
34350&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
34351.next
34352.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
34353&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
34354rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
34355log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
34356rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
34357.next
34358.cindex "log" "retry defer"
34359&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
34360retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
34361message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
34362attempt.
34363.next
34364.cindex "log" "return path"
34365&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
34366the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
34367This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
34368or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
34369.next
34370.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
34371&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
34372and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
34373This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
34374necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
34375.next
34376.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
34377&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
34378gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
34379the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
34380detail is lost.
34381.next
34382.cindex "log" "size rejection"
34383&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
34384it is too big.
34385.next
34386.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
34387.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
34388&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
34389queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
34390it.
34391.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
34392The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
34393.next
34394.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
34395.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
34396&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
34397outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
34398A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
34399response.
34400.next
34401.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
34402.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
34403&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
34404established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
34405&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
34406only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
34407processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
34408dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
34409not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
34410of connections unless this selector is enabled.
34411
34412For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
34413included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
34414reset if the daemon is restarted.
34415Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
34416subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
34417whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
34418match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
34419logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
34420.next
34421.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
34422.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
34423&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
34424RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
34425and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
34426line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
34427.next
34428.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
34429.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
34430&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
34431connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
34432the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
34433does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
34434an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
34435already have their own log lines.
34436
34437The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
34438way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
34439If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
34440an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
34441DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
34442the same logging options.
34443
34444Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
34445is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
34446.code
34447C=EHLO,QUIT
34448.endd
34449shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
34450than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
34451the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
34452setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
34453have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
34454.next
34455.new
34456&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
34457colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
34458log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
34459was accepted or used.
34460.wen
34461.next
34462.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
34463.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
34464&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
34465encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
34466because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
34467been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
34468it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
34469received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
34470.next
34471.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
34472.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
34473.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
34474.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
34475.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
34476&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
34477encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
34478external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
34479using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
34480.next
34481.cindex "log" "subject"
34482.cindex "subject, logging"
34483&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
34484preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
34485Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
34486specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
34487unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
34488.next
34489.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
34490&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
34491when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
34492verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
34493.next
34494.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
34495.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
34496&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34497connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
34498.next
34499.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
34500.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
34501&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34502connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
34503added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
34504.next
34505.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
34506.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
34507&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
34508the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
34509added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
34510.next
34511.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
34512&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
34513result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
34514.endlist
34515
34516
34517.section "Message log" "SECID260"
34518.cindex "message" "log file for"
34519.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
34520.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
34521.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
34522In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
34523that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
34524they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
34525message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
34526makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
34527to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
34528is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
34529only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
34530
34531On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
34532per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
34533&%message_logs%& option false.
34534.ecindex IIDloggen
34535
34536
34537
34538
34539. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34540. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34541
34542.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
34543.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
34544A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
34545described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
34546the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
34547
34548.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
34549.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
34550 "list what Exim processes are doing"
34551.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
34552.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
34553.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
34554.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
34555 various criteria"
34556.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
34557.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
34558 "extract statistics from the log"
34559.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
34560 "check address acceptance from given IP"
34561.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
34562.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
34563.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
34564.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
34565.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
34566.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
34567.endtable
34568
34569Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
34570&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
34571&url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
34572
34573
34574
34575
34576.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
34577.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
34578.cindex "process, querying"
34579.cindex "SIGUSR1"
34580On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
34581(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
34582a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
34583Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
34584processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
34585second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
34586order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
34587send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
34588
34589&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
34590use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
34591script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
34592
34593
34594Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
34595varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
34596but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
34597system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
34598it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
34599options:
34600.display
34601&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
34602&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
34603&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
34604&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
34605.endd
34606An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
34607.code
34608164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3460910483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3461010492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
34611 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3461210592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3461310628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
34614.endd
34615The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
34616been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
34617
34618
34619
34620.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
34621.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
34622.cindex "queue" "grepping"
34623This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
34624.code
34625exim -bpu
34626.endd
34627to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
34628output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
34629options are available:
34630
34631.vlist
34632.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
34633Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
34634tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
34635.code
34636exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
34637.endd
34638.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
34639Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
34640tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
34641
34642.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
34643Match against the size field.
34644
34645.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34646Match messages that are younger than the given time.
34647
34648.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34649Match messages that are older than the given time.
34650
34651.vitem &*-z*&
34652Match only frozen messages.
34653
34654.vitem &*-x*&
34655Match only non-frozen messages.
34656.endlist
34657
34658The following options control the format of the output:
34659
34660.vlist
34661.vitem &*-c*&
34662Display only the count of matching messages.
34663
34664.vitem &*-l*&
34665Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
34666the default.
34667
34668.vitem &*-i*&
34669Display message ids only.
34670
34671.vitem &*-b*&
34672Brief format &-- one line per message.
34673
34674.vitem &*-R*&
34675Display messages in reverse order.
34676.endlist
34677
34678There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
34679
34680
34681
34682.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
34683.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
34684.cindex "queue" "summary"
34685The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
34686-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
34687running a command such as
34688.code
34689exim -bp | exiqsumm
34690.endd
34691The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
34692it, as in the following example:
34693.code
346943 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
34695.endd
34696Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
34697volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
34698been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
34699number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
34700
34701A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
34702domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
34703the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
34704respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
34705domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
34706separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
34707sender.
34708
34709The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
34710this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
34711generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
34712option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
34713level"& addresses).
34714
34715
34716
34717
34718.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
34719 "SECTextspeinf"
34720.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
34721.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
34722The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
34723files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
34724extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
34725match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
34726given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
34727The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34728If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34729included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34730.display
34731&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34732.endd
34733If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34734
34735The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34736condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34737they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34738
34739By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34740makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34741large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34742option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34743case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34744
34745The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34746pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34747regular expression.
34748
34749The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34750if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34751
34752If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34753ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34754whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34755
34756
34757.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34758.cindex "&'exipick'&"
34759John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34760lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34761of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34762&url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34763the &%--help%& option.
34764
34765
34766.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34767.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34768.cindex "cycling logs"
34769.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34770The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34771&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34772you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34773&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34774for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34775There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34776.ilist
34777&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34778default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34779.next
34780&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34781&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34782overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34783configuration.
34784.endlist
34785
34786Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34787the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34788run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34789&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34790&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34791logs are handled similarly.
34792
34793If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34794&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34795to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34796any existing log files.
34797
34798If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34799the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34800using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34801setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34802root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34803.code
348041 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34805.endd
34806assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34807&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34808
34809
34810
34811.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34812.cindex "statistics"
34813.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34814A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34815information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34816Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34817LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34818
34819The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34820latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34821lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34822various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34823list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34824.code
34825eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34826.endd
34827By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34828messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34829both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34830are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34831addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34832options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34833also produced per user.
34834
34835The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34836histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34837hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34838example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34839as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34840
34841Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34842have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34843messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34844and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34845recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34846an entirely separate message.
34847
34848&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34849of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34850each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34851not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34852least one address that failed.
34853
34854The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34855or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34856transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34857(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34858a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34859senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34860and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34861
34862The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34863came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34864without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34865
34866There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34867outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34868by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34869.code
34870perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34871.endd
34872
34873.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34874.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34875.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34876.cindex "checking access"
34877The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34878debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34879policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34880familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34881sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34882access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34883
34884The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34885two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34886.code
34887exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34888.endd
34889The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34890given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34891connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34892is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34893.code
34894Rejected:
34895550 Relay not permitted
34896.endd
34897When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34898for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34899options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34900that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34901you can use:
34902.code
34903exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34904 -f himself@there.example
34905.endd
34906Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34907mandatory arguments.
34908
34909Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34910while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34911&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34912
34913
34914
34915.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34916.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34917.cindex "building DBM files"
34918.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34919.cindex "lower casing"
34920.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34921The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34922the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34923&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34924names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34925can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34926
34927A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34928the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34929&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34930strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34931files.
34932
34933The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34934single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34935It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34936well.
34937
34938.cindex "USE_DB"
34939If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34940configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34941names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34942a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34943.code
34944exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34945.endd
34946reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34947&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34948
34949In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34950Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34951environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34952&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34953when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34954recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34955
34956If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34957finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34958option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34959this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34960&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34961There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34962&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34963return code is 2.
34964
34965
34966
34967
34968.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34969.cindex "retry" "times"
34970.cindex "&'exinext'&"
34971A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34972fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34973complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34974information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34975is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34976output. For example:
34977.code
34978$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34979kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34980 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34981 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34982 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34983roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34984 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34985 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34986 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34987 past final cutoff time
34988.endd
34989You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34990will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34991A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34992message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34993suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34994&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34995run very often.
34996
34997The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34998of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34999passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
35000configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
35001file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
35002environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
35003
35004
35005
35006.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
35007.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
35008.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
35009Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
35010uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
35011arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
35012second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
35013
35014.ilist
35015&'retry'&: the database of retry information
35016.next
35017&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
35018for remote hosts
35019.next
35020&'callout'&: the callout cache
35021.next
35022&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
35023.next
35024&'misc'&: other hints data
35025.endlist
35026
35027The &'misc'& database is used for
35028
35029.ilist
35030Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
35031.next
35032Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
35033&(smtp)& transport)
35034.endlist
35035
35036
35037
35038.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
35039.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
35040The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
35041&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
35042spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
35043.code
35044exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
35045.endd
35046Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
35047.code
35048T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3504931-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
35050.endd
35051The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
35052of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
35053transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
35054a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
35055address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
35056transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
35057to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
35058and a textual description of the error.
35059
35060The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
35061the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
35062ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
35063exceeded.
35064
35065Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
35066consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
35067waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
35068one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
35069may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
35070may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
35071cross-references.
35072
35073
35074
35075.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
35076.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
35077The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
35078database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
35079days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
35080updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
35081since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
35082for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
35083updated sufficiently often.
35084
35085The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
35086followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
35087the retry database:
35088.code
35089exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
35090.endd
35091Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
35092message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
35093they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
35094are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
35095types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
35096message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
35097queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
35098&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
35099For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
35100removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
35101whenever it removes information from the database.
35102
35103Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
35104needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
35105down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
35106first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
35107records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
35108
35109It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
35110hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
35111a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
35112work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
35113but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
35114After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
35115point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
35116tidied.
35117
35118&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
35119databases is likely to keep on increasing.
35120
35121
35122
35123
35124.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
35125.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
35126The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
35127Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
35128getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
35129is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
35130key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
35131displayed.
35132
35133If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
35134except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
35135out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
35136data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
35137by new data, for example:
35138.code
35139> 4 951102:1000
35140.endd
35141resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
35142sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
35143used as optional separators.
35144
35145
35146
35147
35148.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
35149.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
35150.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
35151.cindex "locking mailboxes"
35152The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
35153Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
35154&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
35155a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
35156the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
35157argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
35158second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
35159is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
35160is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
35161
35162.vlist
35163.vitem &%-fcntl%&
35164Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
35165
35166.vitem &%-flock%&
35167Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
35168supports it.
35169
35170.vitem &%-interval%&
35171This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
35172interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
35173
35174.vitem &%-lockfile%&
35175Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
35176
35177.vitem &%-mbx%&
35178Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
35179
35180.vitem &%-q%&
35181Suppress verification output.
35182
35183.vitem &%-retries%&
35184This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
35185the lock (default 10).
35186
35187.vitem &%-restore_time%&
35188This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
35189locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
35190example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
35191subsequently sees.
35192
35193.vitem &%-timeout%&
35194This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
35195timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
35196default), a non-blocking call is used.
35197
35198.vitem &%-v%&
35199Generate verbose output.
35200.endlist
35201
35202If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
35203default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
35204mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
35205&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
35206requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
35207file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
35208more than 30 minutes old.
35209
35210The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
35211&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
35212to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
35213&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
35214number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
35215can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
35216
35217The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
35218&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
35219suppresses all output except error messages.
35220
35221A command such as
35222.code
35223exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
35224.endd
35225runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
35226.display
35227&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
35228<&'some commands'&>
35229&`End`&
35230.endd
35231runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
35232suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
35233such as
35234.code
35235exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
35236 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
35237.endd
35238Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
35239second argument &-- hence the quotes.
35240.ecindex IIDutils
35241
35242
35243. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35244. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35245
35246.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
35247.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
35248.cindex "X-windows"
35249.cindex "&'eximon'&"
35250.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
35251.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
35252The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
35253about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
35254perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
35255such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
35256monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
35257
35258
35259
35260.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
35261The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
35262script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
35263binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
35264be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
35265&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
35266parameters are for.
35267
35268The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
35269a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
35270preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
35271.code
35272EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
35273.endd
35274(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
35275the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
35276overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
35277&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
35278syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
35279
35280X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
35281way. For example, a resource setting of the form
35282.code
35283Eximon*background: gray94
35284.endd
35285changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
35286stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
35287black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
35288data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
35289&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
35290For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
35291reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
35292.code
35293xrdb -merge <<End
35294Eximon*highlight: gray
35295End
35296.endd
35297.cindex "admin user"
35298In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
35299&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
35300
35301The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
35302contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
35303if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
35304binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
35305versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
35306
35307The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
35308more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
35309main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
35310delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
35311different parts of the display.
35312
35313
35314
35315
35316.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
35317.cindex "stripchart"
35318The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
35319be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35320&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
35321configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
35322it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
35323hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
35324received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
35325period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
35326parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35327
35328The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
35329displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
35330title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
35331For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
35332
35333It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
35334a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
35335to a single partition.
35336
35337.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
35338This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
35339the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
35340this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
35341100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
35342SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35343&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35344
35345
35346
35347
35348.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
35349.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
35350.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
35351.cindex "window size"
35352Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
35353to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
35354shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
35355stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
35356the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
35357in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
35358
35359When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
35360currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
35361size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
35362remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
35363
35364The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
35365stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
35366the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
35367The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
35368&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
35369the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35370
35371Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
35372built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
35373START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35374
35375
35376
35377.section "The log display" "SECID267"
35378.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
35379The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
35380the main log is maintained.
35381To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
35382removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
35383The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
35384syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
35385to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
35386
35387The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
35388move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
35389scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
35390LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
35391to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
35392much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
35393a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
35394only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
35395available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
35396normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
35397configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35398
35399Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
35400and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
35401respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
35402It cannot go further back up the log.
35403
35404The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
35405normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
35406by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
35407by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
35408back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
35409the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
35410
35411Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
35412There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
35413the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
35414happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
35415&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
35416^C is typed the search is cancelled.
35417
35418The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
35419widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
35420&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
35421eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
35422However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
35423provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
35424come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
35425unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
35426on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
35427window.
35428
35429
35430
35431.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
35432.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
35433The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
35434are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
35435as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
35436parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
35437at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
35438the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
35439there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
35440to force an update of the queue display at any time.
35441
35442When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
35443and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
35444with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
35445pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
35446type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
35447such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
35448of the texts, the message is not displayed.
35449
35450If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
35451are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
35452example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
35453&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
35454has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
35455cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
35456a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
35457
35458While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
35459else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
35460queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
35461pressing the &"Hide"& button.
35462
35463The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
35464time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
35465message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
35466a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
35467recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
35468listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
35469an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
35470not shown.
35471
35472.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
35473If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
35474
35475The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
35476of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
35477The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
35478available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
35479display is updated.
35480
35481
35482
35483.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
35484.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
35485If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
35486pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
35487line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
35488any selected text.
35489
35490If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
35491MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
35492set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
35493value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
35494run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
35495.code
35496EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
35497.endd
35498The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
35499follows:
35500
35501.ilist
35502&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
35503in a new text window.
35504.next
35505&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
35506information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
35507&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
35508.next
35509&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
35510displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
35511amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
35512option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
35513.next
35514&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
35515delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
35516frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
35517a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
35518up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
35519.next
35520&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
35521that the message be frozen.
35522.next
35523.cindex "thawing messages"
35524.cindex "unfreezing messages"
35525.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
35526&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
35527that the message be thawed.
35528.next
35529.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
35530&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
35531that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
35532for any remaining undelivered addresses.
35533.next
35534&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
35535that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
35536message.
35537.next
35538&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
35539be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35540is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35541Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35542causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
35543additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
35544which case no action is taken.
35545.next
35546&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
35547can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35548is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35549Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35550causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
35551recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
35552case no action is taken.
35553.next
35554&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
35555mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
35556.next
35557&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
35558sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
35559&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
35560in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
35561bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
35562not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
35563the address is qualified with that domain.
35564.endlist
35565
35566When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
35567other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
35568particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
35569output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
35570from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
35571&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
35572if no output is generated.
35573
35574The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
35575thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
35576&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
35577force an update of the display after one of these actions.
35578
35579In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
35580cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
35581and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
35582.ecindex IIDeximon
35583
35584
35585
35586
35587
35588. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35589. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35590
35591.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
35592.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
35593This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
35594which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
35595
35596For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
35597Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
35598existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
35599chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
35600security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
35601its security as compared with other MTAs.
35602
35603What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
35604have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
35605absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
35606as soon as possible.
35607
35608
35609.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
35610.cindex "security" "build-time features"
35611There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
35612to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
35613Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
35614penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
35615
35616.ilist
35617ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
35618start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
35619names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
35620value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
35621&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
35622default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
35623
35624If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
35625which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
35626into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
35627configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
35628.next
35629
35630If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
35631or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
35632file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
35633the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
35634root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
35635right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
35636reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
35637it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
35638privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
35639separate commands.
35640
35641.next
35642The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
35643with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
35644CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
35645requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
35646the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
35647but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
35648previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
35649.next
35650If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
35651is disabled.
35652.next
35653FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
35654never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
35655option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
35656to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
35657is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
35658.endlist
35659
35660
35661
35662.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
35663.cindex "setuid"
35664.cindex "root privilege"
35665The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
35666privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
35667example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
35668may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
35669discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
35670is required for two things:
35671
35672.ilist
35673To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
35674the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
35675not required.
35676.next
35677To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
35678perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
35679configuration.
35680.endlist
35681
35682It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
35683receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
35684obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
35685For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
35686&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
35687group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
35688is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
35689&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
35690
35691Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
35692abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
35693&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
35694
35695After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
35696uid and gid in the following cases:
35697
35698.ilist
35699.oindex "&%-C%&"
35700.oindex "&%-D%&"
35701If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
35702the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
35703calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
35704the calling process.
35705However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
35706option may not be used at all.
35707If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
35708can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
35709user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
35710.next
35711.oindex "&%-be%&"
35712.oindex "&%-bf%&"
35713.oindex "&%-bF%&"
35714If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
35715(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
35716calling process.
35717.next
35718If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
35719process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
35720uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
35721runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
35722testing address verification
35723.oindex "&%-bv%&"
35724.oindex "&%-bh%&"
35725(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35726option).
35727.next
35728For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35729remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35730.endlist
35731
35732The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35733
35734.ilist
35735A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35736user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35737function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35738will be used during message reception.
35739.next
35740A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35741job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35742.next
35743A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35744but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35745subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35746deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35747remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35748subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35749while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35750generating bounce and warning messages.
35751
35752While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35753process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35754this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35755gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35756.next
35757A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35758the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35759.endlist
35760
35761
35762
35763
35764.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35765.cindex "privilege, running without"
35766.cindex "unprivileged running"
35767.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35768Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35769operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35770by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35771gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35772(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35773routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35774to any other uid.
35775
35776.cindex SIGHUP
35777.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35778Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35779that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35780correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35781
35782An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35783to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35784process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35785when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35786SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35787
35788It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35789stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35790been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35791effect.
35792
35793If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35794set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35795to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35796
35797In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35798those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35799Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35800that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35801discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35802have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35803number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35804address this problem at this time.
35805
35806For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35807is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35808&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35809be used in the most straightforward way.
35810
35811If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35812number of restrictions on what you can do:
35813
35814.ilist
35815You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35816&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35817normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35818work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35819explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35820.next
35821Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35822not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35823.next
35824Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35825the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35826and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35827enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35828.next
35829Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35830some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35831
35832.olist
35833They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35834implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35835mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35836.next
35837You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35838owned by the Exim user.
35839.next
35840You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35841on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35842mailboxes need to be created manually.
35843.endlist olist
35844.endlist ilist
35845
35846
35847These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35848However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35849gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35850gives more security at essentially no cost.
35851
35852If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35853&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35854
35855
35856
35857
35858.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35859Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35860are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35861
35862
35863
35864.new
35865.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
35866.cindex "security" "local commands"
35867.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
35868There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
35869commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
35870configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
35871run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
35872
35873.ilist
35874Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
35875injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
35876be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
35877allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
35878has &%use_shell%& enabled.
35879.next
35880A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
35881&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
35882&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
35883hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
35884NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
35885forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
35886need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
35887.next
35888The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
35889administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
35890Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
35891.next
35892Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
35893taint checking might apply to their usage.
35894.next
35895Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
35896administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
35897instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
35898.next
35899Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
35900Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
35901each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
35902of opaque strings.
35903The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
35904real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
35905injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
35906Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
35907.endlist
35908.wen
35909
35910
35911
35912
35913.new
35914.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
35915.cindex "security" "data sources"
35916.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
35917.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
35918.cindex "PCRE" "security"
35919If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
35920are some issues to be aware of:
35921
35922.ilist
35923Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
35924.next
35925Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
35926.next
35927Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
35928data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
35929"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
35930expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
35931when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
35932possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
35933data.
35934.next
35935It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
35936&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
35937items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
35938.next
35939Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
35940expected to yield one result.
35941.endlist
35942.wen
35943
35944
35945
35946
35947.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35948.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35949.cindex "IP source routing"
35950Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35951some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35952IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35953IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35954
35955
35956
35957.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35958Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35959be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35960
35961
35962
35963
35964.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35965.cindex "trusted users"
35966.cindex "admin user"
35967.cindex "privileged user"
35968.cindex "user" "trusted"
35969.cindex "user" "admin"
35970Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35971able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35972addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35973local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35974permit a remote host to be specified.
35975
35976.oindex "&%-f%&"
35977However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
35978in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
35979message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
35980but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
35981permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
35982the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
35983
35984Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
35985other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
35986the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
35987as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
35988group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
35989
35990Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
35991can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
35992them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
35993the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
35994includes the contents of files on the spool.
35995
35996.oindex "&%-M%&"
35997.oindex "&%-q%&"
35998By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
35999delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
36000restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
36001Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
36002queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
36003setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
36004
36005Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
36006the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
36007the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
36008group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
36009the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
36010unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
36011files.
36012
36013
36014
36015.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
36016.cindex "spool directory" "files"
36017Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
36018set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
36019&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
36020any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
36021
36022
36023
36024.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
36025Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
36026of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
36027with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
36028to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
36029this.
36030
36031
36032
36033.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
36034The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
36035are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
36036Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
36037converted output.
36038
36039
36040
36041.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
36042Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
36043to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
36044does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
36045arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
36046
36047
36048
36049.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
36050Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
36051defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
36052loading it.
36053
36054
36055.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
36056.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
36057A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
36058&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
36059The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
36060that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
36061conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
36062
36063The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
36064the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
36065string.
36066
36067
36068
36069.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
36070Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
36071formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
36072the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
36073
36074
36075
36076.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
36077These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
36078enough to hold the result.
36079.ecindex IIDsecurcon
36080
36081
36082
36083
36084. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36085. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36086
36087.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
36088.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
36089.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
36090.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
36091.cindex "spool files" "editing"
36092A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
36093followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
36094the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
36095kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
36096two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
36097is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
36098themselves are recoverable.
36099
36100Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
36101need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
36102on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
36103
36104.ilist
36105You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
36106fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
36107which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
36108place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
36109lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
36110.next
36111.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
36112If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
36113&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
36114present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
36115will always be the case.
36116.next
36117If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
36118.next
36119If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
36120signature.
36121.endlist
36122All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
36123
36124Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
36125its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
36126files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
36127the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
36128the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
36129is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
36130file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
36131-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
36132attempt.
36133
36134.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
36135.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
36136.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
36137The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
36138process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
36139gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
36140message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
36141normally the Exim user.
36142
36143The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
36144transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
36145empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
36146in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
36147created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
36148&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
36149leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
36150&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
36151
36152The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
36153was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
36154start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
36155warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
36156
36157There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
36158order, and are omitted when not relevant:
36159
36160.vlist
36161.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36162This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
36163&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
36164recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
36165this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
36166identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
36167the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
36168the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
36169the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
36170newlines.
36171
36172.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36173A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
36174defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
36175The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36176starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36177character. It may contain internal newlines.
36178
36179.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36180A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
36181Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
36182length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36183starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36184character. It may contain internal newlines.
36185
36186.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
36187This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
36188&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
36189
36190.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
36191This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
36192lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
36193transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
36194messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36195
36196.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
36197This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
36198(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
36199time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
36200hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36201
36202.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
36203The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
36204&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
36205
36206.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
36207The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
36208&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
36209
36210.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36211This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
36212present.
36213
36214.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36215This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
36216present if the number is greater than zero.
36217
36218.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
36219This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
36220file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
36221
36222.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
36223.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
36224The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
36225
36226.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36227This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
36228command.
36229
36230.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36231This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
36232the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
36233messages.
36234
36235.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
36236If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
36237the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
36238&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
36239
36240.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
36241This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
36242address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
36243
36244.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36245.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
36246.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
36247This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
36248if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
36249received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
36250
36251.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
36252For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
36253unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
36254ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
36255supplied by the remote host, if any.
36256
36257.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36258This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
36259which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
36260generated messages.
36261
36262.vitem &%-local%&
36263The message is from a local sender.
36264
36265.vitem &%-localerror%&
36266The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
36267
36268.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
36269This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
36270when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
36271variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
36272
36273.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
36274The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
36275Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
36276
36277.vitem &%-N%&
36278A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
36279actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
36280&%-N%& is assumed.
36281
36282.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
36283This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
36284the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36285
36286.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
36287The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
36288to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
36289
36290.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
36291If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
36292of &$spam_score_int$&.
36293
36294.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
36295A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
36296certificate was verified by the server.
36297
36298.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
36299When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
36300name of the cipher suite that was used.
36301
36302.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
36303When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
36304was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
36305certificate.
36306.endlist
36307
36308Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
36309is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
36310line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
36311is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
36312the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
36313balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
36314to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
36315original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
36316addresses are complete.
36317
36318If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
36319the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
36320Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
36321tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
36322right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
36323follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
36324.code
36325YY darcy@austen.fict.example
36326NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
36327NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36328.endd
36329After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
36330This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
36331recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
36332delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
36333example:
36334.code
363354
36336editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36337darcy@austen.fict.example
36338rdo@foundation
36339alice@wonderland.fict.example
36340.endd
36341However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
36342result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
36343line is of the following form:
36344.display
36345<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
36346 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
36347.endd
36348The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
36349the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
36350fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
36351original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
36352envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
36353length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
36354characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
36355that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
36356
36357
36358A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
36359which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
36360when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
36361character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
36362embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
36363following:
36364
36365.table2 50pt
36366.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
36367.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
36368.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
36369.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
36370.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
36371.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
36372.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
36373.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
36374.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
36375.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
36376.endtable
36377
36378Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
36379purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
36380typical set of headers:
36381.code
36382111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
36383id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36384049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
36385038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
36386042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
36387049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
36388099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
36389darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36390104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
36391darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36392038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36393.endd
36394The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
36395&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
36396unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
36397.ecindex IIDforspo1
36398.ecindex IIDforspo2
36399.ecindex IIDforspo3
36400
36401. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36402. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36403
36404.chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
36405 "DKIM Support"
36406.cindex "DKIM"
36407
36408DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
36409linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
36410be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
36411DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
36412
36413Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
36414disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
36415
36416Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
36417.olist
36418Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
36419It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
36420.next
36421Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
36422ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
36423different signature contexts.
36424.endlist
36425
36426In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
36427default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
36428Exim's standard controls.
36429
36430Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
36431on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
36432exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
36433signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
36434.code
364352009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
36436 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
36437 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
36438 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
36439.endd
36440You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
36441or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
36442control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
36443where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
36444senders).
36445
36446
36447.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
36448.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
36449
36450Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
36451These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
36452
36453.option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
36454MANDATORY:
36455The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
36456option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
36457
36458.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
36459MANDATORY:
36460This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
36461variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
36462variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
36463option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
36464
36465.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
36466MANDATORY:
36467This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
36468&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
36469The result can either
36470.ilist
36471be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
36472.next
36473start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
36474the private key.
36475.next
36476be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
36477be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
36478is set.
36479.endlist
36480
36481.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
36482OPTIONAL:
36483This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
36484The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
36485The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
36486only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
36487
36488.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
36489OPTIONAL:
36490This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
36491should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
36492either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
36493unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
36494variables here.
36495
36496.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
36497OPTIONAL:
36498When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
36499list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
36500signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
36501used.
36502
36503
36504.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
36505.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
36506
36507Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
36508&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
36509syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
36510
36511To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
36512containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
36513runtime of the ACL.
36514
36515Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
36516more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
36517&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
36518&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
36519
36520The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
36521list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
36522called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
36523the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
36524list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
36525&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
36526it defaults as:
36527.code
36528dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
36529.endd
36530This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
36531DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
36532call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
36533.code
36534dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
36535.endd
36536This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
36537and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
36538You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
36539.code
36540dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
36541.endd
36542
36543If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
36544&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
36545
36546
36547Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
36548available (from most to least important):
36549
36550
36551.vlist
36552.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
36553The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
36554an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
36555&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
36556.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
36557A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
36558.ilist
36559&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
36560identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36561.next
36562&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
36563More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36564.next
36565&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
36566available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36567.next
36568&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
36569.endlist
36570.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
36571A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
36572"fail" or "invalid". One of
36573.ilist
36574&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
36575key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
36576.next
36577&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
36578record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
36579.next
36580&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
36581body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
36582means that the message body was modified in transit.
36583.next
36584&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
36585could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
36586re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
36587DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
36588.endlist
36589.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
36590The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
36591an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
36592reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36593.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
36594The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
36595if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
36596identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36597.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
36598The key record selector string.
36599.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
36600The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
36601.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
36602The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36603.vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
36604The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36605.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
36606A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
36607(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
36608.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
36609The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
36610limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
36611that this variable always expands to an integer value.
36612.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
36613UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
36614When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
36615.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
36616UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
36617signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
36618signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
36619integer size comparisons against this value.
36620.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
36621A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
36622.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
36623"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
36624.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
36625"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
36626.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
36627Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36628in the key record.
36629.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
36630Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36631in the key record.
36632.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
36633Notes from the key record (tag n=).
36634.endlist
36635
36636In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
36637
36638.vlist
36639.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
36640ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
36641for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
36642(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
36643verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
36644
36645.code
36646# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
36647warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
36648 sender_domains = gmail.com
36649 dkim_signers = gmail.com
36650 dkim_status = none
36651.endd
36652
36653.vitem &%dkim_status%&
36654ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
36655results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
36656to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
36657
36658.code
36659deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
36660 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
36661 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
36662 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
36663.endd
36664
36665The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
36666see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
36667for more information of what they mean.
36668.endlist
36669
36670. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36671. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36672
36673.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
36674 "Adding drivers or lookups"
36675.cindex "adding drivers"
36676.cindex "new drivers, adding"
36677.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
36678The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
36679authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
36680
36681.olist
36682Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
36683existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
36684.next
36685Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
36686.display
36687<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
36688.endd
36689where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
36690code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
36691should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
36692.next
36693Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
36694.code
36695#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
36696.endd
36697.next
36698Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
36699and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
36700.next
36701.new
36702Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
36703near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
36704Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
36705As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
36706simple form that most lookups have.
36707.wen
36708.next
36709Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
36710&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
36711driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
36712.next
36713Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
36714&_src_&.
36715.next
36716Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
36717as for other drivers and lookups.
36718.endlist
36719
36720Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
36721proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
36722occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
36723options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
36724searched using a binary chop procedure.
36725
36726There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
36727the interface that is expected.
36728
36729
36730
36731
36732. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36733. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36734
36735. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36736. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
36737. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
36738. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
36739. processors.
36740. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36741
36742.literal xml
36743<?sdop
36744 format="newpage"
36745 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
36746 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
36747?>
36748.literal off
36749
36750.makeindex "Options index" "option"
36751.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
36752.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
36753
36754
36755. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36756. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////